compiler: improve escape analysis
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob80323641d2cefa5524f0e041694dc11b2c45f196
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 This file is part of GCC.
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "memmodel.h"
66 #include "tm_p.h"
67 #include "stringpool.h"
68 #include "insn-config.h"
69 #include "ira.h"
70 #include "cgraph.h"
71 #include "diagnostic.h"
72 #include "fold-const.h"
73 #include "stor-layout.h"
74 #include "varasm.h"
75 #include "version.h"
76 #include "flags.h"
77 #include "rtlhash.h"
78 #include "reload.h"
79 #include "output.h"
80 #include "expr.h"
81 #include "dwarf2out.h"
82 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
83 #include "toplev.h"
84 #include "md5.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "print-rtl.h"
87 #include "debug.h"
88 #include "common/common-target.h"
89 #include "langhooks.h"
90 #include "lra.h"
91 #include "dumpfile.h"
92 #include "opts.h"
93 #include "tree-dfa.h"
94 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
95 #include "rtl-iter.h"
96 #include "stringpool.h"
97 #include "attribs.h"
98 #include "file-prefix-map.h" /* remap_debug_filename() */
100 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, unsigned int, const char *,
101 int, bool);
102 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
103 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
104 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
106 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
107 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
108 #endif
110 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
111 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
112 #endif
114 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
115 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
117 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
118 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
119 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
120 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
121 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
122 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
123 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
124 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
125 #else
126 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
127 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
128 #endif
130 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
131 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
132 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
133 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
134 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
135 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
136 #endif
138 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
139 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
140 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
141 #endif
143 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
144 must be kept around forever. */
145 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
147 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
148 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
149 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
150 it. */
151 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
153 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
154 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
155 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
156 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
157 define type declaration DIE's. */
158 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
160 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
167 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
168 static const char *debug_macinfo_section_name;
169 static unsigned macinfo_label_base = 1;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
172 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
173 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
174 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
175 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_str_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
179 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
180 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
182 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
183 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 40
185 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
186 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
187 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
188 bytes.
190 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
191 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
193 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
194 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
195 #endif
197 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR
198 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "-4" : "-12")
199 #endif
201 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
202 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
203 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
205 /* CIE identifier. */
206 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
207 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
208 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
209 #else
210 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
211 #endif
214 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
215 information for each routine. */
216 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
217 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
219 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
221 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
222 const char *str;
223 unsigned int refcount;
224 enum dwarf_form form;
225 char *label;
226 unsigned int index;
229 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
231 typedef const char *compare_type;
233 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
234 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
237 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
239 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_line_str_hash;
241 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
242 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
243 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
245 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
246 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
248 2) Strings can use four forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp,
249 DW_FORM_line_strp or DW_FORM_strx/GNU_str_index.
251 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
252 reference count.
254 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
255 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
256 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
257 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
258 that need it. */
260 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
262 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
264 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
265 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
267 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
268 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
269 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
271 /* The default cold text section. */
272 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
274 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
275 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
277 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
278 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
280 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
282 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
283 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
285 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
286 personality CFI. */
287 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
289 /* Whether an eh_frame section is required. */
290 static GTY(()) bool do_eh_frame = false;
292 /* .debug_rnglists next index. */
293 static unsigned int rnglist_idx;
295 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
296 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
297 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
299 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
300 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
301 #endif
303 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
304 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
305 #endif
307 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
308 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
309 #endif
311 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
312 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
313 #endif
315 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
316 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
317 #endif
319 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
320 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
321 #endif
322 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
323 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
324 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
325 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
326 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
327 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
328 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
329 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
330 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
331 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
333 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
335 static int
336 matches_main_base (const char *path)
338 /* Cache the last query. */
339 static const char *last_path = NULL;
340 static int last_match = 0;
341 if (path != last_path)
343 const char *base;
344 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
345 last_path = path;
346 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
347 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
349 return last_match;
352 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
354 static int
355 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
356 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
357 int matches, int result)
359 /* Find the type name. */
360 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
361 tree t = type_decl;
362 const char *name = 0;
363 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
364 t = DECL_NAME (t);
365 if (t)
366 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
368 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
369 criterion,
370 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
371 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
372 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
373 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
374 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
375 result,
376 (void*) type_decl, name);
377 return result;
379 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
380 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
382 #else
384 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
385 (result)
387 #endif
389 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
390 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
391 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
393 static unsigned int
394 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
396 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
397 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
398 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
401 static bool
402 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
404 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
405 tree type_decl;
406 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
408 if (generic)
409 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
410 else
411 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
413 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
414 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
415 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
416 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
418 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
420 if (type_decl != NULL)
422 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
423 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
425 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
426 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
429 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
432 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
433 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
434 for collect2 the first time around. */
436 static void
437 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
439 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
441 int flags;
443 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
445 int fde_encoding;
446 int per_encoding;
447 int lsda_encoding;
449 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
450 /*global=*/0);
451 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
452 /*global=*/1);
453 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
454 /*global=*/0);
455 flags = ((! flag_pic
456 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
457 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
458 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
459 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
460 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
461 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
462 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
464 else
465 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
467 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
468 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
469 #else
470 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
471 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
472 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
475 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
477 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
478 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
479 collect2. */
480 if (!back)
482 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
483 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
484 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
485 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
486 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
488 #endif
491 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
492 FOR_EH. */
494 static void
495 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
497 if (for_eh)
498 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
499 else
501 if (!debug_frame_section)
502 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
503 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
504 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
508 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
510 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
511 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
513 switch (cfi)
515 case DW_CFA_nop:
516 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
517 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
518 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
519 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
521 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
523 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
524 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
525 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
526 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
528 case DW_CFA_offset:
529 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
530 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
531 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
532 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
533 case DW_CFA_restore:
534 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
535 case DW_CFA_undefined:
536 case DW_CFA_same_value:
537 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
538 case DW_CFA_register:
539 case DW_CFA_expression:
540 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
541 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
543 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
544 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
545 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
546 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
548 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
549 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
551 default:
552 gcc_unreachable ();
556 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
558 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
559 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
561 switch (cfi)
563 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
564 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
565 case DW_CFA_offset:
566 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
567 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
568 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
570 case DW_CFA_register:
571 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
573 case DW_CFA_expression:
574 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
575 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
577 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
578 return dw_cfi_oprnd_cfa_loc;
580 default:
581 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
585 /* Output one FDE. */
587 static void
588 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
589 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
590 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
592 const char *begin, *end;
593 static unsigned int j;
594 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
596 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
597 /* empty */ 0);
598 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
599 for_eh + j);
600 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
601 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
602 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
604 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
605 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
606 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
607 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
608 "FDE Length");
610 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
612 if (for_eh)
613 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
614 else
615 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
616 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
618 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
619 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
621 if (for_eh)
623 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
624 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
625 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
626 "FDE initial location");
627 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
628 end, begin, "FDE address range");
630 else
632 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
633 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
636 if (augmentation[0])
638 if (any_lsda_needed)
640 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
642 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
644 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
645 + 4 /* CIE offset */
646 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
647 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
648 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
650 size += pad;
651 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
654 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
656 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
658 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
659 fde->funcdef_number);
660 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
661 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
662 false,
663 "Language Specific Data Area");
665 else
667 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
668 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
669 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
670 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
673 else
674 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
677 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
678 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
680 size_t from, until, i;
682 from = 0;
683 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
685 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
687 else if (!second)
688 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
689 else
690 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
692 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
693 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
696 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
697 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
698 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
699 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
700 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
702 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
703 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
704 switch *back* into the table section. */
705 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
706 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
707 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
708 #endif
710 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
711 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
712 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
713 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
715 j += 2;
718 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
720 static bool
721 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
723 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
724 return true;
726 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
727 return true;
729 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
730 return true;
732 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
733 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
734 return false;
736 return true;
739 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
740 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
741 location of saved registers. */
743 static void
744 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
746 unsigned int i;
747 dw_fde_ref fde;
748 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
749 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
750 char section_start_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
751 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
752 char augmentation[6];
753 int augmentation_size;
754 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
755 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
756 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
757 int return_reg;
758 rtx personality = NULL;
759 int dw_cie_version;
761 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
762 if (!fde_vec)
763 return;
765 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
766 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
767 return;
769 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
770 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
771 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
772 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
773 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
774 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
775 if (for_eh)
777 bool any_eh_needed = false;
779 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
781 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
782 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
783 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
784 any_eh_needed = true;
785 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
786 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
789 if (!any_eh_needed)
790 return;
793 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
794 if (flag_debug_asm)
795 app_enable ();
797 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
798 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
800 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
801 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
803 /* Output the CIE. */
804 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
805 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
806 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
808 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
809 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
810 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
811 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
812 "Length of Common Information Entry");
814 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
816 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
817 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
818 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
819 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
820 "CIE Identifier Tag");
822 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
823 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
824 due to overflowing the return register column. */
825 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
826 dw_cie_version = 1;
827 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
828 dw_cie_version = 3;
829 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
831 augmentation[0] = 0;
832 augmentation_size = 0;
834 personality = current_unit_personality;
835 if (for_eh)
837 char *p;
839 /* Augmentation:
840 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
841 augmentation section.
842 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
843 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
844 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
845 FDE code pointers.
846 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
847 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
849 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
850 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
851 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
853 p = augmentation + 1;
854 if (personality)
856 *p++ = 'P';
857 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
858 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
860 if (any_lsda_needed)
862 *p++ = 'L';
863 augmentation_size += 1;
865 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
867 *p++ = 'R';
868 augmentation_size += 1;
870 if (p > augmentation + 1)
872 augmentation[0] = 'z';
873 *p = '\0';
876 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
877 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
879 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
880 + 4 /* CIE Id */
881 + 1 /* CIE version */
882 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
883 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
884 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
885 + 1 /* RA column */
886 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
887 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
888 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
890 augmentation_size += pad;
892 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
893 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
894 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
898 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
899 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
901 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
905 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
906 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
908 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
909 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
910 else
911 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
913 if (augmentation[0])
915 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
916 if (personality)
918 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
919 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
920 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
921 personality,
922 true, NULL);
925 if (any_lsda_needed)
926 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
927 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
929 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
930 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
931 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
934 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
935 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
937 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
938 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
939 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
940 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
942 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
943 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
945 unsigned int k;
947 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
948 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
949 continue;
951 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
952 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
953 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
956 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
957 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
959 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
960 if (flag_debug_asm)
961 app_disable ();
964 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
966 static void
967 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
969 int enc;
970 rtx ref;
972 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
974 /* .cfi_personality and .cfi_lsda are only relevant to DWARF2
975 eh unwinders. */
976 if (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2)
977 return;
979 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
981 if (personality)
983 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
984 ref = personality;
986 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
987 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
988 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
989 of the weirder relocation types. */
990 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
991 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
993 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
994 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
995 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
998 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
1000 char lab[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1002 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1003 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
1004 current_function_funcdef_no);
1005 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
1006 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
1008 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
1009 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
1011 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
1012 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1013 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1017 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1018 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1020 dw_fde_ref
1021 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1023 dw_fde_ref fde;
1025 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1026 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1027 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1028 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1029 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1030 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1031 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1032 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1033 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1035 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1036 cfun->fde = fde;
1037 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1039 return fde;
1042 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1043 the prologue. */
1045 void
1046 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1047 unsigned int column ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1048 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1050 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1051 char * dup_label;
1052 dw_fde_ref fde;
1053 section *fnsec;
1054 bool do_frame;
1056 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1058 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1060 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1061 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1062 if (!do_frame
1063 && (!flag_exceptions
1064 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1065 return;
1067 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1068 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1069 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1070 current_function_funcdef_no);
1071 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1072 current_function_funcdef_no);
1073 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1074 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1076 /* We can elide FDE allocation if we're not emitting frame unwind info. */
1077 if (!do_frame)
1078 return;
1080 /* Unlike the debug version, the EH version of frame unwind info is a per-
1081 function setting so we need to record whether we need it for the unit. */
1082 do_eh_frame |= dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ();
1084 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1085 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1086 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1087 do so now. */
1088 fde = cfun->fde;
1089 if (fde == NULL)
1090 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1092 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1093 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1094 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1095 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1096 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1098 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1099 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1100 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1101 if (file)
1102 dwarf2out_source_line (line, column, file, 0, true);
1103 #endif
1105 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1106 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1107 else
1109 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1110 if (!current_unit_personality)
1111 current_unit_personality = personality;
1113 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1114 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1115 function anymore. */
1116 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1117 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1118 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1122 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1123 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1124 been generated. */
1126 void
1127 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1128 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1130 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1132 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1133 function. */
1134 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1135 current_function_funcdef_no);
1136 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1137 current_function_funcdef_no);
1138 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1141 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1142 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1143 been generated. */
1145 void
1146 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1147 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1149 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1150 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1152 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1153 return;
1155 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1156 function. */
1157 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1158 current_function_funcdef_no);
1159 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1160 current_function_funcdef_no);
1161 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1164 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1165 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1166 been generated. */
1168 void
1169 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1170 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1172 dw_fde_ref fde;
1173 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1175 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1176 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1178 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1179 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1181 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1182 function. */
1183 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1184 current_function_funcdef_no);
1185 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1186 fde = cfun->fde;
1187 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1188 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1189 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1192 void
1193 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1195 /* Output call frame information. */
1196 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1197 output_call_frame_info (0);
1199 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1200 if (do_eh_frame)
1201 output_call_frame_info (1);
1204 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1206 static void
1207 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1209 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1210 if (sec == text_section)
1211 text_section_used = true;
1212 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1213 cold_text_section_used = true;
1216 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1217 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1219 void
1220 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1222 section *sect;
1223 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1225 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1227 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1229 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1230 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1231 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1233 else
1235 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1236 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1237 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1239 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1241 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1242 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1243 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1245 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1246 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1248 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1249 sect = current_function_section ();
1250 switch_to_section (sect);
1252 fde->second_in_std_section
1253 = (sect == text_section
1254 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1256 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1257 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1259 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1261 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1262 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1265 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1266 for emitting location expressions. */
1268 /* Data about a single source file. */
1269 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1270 const char * filename;
1271 int emitted_number;
1274 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1276 enum ate_kind {
1277 ate_kind_rtx,
1278 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1279 ate_kind_label
1282 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1283 enum ate_kind kind;
1284 unsigned int refcount;
1285 unsigned int index;
1286 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1288 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1289 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1291 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1294 typedef unsigned int var_loc_view;
1296 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1297 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1298 their entire life. */
1299 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1300 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1301 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1302 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1303 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1304 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1305 Only on head of list. */
1306 char *vl_symbol; /* Label for beginning of view list. Ditto. */
1307 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1308 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1309 var_loc_view vbegin, vend;
1310 hashval_t hash;
1311 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1312 resolved. */
1313 bool resolved_addr;
1314 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1315 bool replaced;
1316 /* True if it has been emitted into .debug_loc* / .debug_loclists*
1317 section. */
1318 unsigned char emitted : 1;
1319 /* True if hash field is index rather than hash value. */
1320 unsigned char num_assigned : 1;
1321 /* True if .debug_loclists.dwo offset has been emitted for it already. */
1322 unsigned char offset_emitted : 1;
1323 /* True if note_variable_value_in_expr has been called on it. */
1324 unsigned char noted_variable_value : 1;
1325 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1326 are the same. */
1327 bool force;
1328 } dw_loc_list_node;
1330 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64);
1331 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1333 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1335 static const char *
1336 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1338 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1340 if (name != NULL)
1341 return name;
1343 return "OP_<unknown>";
1346 /* Return TRUE iff we're to output location view lists as a separate
1347 attribute next to the location lists, as an extension compatible
1348 with DWARF 2 and above. */
1350 static inline bool
1351 dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ()
1353 return debug_variable_location_views == 1;
1356 /* Return TRUE iff we're to output location view lists as part of the
1357 location lists, as proposed for standardization after DWARF 5. */
1359 static inline bool
1360 dwarf2out_locviews_in_loclist ()
1362 #ifndef DW_LLE_view_pair
1363 return false;
1364 #else
1365 return debug_variable_location_views == -1;
1366 #endif
1369 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1370 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1371 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1373 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1374 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1375 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1377 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1379 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1380 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1381 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1382 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1383 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1384 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1385 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1387 return descr;
1390 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1392 static inline void
1393 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1395 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1397 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1398 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1401 *d = descr;
1404 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1406 static bool
1407 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1409 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1410 return false;
1411 switch (a->val_class)
1413 case dw_val_class_none:
1414 return true;
1415 case dw_val_class_addr:
1416 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1418 case dw_val_class_offset:
1419 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1420 case dw_val_class_const:
1421 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
1422 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
1423 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1424 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1425 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1427 case dw_val_class_loc:
1428 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1429 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1430 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1431 case dw_val_class_view_list:
1432 return a->v.val_view_list == b->v.val_view_list;
1433 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1434 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1435 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1436 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1437 case dw_val_class_symview:
1438 return strcmp (a->v.val_symbolic_view, b->v.val_symbolic_view) == 0;
1439 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1440 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1441 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1442 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
1443 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1444 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1445 case dw_val_class_str:
1446 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1447 case dw_val_class_flag:
1448 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1449 case dw_val_class_file:
1450 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
1451 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1452 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1453 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1455 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1456 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1457 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1459 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1460 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1462 case dw_val_class_vec:
1464 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1465 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1467 return (a_len == b_len
1468 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1471 case dw_val_class_data8:
1472 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1474 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1475 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1476 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1478 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1479 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1480 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1481 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1482 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1483 return false;
1485 gcc_unreachable ();
1488 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1490 static bool
1491 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1493 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1494 return false;
1496 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1497 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1498 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1499 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1500 return false;
1502 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1503 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1506 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1508 bool
1509 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1511 while (1)
1513 if (a == b)
1514 return true;
1515 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1516 return false;
1517 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1518 return false;
1520 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1521 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1526 /* Add a constant POLY_OFFSET to a location expression. */
1528 static void
1529 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, poly_int64 poly_offset)
1531 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1532 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1534 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1536 if (known_eq (poly_offset, 0))
1537 return;
1539 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1540 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1543 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1544 if (!poly_offset.is_constant (&offset))
1546 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (poly_offset);
1547 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
1548 return;
1551 p = NULL;
1552 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1553 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1554 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1555 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1556 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1558 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1559 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1560 if (p != NULL
1561 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1562 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1563 *p += offset;
1565 else if (offset > 0)
1566 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1568 else
1570 loc->dw_loc_next
1571 = uint_loc_descriptor (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset);
1572 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1576 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1577 REG and OFFSET. */
1579 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1580 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, poly_int64 offset)
1582 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
1583 if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
1585 if (reg <= 31)
1586 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1587 const_offset, 0);
1588 else
1589 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, const_offset);
1591 else
1593 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_reg_loc_descr (reg, 0);
1594 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
1595 return ret;
1599 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1601 static void
1602 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, poly_int64 offset)
1604 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1605 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1606 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1609 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1610 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1612 /* The number of bits that can be encoded by largest DW_FORM_dataN.
1613 In DWARF4 and earlier it is DW_FORM_data8 with 64 bits, in DWARF5
1614 DW_FORM_data16 with 128 bits. */
1615 #define DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS \
1616 (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 128 : 64)
1618 /* Utility inline function for construction of ops that were GNU extension
1619 before DWARF 5. */
1620 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
1621 dwarf_OP (enum dwarf_location_atom op)
1623 switch (op)
1625 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1626 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1627 return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
1628 break;
1630 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1631 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1632 return DW_OP_GNU_entry_value;
1633 break;
1635 case DW_OP_const_type:
1636 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1637 return DW_OP_GNU_const_type;
1638 break;
1640 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1641 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1642 return DW_OP_GNU_regval_type;
1643 break;
1645 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1646 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1647 return DW_OP_GNU_deref_type;
1648 break;
1650 case DW_OP_convert:
1651 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1652 return DW_OP_GNU_convert;
1653 break;
1655 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1656 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1657 return DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret;
1658 break;
1660 case DW_OP_addrx:
1661 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1662 return DW_OP_GNU_addr_index;
1663 break;
1665 case DW_OP_constx:
1666 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1667 return DW_OP_GNU_const_index;
1668 break;
1670 default:
1671 break;
1673 return op;
1676 /* Similarly for attributes. */
1677 static inline enum dwarf_attribute
1678 dwarf_AT (enum dwarf_attribute at)
1680 switch (at)
1682 case DW_AT_call_return_pc:
1683 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1684 return DW_AT_low_pc;
1685 break;
1687 case DW_AT_call_tail_call:
1688 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1689 return DW_AT_GNU_tail_call;
1690 break;
1692 case DW_AT_call_origin:
1693 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1694 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1695 break;
1697 case DW_AT_call_target:
1698 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1699 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target;
1700 break;
1702 case DW_AT_call_target_clobbered:
1703 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1704 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered;
1705 break;
1707 case DW_AT_call_parameter:
1708 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1709 return DW_AT_abstract_origin;
1710 break;
1712 case DW_AT_call_value:
1713 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1714 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value;
1715 break;
1717 case DW_AT_call_data_value:
1718 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1719 return DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value;
1720 break;
1722 case DW_AT_call_all_calls:
1723 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1724 return DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites;
1725 break;
1727 case DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls:
1728 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1729 return DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites;
1730 break;
1732 case DW_AT_dwo_name:
1733 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1734 return DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name;
1735 break;
1737 case DW_AT_addr_base:
1738 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1739 return DW_AT_GNU_addr_base;
1740 break;
1742 default:
1743 break;
1745 return at;
1748 /* And similarly for tags. */
1749 static inline enum dwarf_tag
1750 dwarf_TAG (enum dwarf_tag tag)
1752 switch (tag)
1754 case DW_TAG_call_site:
1755 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1756 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site;
1757 break;
1759 case DW_TAG_call_site_parameter:
1760 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1761 return DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter;
1762 break;
1764 default:
1765 break;
1767 return tag;
1770 /* And similarly for forms. */
1771 static inline enum dwarf_form
1772 dwarf_FORM (enum dwarf_form form)
1774 switch (form)
1776 case DW_FORM_addrx:
1777 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1778 return DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index;
1779 break;
1781 case DW_FORM_strx:
1782 if (dwarf_version < 5)
1783 return DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
1784 break;
1786 default:
1787 break;
1789 return form;
1792 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1794 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1796 static unsigned long
1797 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1799 unsigned long size = 1;
1801 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1803 case DW_OP_addr:
1804 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1805 break;
1806 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1807 case DW_OP_addrx:
1808 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1809 case DW_OP_constx:
1810 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1811 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1812 break;
1813 case DW_OP_const1u:
1814 case DW_OP_const1s:
1815 size += 1;
1816 break;
1817 case DW_OP_const2u:
1818 case DW_OP_const2s:
1819 size += 2;
1820 break;
1821 case DW_OP_const4u:
1822 case DW_OP_const4s:
1823 size += 4;
1824 break;
1825 case DW_OP_const8u:
1826 case DW_OP_const8s:
1827 size += 8;
1828 break;
1829 case DW_OP_constu:
1830 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1831 break;
1832 case DW_OP_consts:
1833 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1834 break;
1835 case DW_OP_pick:
1836 size += 1;
1837 break;
1838 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1839 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1840 break;
1841 case DW_OP_skip:
1842 case DW_OP_bra:
1843 size += 2;
1844 break;
1845 case DW_OP_breg0:
1846 case DW_OP_breg1:
1847 case DW_OP_breg2:
1848 case DW_OP_breg3:
1849 case DW_OP_breg4:
1850 case DW_OP_breg5:
1851 case DW_OP_breg6:
1852 case DW_OP_breg7:
1853 case DW_OP_breg8:
1854 case DW_OP_breg9:
1855 case DW_OP_breg10:
1856 case DW_OP_breg11:
1857 case DW_OP_breg12:
1858 case DW_OP_breg13:
1859 case DW_OP_breg14:
1860 case DW_OP_breg15:
1861 case DW_OP_breg16:
1862 case DW_OP_breg17:
1863 case DW_OP_breg18:
1864 case DW_OP_breg19:
1865 case DW_OP_breg20:
1866 case DW_OP_breg21:
1867 case DW_OP_breg22:
1868 case DW_OP_breg23:
1869 case DW_OP_breg24:
1870 case DW_OP_breg25:
1871 case DW_OP_breg26:
1872 case DW_OP_breg27:
1873 case DW_OP_breg28:
1874 case DW_OP_breg29:
1875 case DW_OP_breg30:
1876 case DW_OP_breg31:
1877 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1878 break;
1879 case DW_OP_regx:
1880 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1881 break;
1882 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1883 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1884 break;
1885 case DW_OP_bregx:
1886 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1887 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1888 break;
1889 case DW_OP_piece:
1890 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1891 break;
1892 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1893 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1894 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1895 break;
1896 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1897 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1898 size += 1;
1899 break;
1900 case DW_OP_call2:
1901 size += 2;
1902 break;
1903 case DW_OP_call4:
1904 size += 4;
1905 break;
1906 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1907 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
1908 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1909 break;
1910 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1911 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1912 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1913 break;
1914 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
1915 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1916 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1917 break;
1918 case DW_OP_entry_value:
1919 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1921 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1922 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1923 break;
1925 case DW_OP_const_type:
1926 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1928 unsigned long o
1929 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1930 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1931 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1933 case dw_val_class_vec:
1934 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1935 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1936 break;
1937 case dw_val_class_const:
1938 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1939 break;
1940 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1941 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1942 break;
1943 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1944 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1945 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1946 break;
1947 default:
1948 gcc_unreachable ();
1950 break;
1952 case DW_OP_regval_type:
1953 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1955 unsigned long o
1956 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1957 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1958 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1960 break;
1961 case DW_OP_deref_type:
1962 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1964 unsigned long o
1965 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1966 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1968 break;
1969 case DW_OP_convert:
1970 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
1971 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1972 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1973 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1974 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1975 else
1977 unsigned long o
1978 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1979 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1981 break;
1982 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1983 size += 4;
1984 break;
1985 default:
1986 break;
1989 return size;
1992 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1994 unsigned long
1995 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1997 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1998 unsigned long size;
2000 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
2001 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
2002 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
2004 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
2005 break;
2006 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
2008 if (! l)
2009 return size;
2011 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
2013 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
2014 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
2017 return size;
2020 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
2022 static int
2023 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
2025 if (discr_value->pos)
2026 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
2027 else
2028 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
2031 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_list attribute. */
2033 static int
2034 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
2036 int size = 0;
2038 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
2039 list != NULL;
2040 list = list->dw_discr_next)
2042 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
2043 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
2044 range label. */
2045 size += 1;
2046 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
2047 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
2048 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
2050 return size;
2053 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
2054 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
2055 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
2057 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2058 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2059 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2060 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2061 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2062 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2064 static void
2065 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2067 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2068 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2070 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2072 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2073 case DW_OP_const2u:
2074 case DW_OP_const2s:
2075 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2076 break;
2077 case DW_OP_const4u:
2078 if (loc->dtprel)
2080 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2081 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
2082 val1->v.val_addr);
2083 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2084 break;
2086 /* FALLTHRU */
2087 case DW_OP_const4s:
2088 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2089 break;
2090 case DW_OP_const8u:
2091 if (loc->dtprel)
2093 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
2094 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
2095 val1->v.val_addr);
2096 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2097 break;
2099 /* FALLTHRU */
2100 case DW_OP_const8s:
2101 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2102 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2103 break;
2104 case DW_OP_skip:
2105 case DW_OP_bra:
2107 int offset;
2109 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2110 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2112 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2114 break;
2115 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2116 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2117 switch (val2->val_class)
2119 case dw_val_class_const:
2120 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2121 break;
2122 case dw_val_class_vec:
2124 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2125 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2126 unsigned int i;
2127 unsigned char *p;
2129 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2131 elt_size /= 2;
2132 len *= 2;
2134 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2135 i < len;
2136 i++, p += elt_size)
2137 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2138 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2140 break;
2141 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2143 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2145 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2147 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2148 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2150 else
2152 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2153 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2155 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2156 first, NULL);
2157 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2158 second, NULL);
2160 break;
2161 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2163 int i;
2164 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2165 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2166 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2167 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2168 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2169 else
2170 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2171 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
2172 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2174 break;
2175 case dw_val_class_addr:
2176 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
2177 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
2178 break;
2179 default:
2180 gcc_unreachable ();
2182 break;
2183 #else
2184 case DW_OP_const2u:
2185 case DW_OP_const2s:
2186 case DW_OP_const4u:
2187 case DW_OP_const4s:
2188 case DW_OP_const8u:
2189 case DW_OP_const8s:
2190 case DW_OP_skip:
2191 case DW_OP_bra:
2192 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2193 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2194 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2195 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2196 only doing unwinding. */
2197 gcc_unreachable ();
2198 #endif
2199 case DW_OP_const1u:
2200 case DW_OP_const1s:
2201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2202 break;
2203 case DW_OP_constu:
2204 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2205 break;
2206 case DW_OP_consts:
2207 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2208 break;
2209 case DW_OP_pick:
2210 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2211 break;
2212 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2213 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2214 break;
2215 case DW_OP_breg0:
2216 case DW_OP_breg1:
2217 case DW_OP_breg2:
2218 case DW_OP_breg3:
2219 case DW_OP_breg4:
2220 case DW_OP_breg5:
2221 case DW_OP_breg6:
2222 case DW_OP_breg7:
2223 case DW_OP_breg8:
2224 case DW_OP_breg9:
2225 case DW_OP_breg10:
2226 case DW_OP_breg11:
2227 case DW_OP_breg12:
2228 case DW_OP_breg13:
2229 case DW_OP_breg14:
2230 case DW_OP_breg15:
2231 case DW_OP_breg16:
2232 case DW_OP_breg17:
2233 case DW_OP_breg18:
2234 case DW_OP_breg19:
2235 case DW_OP_breg20:
2236 case DW_OP_breg21:
2237 case DW_OP_breg22:
2238 case DW_OP_breg23:
2239 case DW_OP_breg24:
2240 case DW_OP_breg25:
2241 case DW_OP_breg26:
2242 case DW_OP_breg27:
2243 case DW_OP_breg28:
2244 case DW_OP_breg29:
2245 case DW_OP_breg30:
2246 case DW_OP_breg31:
2247 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2248 break;
2249 case DW_OP_regx:
2251 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2252 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2253 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2254 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2255 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2256 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2258 break;
2259 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2260 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2261 break;
2262 case DW_OP_bregx:
2264 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2265 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2266 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2267 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2268 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2269 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2270 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2272 break;
2273 case DW_OP_piece:
2274 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2275 break;
2276 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2277 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2278 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2279 break;
2280 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2281 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2282 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2283 break;
2285 case DW_OP_addr:
2286 if (loc->dtprel)
2288 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2290 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2291 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2292 val1->v.val_addr);
2293 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2295 else
2296 gcc_unreachable ();
2298 else
2300 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2301 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2302 #else
2303 gcc_unreachable ();
2304 #endif
2306 break;
2308 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2309 case DW_OP_addrx:
2310 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2311 case DW_OP_constx:
2312 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2313 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2314 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2315 break;
2317 case DW_OP_call2:
2318 case DW_OP_call4:
2320 unsigned long die_offset
2321 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2322 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2323 an operand. */
2324 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2325 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2
2326 ? 0xffff
2327 : 0xffffffff));
2328 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2329 die_offset, NULL);
2331 break;
2333 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2334 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
2336 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2337 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2338 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2339 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2340 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2342 break;
2344 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2345 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2347 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2348 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2349 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2350 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2351 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2352 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2354 break;
2356 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2357 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2358 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2359 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2360 break;
2362 case DW_OP_const_type:
2363 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2365 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2366 gcc_assert (o);
2367 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2368 switch (val2->val_class)
2370 case dw_val_class_const:
2371 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2372 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2373 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2374 break;
2375 case dw_val_class_vec:
2377 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2378 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2379 unsigned int i;
2380 unsigned char *p;
2382 l = len * elt_size;
2383 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2384 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2386 elt_size /= 2;
2387 len *= 2;
2389 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) val2->v.val_vec.array;
2390 i < len;
2391 i++, p += elt_size)
2392 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2393 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2395 break;
2396 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2398 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2399 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2401 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2402 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2404 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2405 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2407 else
2409 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2410 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2412 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2413 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2415 break;
2416 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2418 int i;
2419 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2420 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2422 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2423 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2424 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2425 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2426 else
2427 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2428 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2430 break;
2431 default:
2432 gcc_unreachable ();
2435 break;
2436 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2437 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2439 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2440 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2441 gcc_assert (o);
2442 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2444 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2445 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2446 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2448 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2449 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2451 break;
2452 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2453 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2455 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2456 gcc_assert (o);
2457 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2458 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2460 break;
2461 case DW_OP_convert:
2462 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2463 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2464 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2465 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2466 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2467 else
2469 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2470 gcc_assert (o);
2471 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2473 break;
2475 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2477 unsigned long o;
2478 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2479 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2480 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2482 break;
2484 default:
2485 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2486 break;
2490 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2491 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2492 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2493 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2494 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2495 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2497 void
2498 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2500 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2502 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2503 /* Output the opcode. */
2504 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2505 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2507 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2508 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2509 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2510 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2512 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2513 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2515 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2516 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2517 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2518 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2521 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2522 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2524 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2525 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2529 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2530 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2532 static void
2533 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2535 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2536 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2538 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2540 case DW_OP_addr:
2541 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2542 case DW_OP_addrx:
2543 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2544 case DW_OP_constx:
2545 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2546 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2547 gcc_unreachable ();
2549 case DW_OP_const1u:
2550 case DW_OP_const1s:
2551 case DW_OP_pick:
2552 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2553 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2554 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2555 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2556 break;
2558 case DW_OP_const2u:
2559 case DW_OP_const2s:
2560 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2561 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2562 break;
2564 case DW_OP_const4u:
2565 case DW_OP_const4s:
2566 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2567 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2568 break;
2570 case DW_OP_const8u:
2571 case DW_OP_const8s:
2572 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2573 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2574 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2575 break;
2577 case DW_OP_skip:
2578 case DW_OP_bra:
2580 int offset;
2582 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2583 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2585 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2586 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2588 break;
2590 case DW_OP_regx:
2592 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2593 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2594 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2595 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2596 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2598 break;
2600 case DW_OP_constu:
2601 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2602 case DW_OP_piece:
2603 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2604 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2605 break;
2607 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2608 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2609 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2610 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2611 break;
2613 case DW_OP_consts:
2614 case DW_OP_breg0:
2615 case DW_OP_breg1:
2616 case DW_OP_breg2:
2617 case DW_OP_breg3:
2618 case DW_OP_breg4:
2619 case DW_OP_breg5:
2620 case DW_OP_breg6:
2621 case DW_OP_breg7:
2622 case DW_OP_breg8:
2623 case DW_OP_breg9:
2624 case DW_OP_breg10:
2625 case DW_OP_breg11:
2626 case DW_OP_breg12:
2627 case DW_OP_breg13:
2628 case DW_OP_breg14:
2629 case DW_OP_breg15:
2630 case DW_OP_breg16:
2631 case DW_OP_breg17:
2632 case DW_OP_breg18:
2633 case DW_OP_breg19:
2634 case DW_OP_breg20:
2635 case DW_OP_breg21:
2636 case DW_OP_breg22:
2637 case DW_OP_breg23:
2638 case DW_OP_breg24:
2639 case DW_OP_breg25:
2640 case DW_OP_breg26:
2641 case DW_OP_breg27:
2642 case DW_OP_breg28:
2643 case DW_OP_breg29:
2644 case DW_OP_breg30:
2645 case DW_OP_breg31:
2646 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2647 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2648 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2649 break;
2651 case DW_OP_bregx:
2653 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2654 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2655 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2656 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2657 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2658 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2659 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2661 break;
2663 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
2664 case DW_OP_entry_value:
2665 case DW_OP_const_type:
2666 case DW_OP_regval_type:
2667 case DW_OP_deref_type:
2668 case DW_OP_convert:
2669 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
2670 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2671 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2672 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2673 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2674 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2675 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2676 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2677 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2678 gcc_unreachable ();
2679 break;
2681 default:
2682 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2683 break;
2687 void
2688 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2690 while (1)
2692 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2693 /* Output the opcode. */
2694 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2696 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2697 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2698 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2699 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2701 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2703 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2704 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2705 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2706 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2708 /* Output the opcode. */
2709 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2710 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2712 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2713 break;
2714 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2716 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2720 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2721 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2722 expression. */
2724 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2725 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, poly_int64 offset)
2727 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2729 offset += cfa->offset;
2731 if (cfa->indirect)
2733 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2734 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2735 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2736 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2737 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2738 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2740 else
2741 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2743 return head;
2746 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2747 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2748 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2750 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2751 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2752 poly_int64 offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2754 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2755 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2756 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2758 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2759 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2761 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2762 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2763 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2764 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2766 else
2767 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2768 return head;
2771 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2773 /* .debug_str support. */
2775 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2776 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2777 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *);
2778 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2779 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2780 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2781 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2782 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2783 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2784 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2785 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2786 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2787 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2788 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2789 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2790 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool, bool);
2791 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2792 dw_die_ref);
2793 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2794 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2795 static void dwarf2out_inline_entry (tree);
2796 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2797 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2798 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2799 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2800 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2801 static void dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
2802 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off);
2803 static bool dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
2804 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off);
2806 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2808 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2810 dwarf2out_init,
2811 dwarf2out_finish,
2812 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2813 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2814 dwarf2out_define,
2815 dwarf2out_undef,
2816 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2817 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2818 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2819 dwarf2out_end_block,
2820 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2821 dwarf2out_source_line,
2822 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2823 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2824 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2825 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2826 #else
2827 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2828 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2829 #endif
2830 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2831 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2832 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2833 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2834 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2835 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2836 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2837 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2838 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2839 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl,
2840 dwarf2out_register_external_die,
2841 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2842 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2843 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2844 something tries to reference them. */
2845 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2846 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2847 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2848 dwarf2out_var_location,
2849 dwarf2out_inline_entry, /* inline_entry */
2850 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2851 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2852 dwarf2out_set_name,
2853 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2854 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2857 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2859 dwarf2out_init,
2860 debug_nothing_charstar,
2861 debug_nothing_charstar,
2862 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2863 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2864 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2865 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2866 debug_nothing_int,
2867 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2868 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2869 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2870 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2871 debug_nothing_int_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2872 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2873 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2874 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2875 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2876 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2877 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2878 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2879 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2880 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2881 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2882 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool_bool,/* imported_module_or_decl */
2883 debug_false_tree_charstarstar_uhwistar,/* die_ref_for_decl */
2884 debug_nothing_tree_charstar_uhwi, /* register_external_die */
2885 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2886 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2887 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2888 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2889 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2890 debug_nothing_tree, /* inline_entry */
2891 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2892 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2893 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2894 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2895 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2898 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2899 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2900 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2902 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2903 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2904 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2905 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2907 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2908 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2909 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2910 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2911 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2912 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2913 yet. For Dwarf V5 or higher .debug_types doesn't exist any more,
2914 it is DW_UT_type unit type in .debug_info section. */
2916 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2918 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2919 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2921 typedef long int dw_offset;
2923 struct comdat_type_node;
2925 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2926 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2927 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2928 supported. */
2930 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2931 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2932 LI_set_address,
2934 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2935 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2936 special opcodes. */
2937 LI_set_line,
2939 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2940 LI_set_file,
2942 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2943 LI_set_column,
2945 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2946 LI_negate_stmt,
2948 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2949 LI_set_prologue_end,
2950 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2952 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2953 LI_set_discriminator,
2955 /* Output a Fixed Advance PC; the target PC is the label index; the
2956 base PC is the previous LI_adv_address or LI_set_address entry.
2957 We only use this when emitting debug views without assembler
2958 support, at explicit user request. Ideally, we should only use
2959 it when the offset might be zero but we can't tell: it's the only
2960 way to maybe change the PC without resetting the view number. */
2961 LI_adv_address
2964 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2965 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2966 unsigned int val;
2967 } dw_line_info_entry;
2970 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2971 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2972 const char *end_label;
2974 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2975 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2976 unsigned int file_num;
2977 unsigned int line_num;
2978 unsigned int column_num;
2979 int discrim_num;
2980 bool is_stmt;
2981 bool in_use;
2983 /* This denotes the NEXT view number.
2985 If it is 0, it is known that the NEXT view will be the first view
2986 at the given PC.
2988 If it is -1, we're forcing the view number to be reset, e.g. at a
2989 function entry.
2991 The meaning of other nonzero values depends on whether we're
2992 computing views internally or leaving it for the assembler to do
2993 so. If we're emitting them internally, view denotes the view
2994 number since the last known advance of PC. If we're leaving it
2995 for the assembler, it denotes the LVU label number that we're
2996 going to ask the assembler to assign. */
2997 var_loc_view view;
2999 /* This counts the number of symbolic views emitted in this table
3000 since the latest view reset. Its max value, over all tables,
3001 sets symview_upper_bound. */
3002 var_loc_view symviews_since_reset;
3004 #define FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW(x) ((x) = (var_loc_view)-1)
3005 #define RESET_NEXT_VIEW(x) ((x) = (var_loc_view)0)
3006 #define FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P(x) ((x) == (var_loc_view)-1)
3007 #define RESETTING_VIEW_P(x) ((x) == (var_loc_view)0 || FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (x))
3009 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
3012 /* This is an upper bound for view numbers that the assembler may
3013 assign to symbolic views output in this translation. It is used to
3014 decide how big a field to use to represent view numbers in
3015 symview-classed attributes. */
3017 static var_loc_view symview_upper_bound;
3019 /* If we're keep track of location views and their reset points, and
3020 INSN is a reset point (i.e., it necessarily advances the PC), mark
3021 the next view in TABLE as reset. */
3023 static void
3024 maybe_reset_location_view (rtx_insn *insn, dw_line_info_table *table)
3026 if (!debug_internal_reset_location_views)
3027 return;
3029 /* Maybe turn (part of?) this test into a default target hook. */
3030 int reset = 0;
3032 if (targetm.reset_location_view)
3033 reset = targetm.reset_location_view (insn);
3035 if (reset)
3037 else if (JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn))
3038 reset = 1;
3039 else if (GET_CODE (insn) == USE
3040 || GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER
3041 || GET_CODE (insn) == ASM_INPUT
3042 || asm_noperands (insn) >= 0)
3044 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) > 0)
3045 reset = 1;
3047 if (reset > 0 && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
3048 RESET_NEXT_VIEW (table->view);
3051 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3052 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3053 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3055 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
3056 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3057 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3059 dw_attr_node;
3062 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3063 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3064 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3066 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
3067 union die_symbol_or_type_node
3069 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
3070 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
3072 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
3073 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
3074 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3075 dw_die_ref die_child;
3076 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3077 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3078 dw_offset die_offset;
3079 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3080 int die_mark;
3081 unsigned int decl_id;
3082 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3083 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3084 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
3085 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
3086 /* For an external ref to die_symbol if die_offset contains an extra
3087 offset to that symbol. */
3088 BOOL_BITFIELD with_offset : 1;
3089 /* Whether this DIE was removed from the DIE tree, for example via
3090 prune_unused_types. We don't consider those present from the
3091 DIE lookup routines. */
3092 BOOL_BITFIELD removed : 1;
3093 /* Lots of spare bits. */
3095 die_node;
3097 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
3098 static bool early_dwarf;
3099 static bool early_dwarf_finished;
3100 struct set_early_dwarf {
3101 bool saved;
3102 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf)
3104 gcc_assert (! early_dwarf_finished);
3105 early_dwarf = true;
3107 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
3110 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3111 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3112 c = die->die_child; \
3113 if (c) do { \
3114 c = c->die_sib; \
3115 expr; \
3116 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3117 } while (0)
3119 /* The pubname structure */
3121 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
3122 dw_die_ref die;
3123 const char *name;
3125 pubname_entry;
3128 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
3129 const char *label;
3130 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
3131 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
3132 int num;
3133 /* Index for the range list for DW_FORM_rnglistx. */
3134 unsigned int idx : 31;
3135 /* True if this range might be possibly in a different section
3136 from previous entry. */
3137 unsigned int maybe_new_sec : 1;
3140 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
3142 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
3143 unsigned char code;
3144 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
3145 const char *info;
3147 macinfo_entry;
3150 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
3151 const char *begin;
3152 const char *end;
3155 /* The comdat type node structure. */
3156 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
3158 dw_die_ref root_die;
3159 dw_die_ref type_die;
3160 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
3161 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
3162 comdat_type_node *next;
3165 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
3166 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
3167 missing bits. */
3168 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
3169 dw_die_ref die;
3170 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
3171 determine ancestry later. */
3172 tree created_for;
3173 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3175 limbo_die_node;
3177 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
3179 dw_die_ref old_die;
3180 dw_die_ref new_die;
3181 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
3183 skeleton_chain_node;
3185 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3186 implicitly generated for a type.
3188 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
3189 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
3190 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
3191 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3192 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3193 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
3194 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
3196 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3197 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3198 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3199 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3200 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3201 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3202 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3203 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3204 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3206 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3207 language, and compiler version. */
3209 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3210 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3211 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE \
3212 + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 4 : 3))
3214 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
3215 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3216 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3217 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3219 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF skeleton compilation unit header. */
3220 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE \
3221 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + (dwarf_version >= 5 ? 8 : 0))
3223 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3224 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3226 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3227 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3228 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3229 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3230 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3232 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3233 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3234 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3235 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3236 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3237 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3239 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3240 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3241 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3242 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3243 #else
3244 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3245 #endif
3246 #endif
3248 /* Use assembler views in line directives if available. */
3249 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3250 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_VIEW
3251 #define DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO 1
3252 #else
3253 #define DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO 0
3254 #endif
3255 #endif
3257 /* Return true if GCC configure detected assembler support for .loc. */
3259 bool
3260 dwarf2out_default_as_loc_support (void)
3262 return DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO;
3263 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
3264 # undef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3265 # pragma GCC poison DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3266 #endif
3269 /* Return true if GCC configure detected assembler support for views
3270 in .loc directives. */
3272 bool
3273 dwarf2out_default_as_locview_support (void)
3275 return DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO;
3276 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
3277 # undef DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3278 # pragma GCC poison DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
3279 #endif
3282 /* A bit is set in ZERO_VIEW_P if we are using the assembler-supported
3283 view computation, and it refers to a view identifier for which we
3284 will not emit a label because it is known to map to a view number
3285 zero. We won't allocate the bitmap if we're not using assembler
3286 support for location views, but we have to make the variable
3287 visible for GGC and for code that will be optimized out for lack of
3288 support but that's still parsed and compiled. We could abstract it
3289 out with macros, but it's not worth it. */
3290 static GTY(()) bitmap zero_view_p;
3292 /* Evaluate to TRUE iff N is known to identify the first location view
3293 at its PC. When not using assembler location view computation,
3294 that must be view number zero. Otherwise, ZERO_VIEW_P is allocated
3295 and views label numbers recorded in it are the ones known to be
3296 zero. */
3297 #define ZERO_VIEW_P(N) ((N) == (var_loc_view)0 \
3298 || (N) == (var_loc_view)-1 \
3299 || (zero_view_p \
3300 && bitmap_bit_p (zero_view_p, (N))))
3302 /* Return true iff we're to emit .loc directives for the assembler to
3303 generate line number sections.
3305 When we're not emitting views, all we need from the assembler is
3306 support for .loc directives.
3308 If we are emitting views, we can only use the assembler's .loc
3309 support if it also supports views.
3311 When the compiler is emitting the line number programs and
3312 computing view numbers itself, it resets view numbers at known PC
3313 changes and counts from that, and then it emits view numbers as
3314 literal constants in locviewlists. There are cases in which the
3315 compiler is not sure about PC changes, e.g. when extra alignment is
3316 requested for a label. In these cases, the compiler may not reset
3317 the view counter, and the potential PC advance in the line number
3318 program will use an opcode that does not reset the view counter
3319 even if the PC actually changes, so that compiler and debug info
3320 consumer can keep view numbers in sync.
3322 When the compiler defers view computation to the assembler, it
3323 emits symbolic view numbers in locviewlists, with the exception of
3324 views known to be zero (forced resets, or reset after
3325 compiler-visible PC changes): instead of emitting symbols for
3326 these, we emit literal zero and assert the assembler agrees with
3327 the compiler's assessment. We could use symbolic views everywhere,
3328 instead of special-casing zero views, but then we'd be unable to
3329 optimize out locviewlists that contain only zeros. */
3331 static bool
3332 output_asm_line_debug_info (void)
3334 return (dwarf2out_as_loc_support
3335 && (dwarf2out_as_locview_support
3336 || !debug_variable_location_views));
3339 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3340 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3341 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3343 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3344 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
3346 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3347 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3349 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3350 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3351 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3352 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3353 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3355 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
3356 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
3357 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
3358 #endif
3360 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3361 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3362 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3364 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3365 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
3367 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
3368 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
3370 /* A list of CU DIEs that have been separated. */
3371 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *cu_die_list;
3373 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3374 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3376 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
3377 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
3378 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
3380 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
3382 typedef const char *compare_type;
3384 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
3385 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
3388 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3389 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
3391 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
3393 typedef tree compare_type;
3395 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
3396 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
3398 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3399 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3400 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
3402 struct GTY ((for_user)) variable_value_struct {
3403 unsigned int decl_id;
3404 vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *dies;
3407 struct variable_value_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<variable_value_struct>
3409 typedef tree compare_type;
3411 static hashval_t hash (variable_value_struct *);
3412 static bool equal (variable_value_struct *, tree);
3414 /* A hash table of DIEs that contain DW_OP_GNU_variable_value with
3415 dw_val_class_decl_ref class, indexed by FUNCTION_DECLs which is
3416 DECL_CONTEXT of the referenced VAR_DECLs. */
3417 static GTY (()) hash_table<variable_value_hasher> *variable_value_hash;
3419 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
3421 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
3422 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
3425 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
3426 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
3427 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
3429 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
3430 dw_die_ref die;
3431 tree arg;
3432 } die_arg_entry;
3435 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3436 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
3437 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
3438 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
3439 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
3440 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
3441 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
3442 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
3443 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
3444 NULL as second operand. */
3445 rtx GTY (()) loc;
3446 const char * GTY (()) label;
3447 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3448 var_loc_view view;
3451 /* Variable location list. */
3452 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
3453 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3455 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
3456 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
3457 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
3458 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
3459 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
3460 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
3461 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3463 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
3464 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
3465 is after section switch. */
3466 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
3468 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3469 unsigned int decl_id;
3471 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3473 /* Call argument location list. */
3474 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
3475 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
3476 const char * GTY (()) label;
3477 tree GTY (()) block;
3478 bool tail_call_p;
3479 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
3480 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3484 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
3486 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3488 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
3489 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
3492 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3493 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
3495 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
3496 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
3497 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
3499 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
3500 static int call_site_count = -1;
3501 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
3502 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
3504 /* A cached location list. */
3505 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
3506 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
3507 unsigned int decl_id;
3509 /* The cached location list. */
3510 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3512 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3514 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3517 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3519 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3520 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3523 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3524 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3526 /* A vector of references to DIE's that are uniquely identified by their tag,
3527 presence/absence of children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3528 static GTY(()) vec<dw_die_ref, va_gc> *abbrev_die_table;
3530 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3531 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3532 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3533 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3534 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3536 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3537 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3539 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3540 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3541 assembly for the function. */
3542 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3544 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3545 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3546 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3548 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3549 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3551 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3552 refer to. */
3553 static bool info_section_emitted;
3555 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3556 accessible names. */
3557 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3559 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3560 accessible types. */
3561 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3563 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3564 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3565 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3567 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3568 emitted. */
3569 #define have_macinfo \
3570 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3571 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3572 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3574 /* Vector of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3575 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges, va_gc> *ranges_table;
3577 /* Vector of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3578 static GTY (()) vec<dw_ranges_by_label, va_gc> *ranges_by_label;
3580 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3581 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3583 /* Unique label counter. */
3584 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3586 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3587 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3589 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3590 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3592 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3593 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3595 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3597 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3598 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3599 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3600 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3601 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3603 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3604 within the current function. */
3605 static poly_int64 frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3606 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3608 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3610 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3611 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3612 enum dw_scalar_form
3614 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3615 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3616 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3619 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3621 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3622 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3623 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3624 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3625 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3626 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3627 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3628 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3629 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3630 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3631 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3632 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3633 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3634 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3635 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3636 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3637 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3638 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3639 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3640 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3641 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3642 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3643 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3644 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3645 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3646 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3647 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3648 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3649 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3650 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3651 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3652 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3653 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3654 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3655 dw_loc_list_ref);
3656 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3657 static void add_AT_view_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3658 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3659 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3660 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3661 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3662 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3663 static void add_AT_symview (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3664 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3665 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3666 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3667 static void add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3668 const char *);
3669 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3670 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3671 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3672 unsigned long, bool);
3673 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3674 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3675 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3676 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3677 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3678 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3679 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3680 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3681 static bool is_cxx (void);
3682 static bool is_cxx (const_tree);
3683 static bool is_fortran (void);
3684 static bool is_ada (void);
3685 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3686 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3687 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3688 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3689 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3690 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3691 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3692 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3693 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3694 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3695 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3696 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *, var_loc_view);
3697 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3698 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3699 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3700 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3701 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3702 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3703 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3704 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3705 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3706 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3707 struct checksum_attributes;
3708 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3709 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3710 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3711 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3712 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3713 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3714 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3715 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3716 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3717 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3718 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3719 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3720 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3721 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3722 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3723 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3724 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3725 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3726 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3727 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3728 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3729 dw_die_ref,
3730 dw_die_ref);
3731 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3732 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3734 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3735 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3736 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3737 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3738 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3739 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3740 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3741 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3742 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3743 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3744 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3745 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3746 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3747 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3748 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3749 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3750 static void output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type);
3751 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int, const unsigned char *);
3752 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3753 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3754 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3755 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3756 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3757 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3758 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3759 static void output_aranges (void);
3760 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree, bool = false);
3761 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3762 bool *, bool);
3763 static void output_ranges (void);
3764 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3765 static void output_line_info (bool);
3766 static void output_file_names (void);
3767 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree, bool);
3768 static int is_base_type (tree);
3769 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3770 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3771 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3772 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3773 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3774 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3775 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3776 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3777 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3778 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3779 enum var_init_status);
3780 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3781 enum var_init_status);
3782 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, poly_int64,
3783 enum var_init_status);
3784 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3785 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3786 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3787 enum var_init_status);
3788 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3789 enum var_init_status);
3790 struct loc_descr_context;
3791 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3792 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3793 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3794 struct loc_descr_context *);
3795 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3796 struct loc_descr_context *);
3797 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3798 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3799 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3800 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3801 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3802 struct vlr_context;
3803 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3804 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3805 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3806 dw_loc_list_ref);
3807 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3808 struct vlr_context *);
3809 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3810 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3811 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3812 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3813 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3814 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3815 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3816 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3817 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3818 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3819 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3820 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3821 struct loc_descr_context *);
3822 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3823 struct loc_descr_context *);
3824 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3825 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3826 static void add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3827 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3828 struct vlr_context *);
3829 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3830 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3831 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3832 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3833 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3834 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree, bool = false);
3835 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3836 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3837 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3838 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3839 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3840 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3841 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3842 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3843 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3844 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, bool, dw_die_ref);
3845 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3846 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3847 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3848 #if 0
3849 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3850 #endif
3851 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3852 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3853 #if 0
3854 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3855 #endif
3856 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3857 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3858 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3859 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3860 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3861 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3862 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3863 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3864 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3865 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3866 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3867 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3868 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3869 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3870 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3871 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3872 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3873 enum debug_info_usage);
3874 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3875 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3876 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3877 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3878 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3879 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3880 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3881 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3882 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3883 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3884 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3885 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3886 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3887 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3888 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3889 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3890 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3891 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3892 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3893 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3894 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3895 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3896 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *, var_loc_view,
3897 const char *, var_loc_view, const char *);
3898 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3899 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3900 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3902 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3903 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3904 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3905 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3906 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3907 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3908 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3909 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3910 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3911 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3912 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3913 const char *, const char *);
3914 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3915 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3916 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3917 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3918 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3919 static void resolve_variable_values (void);
3921 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3923 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3925 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3926 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3927 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3929 enum dtprel_bool
3931 dtprel_false = 0,
3932 dtprel_true = 1
3935 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3936 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3937 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3938 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3940 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3941 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3943 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3944 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? dwarf_OP (DW_OP_constx)
3945 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3946 else
3947 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? dwarf_OP (DW_OP_addrx) : DW_OP_addr;
3950 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3951 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3952 relocation. */
3953 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3954 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3956 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3958 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3959 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3960 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3961 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3962 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3963 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3964 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3965 else
3966 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3968 return ref;
3971 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3973 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3974 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3975 #endif
3976 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3977 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3978 #endif
3979 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION
3980 #define DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info"
3981 #endif
3982 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3983 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_info.dwo"
3984 #endif
3985 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3986 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3987 #endif
3988 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION
3989 #define DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev"
3990 #endif
3991 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3992 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3993 #endif
3994 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3995 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_abbrev.dwo"
3996 #endif
3997 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3998 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3999 #endif
4000 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
4001 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
4002 #endif
4003 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4004 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4005 #endif
4006 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION
4007 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo"
4008 #endif
4009 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
4010 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
4011 #endif
4012 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
4013 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macinfo.dwo"
4014 #endif
4015 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
4016 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
4017 #endif
4018 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION
4019 #define DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro"
4020 #endif
4021 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
4022 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
4023 #endif
4024 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
4025 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_macro.dwo"
4026 #endif
4027 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4028 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4029 #endif
4030 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION
4031 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line"
4032 #endif
4033 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
4034 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
4035 #endif
4036 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION
4037 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line.dwo"
4038 #endif
4039 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4040 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4041 #endif
4042 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
4043 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
4044 #endif
4045 #ifndef DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
4046 #define DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists"
4047 #endif
4048 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
4049 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION ".debug_loclists.dwo"
4050 #endif
4051 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4052 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
4053 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
4054 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
4055 #endif
4056 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
4057 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
4058 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
4059 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
4060 #endif
4061 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4062 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
4063 #endif
4064 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4065 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
4066 #endif
4067 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
4068 #define DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str_offsets.dwo"
4069 #endif
4070 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4071 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4072 #endif
4073 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION
4074 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str"
4075 #endif
4076 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
4077 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
4078 #endif
4079 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION
4080 #define DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_str.dwo"
4081 #endif
4082 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4083 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4084 #endif
4085 #ifndef DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
4086 #define DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION ".debug_rnglists"
4087 #endif
4088 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION
4089 #define DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION ".debug_line_str"
4090 #endif
4091 #ifndef DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION
4092 #define DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_line_str"
4093 #endif
4095 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4096 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4097 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4098 #endif
4100 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4101 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4102 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
4103 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4104 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4106 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
4107 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
4109 /* Attribute used to refer to the macro section. */
4110 #define DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_AT_macros \
4111 : dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros)
4113 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4114 the section names themselves. */
4116 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4117 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4118 #endif
4119 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4120 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4121 #endif
4122 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4123 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4124 #endif
4125 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4126 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
4127 #endif
4128 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4129 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4130 #endif
4131 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4132 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
4133 #endif
4134 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4135 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4136 #endif
4137 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4138 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
4139 #endif
4140 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
4141 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
4142 #endif
4143 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4144 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4145 #endif
4146 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4147 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4148 #endif
4149 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4150 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4151 #endif
4152 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
4153 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
4154 #endif
4155 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
4156 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
4158 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4159 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4160 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4161 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4162 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4164 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4165 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4166 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4167 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4168 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4169 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4170 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4171 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4172 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4173 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4174 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4175 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4176 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4177 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4178 static char ranges_base_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4180 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4181 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4182 #endif
4183 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4184 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4185 #endif
4186 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4187 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4188 #endif
4189 #ifndef BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL
4190 #define BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL "LBI"
4191 #endif
4192 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4193 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4194 #endif
4195 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4196 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4197 #endif
4200 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
4201 static dw_die_ref
4202 comp_unit_die (void)
4204 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
4205 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
4206 return single_comp_unit_die;
4209 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4210 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4212 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4214 void
4215 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4217 demangle_name_func = func;
4220 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4222 static inline int
4223 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
4225 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4226 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4227 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4230 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4231 removed. */
4233 static inline tree
4234 type_main_variant (tree type)
4236 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4238 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4239 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4240 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4241 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4242 here. */
4243 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4244 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4245 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4247 return type;
4250 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4252 static inline int
4253 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
4255 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4257 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4258 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4261 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
4263 static void
4264 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
4266 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
4269 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
4271 static unsigned long int
4272 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4274 if (ref->die_offset)
4275 return ref->die_offset;
4276 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
4278 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
4279 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4281 return ref->die_offset;
4284 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
4286 static unsigned long int
4287 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
4289 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
4290 return ref->die_offset;
4293 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4295 static const char *
4296 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4298 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
4300 if (name != NULL)
4301 return name;
4303 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4306 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4308 static const char *
4309 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4311 const char *name;
4313 switch (attr)
4315 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4316 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
4317 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
4318 #else
4319 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4320 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4321 #endif
4323 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4324 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
4325 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
4326 #else
4327 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4328 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4329 #endif
4332 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
4334 if (name != NULL)
4335 return name;
4337 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4340 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4342 static const char *
4343 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4345 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
4347 if (name != NULL)
4348 return name;
4350 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4353 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4354 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4355 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4356 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4357 given block. */
4359 static tree
4360 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4362 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4363 return NULL_TREE;
4365 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
4366 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4367 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4368 return NULL_TREE;
4370 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4371 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4372 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4374 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4377 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4378 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4379 parameter. */
4381 static tree
4382 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4384 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4386 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4387 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4388 else
4389 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4390 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4392 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4393 context = NULL_TREE;
4395 return context;
4398 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4400 static inline void
4401 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
4403 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4404 if (die == NULL)
4405 return;
4407 if (flag_checking)
4409 /* Check we do not add duplicate attrs. Can't use get_AT here
4410 because that recurses to the specification/abstract origin DIE. */
4411 dw_attr_node *a;
4412 unsigned ix;
4413 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4414 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != attr->dw_attr);
4417 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
4418 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
4421 static inline enum dw_val_class
4422 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
4424 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4427 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
4428 DW_FORM_addrx/GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_strx/GNU_str_index. String
4429 indices are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
4430 pruning. */
4432 static inline unsigned int
4433 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
4435 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4436 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
4437 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
4438 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
4439 return NOT_INDEXED;
4442 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4444 static inline void
4445 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4447 dw_attr_node attr;
4449 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4450 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4451 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4452 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4453 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4456 static inline unsigned
4457 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
4459 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4460 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4463 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4465 static inline void
4466 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4468 dw_attr_node attr;
4470 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4471 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4472 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4473 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4474 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4477 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4478 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
4480 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const
4481 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const_implicit));
4482 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4485 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4487 static inline void
4488 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4489 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4491 dw_attr_node attr;
4493 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4494 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4495 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4496 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4497 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4500 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4501 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
4503 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
4504 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit));
4505 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4508 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4510 static inline void
4511 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4512 const wide_int& w)
4514 dw_attr_node attr;
4516 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4517 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
4518 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4519 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
4520 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
4521 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4524 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4526 static inline void
4527 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4528 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
4530 dw_attr_node attr;
4532 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4533 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
4534 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4535 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
4536 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
4537 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4540 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4542 static inline void
4543 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4544 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4546 dw_attr_node attr;
4548 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4549 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4550 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4551 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4552 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4553 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4554 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4557 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4559 static inline void
4560 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4561 unsigned char data8[8])
4563 dw_attr_node attr;
4565 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4566 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4567 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4568 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4569 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4572 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4573 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4574 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4575 references. */
4577 static inline void
4578 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4579 bool force_direct)
4581 dw_attr_node attr;
4582 char * lbl_id;
4584 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4585 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4586 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4587 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4588 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4589 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4590 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4591 else
4592 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4593 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4595 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4596 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4597 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4598 else
4599 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4600 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4601 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4602 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4603 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4604 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4605 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4606 else
4607 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4608 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4611 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4613 hashval_t
4614 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4616 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4619 bool
4620 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4622 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4625 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4627 static struct indirect_string_node *
4628 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4629 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4631 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4633 indirect_string_node **slot
4634 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4635 if (*slot == NULL)
4637 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4638 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4639 *slot = node;
4641 else
4642 node = *slot;
4644 node->refcount++;
4645 return node;
4648 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4650 static struct indirect_string_node *
4651 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4653 if (! debug_str_hash)
4654 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4656 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4659 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4661 static inline void
4662 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4664 dw_attr_node attr;
4665 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4667 node = find_AT_string (str);
4669 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4670 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4671 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4672 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4673 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4676 static inline const char *
4677 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4679 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4680 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4683 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4684 the string inline in the die. */
4686 static void
4687 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4689 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4690 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4691 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
4692 || node->form == DW_FORM_line_strp
4693 || node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx))
4695 gcc_assert (node->label);
4696 return;
4698 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4699 ++dw2_string_counter;
4700 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4702 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4704 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4705 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4707 else
4709 node->form = dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx);
4710 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4714 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish, called to reset indirect
4715 string decisions done for early LTO dwarf output before fat object
4716 dwarf output. */
4719 reset_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
4721 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
4722 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx))
4724 free (node->label);
4725 node->label = NULL;
4726 node->form = (dwarf_form) 0;
4727 node->index = 0;
4729 return 1;
4732 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4733 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4735 static enum dwarf_form
4736 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4738 unsigned int len;
4740 if (node->form)
4741 return node->form;
4743 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4745 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4746 always better to put it inline. */
4747 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4748 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4750 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4751 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4752 single module. */
4753 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4754 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4755 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4756 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4758 set_indirect_string (node);
4760 return node->form;
4763 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4764 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4766 static enum dwarf_form
4767 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4769 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4770 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4773 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4775 static inline void
4776 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4778 dw_attr_node attr;
4779 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4781 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4782 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4783 if (targ_die == NULL)
4784 return;
4786 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4787 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4788 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4789 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4790 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4791 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4794 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4796 static inline void
4797 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4799 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4800 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4801 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4804 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4805 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4807 static inline void
4808 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4810 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4811 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4812 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4815 static inline dw_die_ref
4816 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4818 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4819 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4822 static inline int
4823 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4825 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4826 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4828 return 0;
4831 static inline void
4832 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4834 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4835 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4838 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4840 static inline void
4841 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4843 dw_attr_node attr;
4845 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4846 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4847 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4848 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4849 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4852 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4854 static inline void
4855 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4857 dw_attr_node attr;
4859 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4860 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4861 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4862 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4863 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4866 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4867 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4869 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4870 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4873 static inline void
4874 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4876 dw_attr_node attr;
4878 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4879 return;
4881 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4882 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4883 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4884 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4885 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4886 have_location_lists = true;
4889 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4890 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4892 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4893 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4896 /* Add a view list attribute to DIE. It must have a DW_AT_location
4897 attribute, because the view list complements the location list. */
4899 static inline void
4900 add_AT_view_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4902 dw_attr_node attr;
4904 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4905 return;
4907 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4908 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_view_list;
4909 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4910 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_view_list = die;
4911 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4912 gcc_checking_assert (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location));
4913 gcc_assert (have_location_lists);
4916 /* Return a pointer to the location list referenced by the attribute.
4917 If the named attribute is a view list, look up the corresponding
4918 DW_AT_location attribute and return its location list. */
4920 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4921 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4923 gcc_assert (a);
4924 switch (AT_class (a))
4926 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
4927 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4928 case dw_val_class_view_list:
4930 dw_attr_node *l;
4931 l = get_AT (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_view_list, DW_AT_location);
4932 if (!l)
4933 return NULL;
4934 gcc_checking_assert (l + 1 == a);
4935 return AT_loc_list_ptr (l);
4937 default:
4938 gcc_unreachable ();
4942 /* Return the location attribute value associated with a view list
4943 attribute value. */
4945 static inline dw_val_node *
4946 view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (dw_val_node *val)
4948 gcc_assert (val->val_class == dw_val_class_view_list);
4949 dw_attr_node *loc = get_AT (val->v.val_view_list, DW_AT_location);
4950 if (!loc)
4951 return NULL;
4952 gcc_checking_assert (&(loc + 1)->dw_attr_val == val);
4953 gcc_assert (AT_class (loc) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4954 return &loc->dw_attr_val;
4957 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4959 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4960 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4963 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4965 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4967 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4969 hashval_t
4970 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4972 inchash::hash hstate;
4973 switch (a->kind)
4975 case ate_kind_rtx:
4976 hstate.add_int (0);
4977 break;
4978 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4979 hstate.add_int (1);
4980 break;
4981 case ate_kind_label:
4982 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4983 default:
4984 gcc_unreachable ();
4986 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4987 return hstate.end ();
4990 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4992 bool
4993 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4995 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4996 return 0;
4997 switch (a1->kind)
4999 case ate_kind_rtx:
5000 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
5001 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
5002 case ate_kind_label:
5003 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
5004 default:
5005 gcc_unreachable ();
5009 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
5011 void
5012 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
5014 e->kind = kind;
5015 switch (kind)
5017 case ate_kind_rtx:
5018 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
5019 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
5020 break;
5021 case ate_kind_label:
5022 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
5023 break;
5025 e->refcount = 0;
5026 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
5029 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
5030 index until output time. */
5032 static addr_table_entry *
5033 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
5035 addr_table_entry *node;
5036 addr_table_entry finder;
5038 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
5039 if (! addr_index_table)
5040 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
5041 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
5042 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
5044 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
5046 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
5047 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
5048 *slot = node;
5050 else
5051 node = *slot;
5053 node->refcount++;
5054 return node;
5057 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
5058 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
5059 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
5060 bugs. */
5062 static void
5063 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
5065 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
5066 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
5067 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5068 entry->refcount--;
5071 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
5072 address_table. */
5074 static void
5075 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
5077 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
5078 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
5080 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5081 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
5085 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
5086 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
5087 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
5088 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
5089 in the same order for each run. */
5092 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
5094 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
5096 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
5097 if (node->refcount == 0)
5098 return 1;
5100 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
5101 node->index = *index;
5102 *index += 1;
5104 return 1;
5107 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
5108 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
5109 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
5110 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
5112 static inline void
5113 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
5114 bool force_direct)
5116 dw_attr_node attr;
5118 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5119 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5120 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5121 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
5122 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
5123 else
5124 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5125 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5128 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
5130 static inline rtx
5131 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
5133 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5134 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5137 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
5139 static inline void
5140 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5141 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5143 dw_attr_node attr;
5145 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5146 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5147 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5148 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5149 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5152 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
5154 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5155 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
5157 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file
5158 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file_implicit));
5159 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5162 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
5164 static inline void
5165 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5166 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
5168 dw_attr_node attr;
5170 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5171 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
5172 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5173 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
5174 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
5175 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5178 /* Add a symbolic view identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5180 static inline void
5181 add_AT_symview (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5182 const char *view_label)
5184 dw_attr_node attr;
5186 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5187 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_symview;
5188 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5189 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_symbolic_view = xstrdup (view_label);
5190 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5193 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5195 static inline void
5196 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5197 const char *lbl_id)
5199 dw_attr_node attr;
5201 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5202 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5203 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5204 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5205 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
5206 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
5207 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
5208 ate_kind_label);
5209 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5212 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5213 debug_line section. */
5215 static inline void
5216 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5217 const char *label)
5219 dw_attr_node attr;
5221 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5222 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5223 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5224 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5225 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5228 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5229 debug_loclists section. */
5231 static inline void
5232 add_AT_loclistsptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5233 const char *label)
5235 dw_attr_node attr;
5237 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5238 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loclistsptr;
5239 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5240 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5241 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5244 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5245 debug_macinfo section. */
5247 static inline void
5248 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5249 const char *label)
5251 dw_attr_node attr;
5253 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5254 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5255 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5256 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5257 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5260 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5262 static inline void
5263 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5264 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5266 dw_attr_node attr;
5268 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5269 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5270 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
5271 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5272 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5275 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
5276 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
5277 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
5278 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
5280 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
5281 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
5283 static void
5284 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5285 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
5287 dw_attr_node attr;
5289 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5290 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5291 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
5292 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
5293 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
5294 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
5295 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
5296 else
5297 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
5298 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5299 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5302 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
5304 static inline const char *
5305 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
5307 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
5308 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
5311 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
5313 static inline const char *
5314 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
5316 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
5317 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
5320 static inline const char *
5321 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
5323 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5324 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5325 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
5326 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loclistsptr
5327 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
5328 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5331 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5333 static dw_attr_node *
5334 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5336 dw_attr_node *a;
5337 unsigned ix;
5338 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5340 if (! die)
5341 return NULL;
5343 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5344 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5345 return a;
5346 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5347 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5348 spec = AT_ref (a);
5350 if (spec)
5351 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5353 return NULL;
5356 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
5358 static dw_die_ref
5359 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
5361 dw_die_ref t;
5363 if (!die)
5364 return NULL;
5366 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
5367 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
5368 die = t;
5370 return die->die_parent;
5373 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5374 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5375 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5377 static inline const char *
5378 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5380 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5382 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5385 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5386 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5387 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5389 static inline const char *
5390 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5392 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5394 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5397 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5398 NULL if it is not present. */
5400 static inline const char *
5401 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5403 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5405 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5408 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5409 if it is not present. */
5411 static inline int
5412 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5414 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5416 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5419 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5420 if it is not present. */
5422 static inline unsigned
5423 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5425 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5427 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5430 static inline dw_die_ref
5431 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5433 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5435 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5438 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5439 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5441 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5443 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5446 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5448 static inline bool
5449 is_cxx (void)
5451 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5453 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
5454 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
5457 /* Return TRUE if DECL was created by the C++ frontend. */
5459 static bool
5460 is_cxx (const_tree decl)
5462 if (in_lto_p)
5464 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5465 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5466 return strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context), "GNU C++", 7) == 0;
5468 return is_cxx ();
5471 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5473 static inline bool
5474 is_fortran (void)
5476 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5478 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5479 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5480 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
5481 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
5482 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
5485 static inline bool
5486 is_fortran (const_tree decl)
5488 if (in_lto_p)
5490 const_tree context = get_ultimate_context (decl);
5491 if (context && TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context))
5492 return (strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5493 "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0
5494 || strcmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (context),
5495 "GNU F77") == 0);
5497 return is_fortran ();
5500 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5502 static inline bool
5503 is_ada (void)
5505 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
5507 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5510 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
5511 was successful. */
5513 static bool
5514 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5516 dw_attr_node *a;
5517 unsigned ix;
5519 if (! die)
5520 return false;
5522 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5523 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5525 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5526 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5527 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5529 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5530 that are needed. */
5531 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
5532 return true;
5534 return false;
5537 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5538 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5540 static void
5541 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5543 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5544 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5545 if (prev == child)
5547 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5548 prev = NULL;
5550 else
5551 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5552 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5553 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5554 child->die_sib = NULL;
5557 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
5558 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
5560 static void
5561 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
5563 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
5565 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
5566 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
5568 new_child->die_parent = parent;
5569 if (prev == old_child)
5571 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
5572 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
5574 else
5576 prev->die_sib = new_child;
5577 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
5579 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
5580 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
5581 old_child->die_sib = NULL;
5584 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
5586 static void
5587 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5589 dw_die_ref c;
5590 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
5591 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
5592 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
5595 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5596 matches TAG. */
5598 static void
5599 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5601 dw_die_ref c;
5603 c = die->die_child;
5604 if (c) do {
5605 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5606 c = c->die_sib;
5607 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5609 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5610 c->die_parent = NULL;
5611 /* Might have removed every child. */
5612 if (die->die_child == NULL)
5613 return;
5614 c = prev->die_sib;
5616 } while (c != die->die_child);
5619 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5621 static void
5622 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5624 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5625 if (! die || ! child_die)
5626 return;
5627 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5629 child_die->die_parent = die;
5630 if (die->die_child)
5632 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5633 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5635 else
5636 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5637 die->die_child = child_die;
5640 /* Like add_child_die, but put CHILD_DIE after AFTER_DIE. */
5642 static void
5643 add_child_die_after (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die,
5644 dw_die_ref after_die)
5646 gcc_assert (die
5647 && child_die
5648 && after_die
5649 && die->die_child
5650 && die != child_die);
5652 child_die->die_parent = die;
5653 child_die->die_sib = after_die->die_sib;
5654 after_die->die_sib = child_die;
5655 if (die->die_child == after_die)
5656 die->die_child = child_die;
5659 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
5660 NEW_PARENT. */
5662 static void
5663 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
5665 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5666 if (p->die_sib == child)
5668 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5669 break;
5671 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
5674 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5675 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5676 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5678 static void
5679 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5681 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5682 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5683 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5685 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5687 if (tmp)
5688 child = tmp;
5691 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5692 || (child->die_parent
5693 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5695 reparent_child (child, parent);
5698 /* Create and return a new die with TAG_VALUE as tag. */
5700 static inline dw_die_ref
5701 new_die_raw (enum dwarf_tag tag_value)
5703 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5704 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5705 return die;
5708 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5709 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5710 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5711 later. */
5713 static inline dw_die_ref
5714 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5716 dw_die_ref die = new_die_raw (tag_value);
5718 if (parent_die != NULL)
5719 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5720 else
5722 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5724 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5725 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5726 streaming. */
5727 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5728 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5729 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5730 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5731 && tag_value != DW_TAG_skeleton_unit
5732 && !early_dwarf
5733 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5734 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5735 them up. */
5736 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5737 || !decl_function_context (t))
5738 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5739 are local to a function will be fixed in
5740 decls_for_scope. */
5741 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5742 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5743 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5744 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5745 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5746 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5747 && !in_lto_p)
5749 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5750 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5751 gcc_unreachable ();
5754 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5755 limbo_node->die = die;
5756 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5757 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5758 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5761 return die;
5764 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5766 static inline dw_die_ref
5767 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5769 dw_die_ref die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5770 if (die && die->removed)
5772 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = NULL;
5773 return NULL;
5775 return die;
5778 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5779 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5780 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5782 static inline dw_die_ref
5783 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5785 if (type
5786 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5787 && type_die
5788 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5789 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5790 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5791 return type_die;
5794 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5795 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5796 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5797 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5798 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5799 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5801 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5802 a naming typedef is. */
5804 static inline dw_die_ref
5805 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5807 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5808 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5811 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5813 static inline void
5814 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5816 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5819 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5821 inline hashval_t
5822 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5824 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5827 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5829 inline bool
5830 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5832 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5835 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5837 static inline dw_die_ref
5838 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5840 dw_die_ref *die = decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl),
5841 NO_INSERT);
5842 if (!die)
5843 return NULL;
5844 if ((*die)->removed)
5846 decl_die_table->clear_slot (die);
5847 return NULL;
5849 return *die;
5853 /* For DECL which might have early dwarf output query a SYMBOL + OFFSET
5854 style reference. Return true if we found one refering to a DIE for
5855 DECL, otherwise return false. */
5857 static bool
5858 dwarf2out_die_ref_for_decl (tree decl, const char **sym,
5859 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *off)
5861 dw_die_ref die;
5863 if ((flag_wpa || flag_incremental_link == INCREMENTAL_LINK_LTO)
5864 && !decl_die_table)
5865 return false;
5867 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5868 die = BLOCK_DIE (decl);
5869 else
5870 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
5871 if (!die)
5872 return false;
5874 /* During WPA stage and incremental linking we currently use DIEs
5875 to store the decl <-> label + offset map. That's quite inefficient
5876 but it works for now. */
5877 if (flag_wpa
5878 || flag_incremental_link == INCREMENTAL_LINK_LTO)
5880 dw_die_ref ref = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
5881 if (!ref)
5883 gcc_assert (die == comp_unit_die ());
5884 return false;
5886 *off = ref->die_offset;
5887 *sym = ref->die_id.die_symbol;
5888 return true;
5891 /* Similar to get_ref_die_offset_label, but using the "correct"
5892 label. */
5893 *off = die->die_offset;
5894 while (die->die_parent)
5895 die = die->die_parent;
5896 /* For the containing CU DIE we compute a die_symbol in
5897 compute_comp_unit_symbol. */
5898 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
5899 && die->die_id.die_symbol != NULL);
5900 *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
5901 return true;
5904 /* Add a reference of kind ATTR_KIND to a DIE at SYMBOL + OFFSET to DIE. */
5906 static void
5907 add_AT_external_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5908 const char *symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5910 /* Create a fake DIE that contains the reference. Don't use
5911 new_die because we don't want to end up in the limbo list. */
5912 dw_die_ref ref = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
5913 ref->die_id.die_symbol = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (get_identifier (symbol));
5914 ref->die_offset = offset;
5915 ref->with_offset = 1;
5916 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, ref);
5919 /* Create a DIE for DECL if required and add a reference to a DIE
5920 at SYMBOL + OFFSET which contains attributes dumped early. */
5922 static void
5923 dwarf2out_register_external_die (tree decl, const char *sym,
5924 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off)
5926 if (debug_info_level == DINFO_LEVEL_NONE)
5927 return;
5929 if ((flag_wpa
5930 || flag_incremental_link == INCREMENTAL_LINK_LTO) && !decl_die_table)
5931 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (1000);
5933 dw_die_ref die
5934 = TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK ? BLOCK_DIE (decl) : lookup_decl_die (decl);
5935 gcc_assert (!die);
5937 tree ctx;
5938 dw_die_ref parent = NULL;
5939 /* Need to lookup a DIE for the decls context - the containing
5940 function or translation unit. */
5941 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
5943 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (decl);
5944 /* ??? We do not output DIEs for all scopes thus skip as
5945 many DIEs as needed. */
5946 while (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK
5947 && !BLOCK_DIE (ctx))
5948 ctx = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (ctx);
5950 else
5951 ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5952 /* Peel types in the context stack. */
5953 while (ctx && TYPE_P (ctx))
5954 ctx = TYPE_CONTEXT (ctx);
5955 /* Likewise namespaces in case we do not want to emit DIEs for them. */
5956 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
5957 while (ctx && TREE_CODE (ctx) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
5958 ctx = DECL_CONTEXT (ctx);
5959 if (ctx)
5961 if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == BLOCK)
5962 parent = BLOCK_DIE (ctx);
5963 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
5964 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5965 && !flag_wpa
5966 && flag_incremental_link != INCREMENTAL_LINK_LTO)
5967 /* Otherwise all late annotations go to the main CU which
5968 imports the original CUs. */
5969 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5970 else if (TREE_CODE (ctx) == FUNCTION_DECL
5971 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL
5972 && TREE_CODE (decl) != BLOCK)
5973 /* Leave function local entities parent determination to when
5974 we process scope vars. */
5976 else
5977 parent = lookup_decl_die (ctx);
5979 else
5980 /* In some cases the FEs fail to set DECL_CONTEXT properly.
5981 Handle this case gracefully by globalizing stuff. */
5982 parent = comp_unit_die ();
5983 /* Create a DIE "stub". */
5984 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
5986 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
5987 if (! flag_wpa && flag_incremental_link != INCREMENTAL_LINK_LTO)
5989 die = comp_unit_die ();
5990 dw_die_ref import = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_unit, die, NULL_TREE);
5991 add_AT_external_die_ref (import, DW_AT_import, sym, off);
5992 /* We re-target all CU decls to the LTRANS CU DIE, so no need
5993 to create a DIE for the original CUs. */
5994 return;
5996 /* Keep the 1:1 association during WPA. */
5997 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, decl);
5998 break;
5999 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
6000 if (is_fortran (decl))
6001 die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, parent, decl);
6002 else
6003 die = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, parent, decl);
6004 break;
6005 case FUNCTION_DECL:
6006 die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, parent, decl);
6007 break;
6008 case VAR_DECL:
6009 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
6010 break;
6011 case RESULT_DECL:
6012 die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, parent, decl);
6013 break;
6014 case PARM_DECL:
6015 die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, parent, decl);
6016 break;
6017 case CONST_DECL:
6018 die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, parent, decl);
6019 break;
6020 case LABEL_DECL:
6021 die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, parent, decl);
6022 break;
6023 case BLOCK:
6024 die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, parent, decl);
6025 break;
6026 default:
6027 gcc_unreachable ();
6029 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == BLOCK)
6030 BLOCK_DIE (decl) = die;
6031 else
6032 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
6034 /* Add a reference to the DIE providing early debug at $sym + off. */
6035 add_AT_external_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, sym, off);
6038 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
6040 inline hashval_t
6041 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
6043 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
6046 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
6047 UID of decl *Y. */
6049 inline bool
6050 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
6052 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
6055 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
6057 static inline var_loc_list *
6058 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
6060 if (!decl_loc_table)
6061 return NULL;
6062 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
6065 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
6067 inline hashval_t
6068 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
6070 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
6073 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
6074 UID of decl *Y. */
6076 inline bool
6077 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
6079 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
6082 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
6084 static void
6085 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
6087 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
6089 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
6090 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
6093 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
6095 static HOST_WIDE_INT
6096 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
6098 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
6099 if (ret)
6100 return ret;
6101 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
6102 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
6103 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
6106 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
6108 static rtx *
6109 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
6111 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
6112 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
6113 else
6114 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
6117 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
6118 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
6120 static rtx_expr_list *
6121 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
6123 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
6124 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
6125 else
6126 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
6127 GEN_INT (bitsize),
6128 loc_note), next);
6131 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
6132 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
6134 static rtx
6135 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6136 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
6138 if (bitsize != -1)
6140 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
6141 if (bitpos != 0)
6142 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
6144 return loc_note;
6147 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
6148 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
6149 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
6150 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
6151 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
6152 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
6153 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
6154 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
6155 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
6157 static void
6158 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
6159 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
6160 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
6162 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
6163 bool copy = inner != NULL;
6165 if (copy)
6167 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
6168 while (src != inner)
6170 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
6171 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
6172 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6173 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
6176 /* Add padding if needed. */
6177 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
6179 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
6180 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6181 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6183 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
6185 gcc_assert (!copy);
6186 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
6187 just update the location for it and return. */
6188 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
6189 return;
6191 /* Add the piece that changed. */
6192 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6193 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6194 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
6195 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
6196 if (!copy)
6197 src = dest;
6198 while (diff > 0 && *src)
6200 rtx piece = *src;
6201 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
6202 if (copy)
6203 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
6204 else
6206 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
6207 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
6210 /* Add padding if needed. */
6211 if (diff < 0 && *src)
6213 if (!copy)
6214 dest = src;
6215 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
6216 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6218 if (!copy)
6219 return;
6220 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
6221 while (*src)
6223 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
6224 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
6225 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
6226 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
6230 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
6232 static struct var_loc_node *
6233 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label, var_loc_view view)
6235 unsigned int decl_id;
6236 var_loc_list *temp;
6237 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
6238 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
6240 if (VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
6242 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
6243 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
6244 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
6245 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
6247 bool reverse;
6248 tree innerdecl = get_ref_base_and_extent_hwi (realdecl, &bitpos,
6249 &bitsize, &reverse);
6250 if (!innerdecl
6251 || !DECL_P (innerdecl)
6252 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
6253 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
6254 || bitsize == 0
6255 || bitpos + bitsize > 256)
6256 return NULL;
6257 decl = innerdecl;
6261 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
6262 var_loc_list **slot
6263 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
6264 if (*slot == NULL)
6266 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
6267 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
6268 *slot = temp;
6270 else
6271 temp = *slot;
6273 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
6274 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
6275 if (temp->last
6276 && temp->first == temp->last
6277 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
6278 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
6279 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
6280 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
6281 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
6282 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
6283 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
6284 && prev_real_insn (as_a<rtx_insn *> (temp->first->loc)) == NULL_RTX
6285 && (bitsize != -1
6286 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
6287 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
6288 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
6289 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
6291 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6292 temp->first->next = loc;
6293 temp->last = loc;
6294 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6296 else if (temp->last)
6298 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
6299 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
6300 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
6301 if (last->next)
6303 last = last->next;
6304 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
6306 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
6308 piece_loc = &last->loc;
6311 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
6312 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
6313 break;
6314 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
6315 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
6317 while (*piece_loc);
6319 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
6320 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
6321 last element. */
6322 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0 && last->view == view)
6324 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
6325 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
6326 if (piece_loc != NULL)
6328 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
6329 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6330 return NULL;
6332 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
6333 if (temp->last != last)
6335 temp->last->next = NULL;
6336 unused = last;
6337 last = temp->last;
6338 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0 || last->view != view);
6340 else
6342 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
6343 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
6344 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
6345 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
6346 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6347 return temp->last;
6350 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
6351 last_loc_note = last->loc;
6352 else if (piece_loc != NULL
6353 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
6354 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
6355 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
6356 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
6357 else
6358 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
6359 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
6360 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
6361 we have nothing to do. */
6362 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
6363 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
6364 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
6365 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6366 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
6367 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
6368 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
6369 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
6370 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
6372 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
6373 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
6374 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
6375 if (unused)
6377 loc = unused;
6378 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
6380 else
6381 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6382 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
6383 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6384 else
6385 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
6386 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
6387 last->next = loc;
6388 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
6389 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
6390 if (last != temp->last)
6391 temp->last = last;
6393 else if (unused)
6394 ggc_free (unused);
6396 else
6398 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
6399 temp->first = loc;
6400 temp->last = loc;
6401 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
6403 return loc;
6406 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
6407 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
6408 the DIE internal representation. */
6409 static int print_indent;
6411 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
6413 static inline void
6414 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
6416 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
6419 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
6421 static inline void
6422 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
6424 int i;
6426 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
6427 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
6430 static inline void
6431 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
6433 if (discr_value->pos)
6434 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
6435 else
6436 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
6439 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
6441 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
6442 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
6444 static void
6445 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6447 switch (val->val_class)
6449 case dw_val_class_addr:
6450 fprintf (outfile, "address");
6451 break;
6452 case dw_val_class_offset:
6453 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
6454 break;
6455 case dw_val_class_loc:
6456 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
6457 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
6458 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
6459 else if (recurse)
6461 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
6462 print_indent += 4;
6463 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
6464 print_indent -= 4;
6466 else
6467 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
6468 break;
6469 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6470 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
6471 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
6472 break;
6473 case dw_val_class_view_list:
6474 val = view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (val);
6475 fprintf (outfile, "location list with views -> labels:%s and %s",
6476 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol,
6477 val->v.val_loc_list->vl_symbol);
6478 break;
6479 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6480 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
6481 break;
6482 case dw_val_class_const:
6483 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6484 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
6485 break;
6486 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6487 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6488 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
6489 break;
6490 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6491 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
6492 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
6493 val->v.val_double.high,
6494 val->v.val_double.low);
6495 break;
6496 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6498 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
6499 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
6500 gcc_assert (i > 0);
6501 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
6502 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
6503 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
6504 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
6505 while (--i >= 0)
6506 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
6507 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
6508 fprintf (outfile, ")");
6509 break;
6511 case dw_val_class_vec:
6512 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
6513 break;
6514 case dw_val_class_flag:
6515 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
6516 break;
6517 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6518 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
6520 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
6522 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6524 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
6525 print_signature (outfile,
6526 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6528 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
6530 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
6531 if (die->with_offset)
6532 fprintf (outfile, " + %ld", die->die_offset);
6534 else
6535 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
6536 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
6538 else
6539 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
6540 break;
6541 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6542 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
6543 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
6544 break;
6545 case dw_val_class_symview:
6546 fprintf (outfile, "view: %s", val->v.val_symbolic_view);
6547 break;
6548 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6549 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6550 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6551 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6552 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6553 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
6554 break;
6555 case dw_val_class_str:
6556 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
6557 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
6558 else
6559 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
6560 break;
6561 case dw_val_class_file:
6562 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6563 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
6564 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
6565 break;
6566 case dw_val_class_data8:
6568 int i;
6570 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
6571 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
6572 break;
6574 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
6575 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
6576 break;
6577 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
6578 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
6579 node != NULL;
6580 node = node->dw_discr_next)
6582 if (node->dw_discr_range)
6584 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
6585 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6586 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
6588 else
6589 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
6591 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
6592 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
6594 default:
6595 break;
6599 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
6601 static void
6602 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
6604 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
6608 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
6609 routine is a debugging aid only. */
6611 static void
6612 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
6614 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
6616 if (loc == NULL)
6618 print_spaces (outfile);
6619 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
6620 return;
6623 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
6625 print_spaces (outfile);
6626 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
6627 (void *) l,
6628 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
6629 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6631 fprintf (outfile, " ");
6632 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
6634 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
6636 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
6637 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
6639 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6643 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
6644 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6646 static void
6647 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
6649 dw_attr_node *a;
6650 dw_die_ref c;
6651 unsigned ix;
6653 print_spaces (outfile);
6654 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
6655 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
6656 (void*) die);
6657 print_spaces (outfile);
6658 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
6659 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
6660 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
6662 if (die->comdat_type_p)
6664 print_spaces (outfile);
6665 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
6666 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
6667 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6670 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6672 print_spaces (outfile);
6673 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
6675 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
6676 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6679 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6681 print_indent += 4;
6682 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
6683 print_indent -= 4;
6685 if (print_indent == 0)
6686 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
6689 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
6691 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6692 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
6694 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
6697 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6699 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6700 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6702 print_die (die, stderr);
6705 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6706 debug (die_struct &ref)
6708 print_die (&ref, stderr);
6711 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6712 debug (die_struct *ptr)
6714 if (ptr)
6715 debug (*ptr);
6716 else
6717 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
6721 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6722 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6724 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6725 debug_dwarf (void)
6727 print_indent = 0;
6728 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
6731 /* Verify the DIE tree structure. */
6733 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
6734 verify_die (dw_die_ref die)
6736 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6737 if (die->die_parent == NULL
6738 && die->die_sib == NULL)
6739 return;
6740 /* Verify the die_sib list is cyclic. */
6741 dw_die_ref x = die;
6744 x->die_mark = 1;
6745 x = x->die_sib;
6747 while (x && !x->die_mark);
6748 gcc_assert (x == die);
6749 x = die;
6752 /* Verify all dies have the same parent. */
6753 gcc_assert (x->die_parent == die->die_parent);
6754 if (x->die_child)
6756 /* Verify the child has the proper parent and recurse. */
6757 gcc_assert (x->die_child->die_parent == x);
6758 verify_die (x->die_child);
6760 x->die_mark = 0;
6761 x = x->die_sib;
6763 while (x && x->die_mark);
6766 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
6768 static void
6769 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
6771 unsigned ix;
6772 dw_attr_node *a;
6773 bool inline_found = false;
6774 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
6775 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_column = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
6776 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6778 switch (a->dw_attr)
6780 case DW_AT_inline:
6781 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
6782 inline_found = true;
6783 break;
6784 case DW_AT_location:
6785 ++n_location;
6786 break;
6787 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6788 ++n_low_pc;
6789 break;
6790 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6791 ++n_high_pc;
6792 break;
6793 case DW_AT_artificial:
6794 ++n_artificial;
6795 break;
6796 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6797 ++n_decl_column;
6798 break;
6799 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6800 ++n_decl_line;
6801 break;
6802 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6803 ++n_decl_file;
6804 break;
6805 default:
6806 break;
6809 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
6810 || n_decl_column > 1 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
6812 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
6813 debug_dwarf_die (die);
6814 gcc_unreachable ();
6816 if (inline_found)
6818 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
6819 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
6820 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
6821 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
6822 expansions. */
6823 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6824 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
6825 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
6826 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
6827 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
6828 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_call_all_calls
6829 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
6833 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6834 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6835 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6837 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6839 static inline void
6840 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6842 int tem;
6843 inchash::hash hstate;
6844 hashval_t hash;
6846 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
6847 CHECKSUM (tem);
6848 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6849 hash = hstate.end();
6850 CHECKSUM (hash);
6853 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6855 static void
6856 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6858 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6859 rtx r;
6861 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6863 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6864 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6865 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6866 return;
6868 switch (AT_class (at))
6870 case dw_val_class_const:
6871 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
6872 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6873 break;
6874 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6875 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
6876 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6877 break;
6878 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6879 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6880 break;
6881 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6882 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6883 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6884 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6885 break;
6886 case dw_val_class_vec:
6887 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6888 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6889 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6890 break;
6891 case dw_val_class_flag:
6892 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6893 break;
6894 case dw_val_class_str:
6895 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6896 break;
6898 case dw_val_class_addr:
6899 r = AT_addr (at);
6900 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6901 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6902 break;
6904 case dw_val_class_offset:
6905 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6906 break;
6908 case dw_val_class_loc:
6909 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6910 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6911 break;
6913 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6914 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6915 break;
6917 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6918 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6919 case dw_val_class_symview:
6920 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6921 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6922 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6923 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
6924 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6925 break;
6927 case dw_val_class_file:
6928 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
6929 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6930 break;
6932 case dw_val_class_data8:
6933 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6934 break;
6936 default:
6937 break;
6941 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6943 static void
6944 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6946 dw_die_ref c;
6947 dw_attr_node *a;
6948 unsigned ix;
6950 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6951 if (die->die_mark)
6953 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6954 return;
6956 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6958 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6960 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6961 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6963 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6966 #undef CHECKSUM
6967 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6968 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6970 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6971 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6972 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6973 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6974 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6975 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6976 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6977 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6979 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6981 static void
6982 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6984 unsigned char byte;
6985 bool more;
6987 while (1)
6989 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6990 value >>= 7;
6991 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6992 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6993 if (more)
6994 byte |= 0x80;
6995 CHECKSUM (byte);
6996 if (!more)
6997 break;
7001 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
7003 static void
7004 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
7006 while (1)
7008 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
7009 value >>= 7;
7010 if (value != 0)
7011 /* More bytes to follow. */
7012 byte |= 0x80;
7013 CHECKSUM (byte);
7014 if (value == 0)
7015 break;
7019 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
7020 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
7022 static void
7023 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
7025 const char *name;
7026 dw_die_ref spec;
7027 int tag = die->die_tag;
7029 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
7030 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
7031 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
7032 return;
7034 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7036 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7037 if (spec != NULL)
7038 die = spec;
7040 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
7041 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
7043 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
7044 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7045 if (name != NULL)
7046 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7049 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
7051 static inline void
7052 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
7054 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
7055 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
7056 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
7058 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7059 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
7060 return;
7063 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
7064 while (loc != NULL)
7066 inchash::hash hstate;
7067 hashval_t hash;
7069 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
7070 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
7071 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
7072 hash = hstate.end ();
7073 CHECKSUM (hash);
7074 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
7078 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
7080 static void
7081 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
7082 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7084 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7085 rtx r;
7087 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7089 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
7091 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
7092 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
7093 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
7094 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
7095 is complete or not. */
7096 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
7097 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7098 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7099 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7100 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
7101 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
7102 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
7104 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
7106 if (name_attr != NULL)
7108 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
7110 if (decl == NULL)
7111 decl = target_die;
7112 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
7113 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7114 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
7115 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
7116 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
7117 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7118 return;
7122 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
7123 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
7124 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
7125 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
7127 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
7128 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7129 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
7131 else
7133 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
7135 if (decl == NULL)
7136 decl = target_die;
7137 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7138 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
7139 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7140 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
7141 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
7142 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
7144 return;
7147 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
7148 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
7150 switch (AT_class (at))
7152 case dw_val_class_const:
7153 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7154 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7155 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
7156 break;
7158 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7159 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7160 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7161 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
7162 break;
7164 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7165 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7166 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
7167 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
7168 break;
7170 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7171 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7172 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
7173 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7174 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
7175 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
7176 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
7177 break;
7179 case dw_val_class_vec:
7180 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
7181 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7182 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
7183 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
7184 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
7185 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
7186 break;
7188 case dw_val_class_flag:
7189 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
7190 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
7191 break;
7193 case dw_val_class_str:
7194 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7195 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
7196 break;
7198 case dw_val_class_addr:
7199 r = AT_addr (at);
7200 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
7201 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7202 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
7203 break;
7205 case dw_val_class_offset:
7206 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
7207 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7208 break;
7210 case dw_val_class_loc:
7211 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
7212 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
7213 break;
7215 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7216 case dw_val_class_symview:
7217 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7218 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7219 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7220 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7221 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7222 break;
7224 case dw_val_class_file:
7225 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7226 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
7227 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
7228 break;
7230 case dw_val_class_data8:
7231 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
7232 break;
7234 default:
7235 break;
7239 struct checksum_attributes
7241 dw_attr_node *at_name;
7242 dw_attr_node *at_type;
7243 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
7244 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
7245 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
7246 dw_attr_node *at_alignment;
7247 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
7248 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
7249 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
7250 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
7251 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
7252 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
7253 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
7254 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
7255 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
7256 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
7257 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
7258 dw_attr_node *at_count;
7259 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
7260 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
7261 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
7262 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
7263 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
7264 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
7265 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
7266 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
7267 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
7268 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
7269 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
7270 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
7271 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
7272 dw_attr_node *at_location;
7273 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
7274 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
7275 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
7276 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
7277 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
7278 dw_attr_node *at_small;
7279 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
7280 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
7281 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_bit_size;
7282 dw_attr_node *at_string_length_byte_size;
7283 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
7284 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
7285 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
7286 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
7287 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
7288 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
7289 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
7290 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
7293 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
7295 static void
7296 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
7298 dw_attr_node *a;
7299 unsigned ix;
7301 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7303 switch (a->dw_attr)
7305 case DW_AT_name:
7306 attrs->at_name = a;
7307 break;
7308 case DW_AT_type:
7309 attrs->at_type = a;
7310 break;
7311 case DW_AT_friend:
7312 attrs->at_friend = a;
7313 break;
7314 case DW_AT_accessibility:
7315 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
7316 break;
7317 case DW_AT_address_class:
7318 attrs->at_address_class = a;
7319 break;
7320 case DW_AT_alignment:
7321 attrs->at_alignment = a;
7322 break;
7323 case DW_AT_allocated:
7324 attrs->at_allocated = a;
7325 break;
7326 case DW_AT_artificial:
7327 attrs->at_artificial = a;
7328 break;
7329 case DW_AT_associated:
7330 attrs->at_associated = a;
7331 break;
7332 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
7333 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
7334 break;
7335 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
7336 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
7337 break;
7338 case DW_AT_bit_size:
7339 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
7340 break;
7341 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
7342 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
7343 break;
7344 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7345 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
7346 break;
7347 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
7348 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
7349 break;
7350 case DW_AT_const_value:
7351 attrs->at_const_value = a;
7352 break;
7353 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7354 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
7355 break;
7356 case DW_AT_count:
7357 attrs->at_count = a;
7358 break;
7359 case DW_AT_data_location:
7360 attrs->at_data_location = a;
7361 break;
7362 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7363 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
7364 break;
7365 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
7366 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
7367 break;
7368 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
7369 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
7370 break;
7371 case DW_AT_default_value:
7372 attrs->at_default_value = a;
7373 break;
7374 case DW_AT_digit_count:
7375 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
7376 break;
7377 case DW_AT_discr:
7378 attrs->at_discr = a;
7379 break;
7380 case DW_AT_discr_list:
7381 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
7382 break;
7383 case DW_AT_discr_value:
7384 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
7385 break;
7386 case DW_AT_encoding:
7387 attrs->at_encoding = a;
7388 break;
7389 case DW_AT_endianity:
7390 attrs->at_endianity = a;
7391 break;
7392 case DW_AT_explicit:
7393 attrs->at_explicit = a;
7394 break;
7395 case DW_AT_is_optional:
7396 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
7397 break;
7398 case DW_AT_location:
7399 attrs->at_location = a;
7400 break;
7401 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7402 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
7403 break;
7404 case DW_AT_mutable:
7405 attrs->at_mutable = a;
7406 break;
7407 case DW_AT_ordering:
7408 attrs->at_ordering = a;
7409 break;
7410 case DW_AT_picture_string:
7411 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
7412 break;
7413 case DW_AT_prototyped:
7414 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
7415 break;
7416 case DW_AT_small:
7417 attrs->at_small = a;
7418 break;
7419 case DW_AT_segment:
7420 attrs->at_segment = a;
7421 break;
7422 case DW_AT_string_length:
7423 attrs->at_string_length = a;
7424 break;
7425 case DW_AT_string_length_bit_size:
7426 attrs->at_string_length_bit_size = a;
7427 break;
7428 case DW_AT_string_length_byte_size:
7429 attrs->at_string_length_byte_size = a;
7430 break;
7431 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
7432 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
7433 break;
7434 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7435 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
7436 break;
7437 case DW_AT_use_location:
7438 attrs->at_use_location = a;
7439 break;
7440 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7441 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
7442 break;
7443 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7444 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
7445 break;
7446 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7447 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
7448 break;
7449 case DW_AT_visibility:
7450 attrs->at_visibility = a;
7451 break;
7452 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7453 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
7454 break;
7455 default:
7456 break;
7461 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
7463 static void
7464 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
7466 dw_die_ref c;
7467 dw_die_ref decl;
7468 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
7470 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
7471 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
7473 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
7475 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7476 if (decl != NULL)
7477 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
7478 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
7480 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
7481 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
7482 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
7483 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
7484 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
7485 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
7486 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
7487 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
7488 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
7489 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
7490 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
7491 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
7492 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
7493 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
7494 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
7495 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
7496 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
7497 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
7498 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
7499 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
7500 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
7501 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
7502 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
7503 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
7504 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
7505 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
7506 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
7507 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
7508 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
7509 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
7510 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
7511 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
7512 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
7513 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
7514 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
7515 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
7516 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
7517 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_bit_size);
7518 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length_byte_size);
7519 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
7520 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
7521 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
7522 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
7523 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
7524 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
7525 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
7526 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
7527 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
7528 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
7529 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_alignment);
7531 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
7532 c = die->die_child;
7533 if (c) do {
7534 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
7536 c = c->die_sib;
7537 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
7538 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7540 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
7542 else if (name_attr != NULL
7543 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
7545 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
7546 functions. */
7547 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
7548 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
7549 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
7551 else
7553 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
7554 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
7555 if (c->die_mark == 0)
7556 c->die_mark = -1;
7557 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
7559 } while (c != die->die_child);
7561 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
7564 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
7565 static void
7566 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
7568 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
7569 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
7572 #undef CHECKSUM
7573 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
7574 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
7575 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
7576 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
7578 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
7579 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
7580 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
7581 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
7582 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
7583 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
7584 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
7586 static void
7587 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
7589 int mark;
7590 const char *name;
7591 unsigned char checksum[16];
7592 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7593 dw_die_ref decl;
7594 dw_die_ref parent;
7596 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
7597 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7598 parent = get_die_parent (die);
7600 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
7601 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
7602 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
7604 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
7606 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7608 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7609 if (parent != NULL)
7610 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7612 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
7613 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
7614 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7616 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
7619 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
7621 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7622 mark = 1;
7623 die->die_mark = mark;
7625 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
7626 if (parent != NULL)
7627 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
7629 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
7630 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
7631 unmark_all_dies (die);
7632 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7634 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
7635 type node together. */
7636 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
7637 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
7638 die->comdat_type_p = true;
7639 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7640 type_node->type_die = die;
7642 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
7643 as well. */
7644 if (decl != NULL)
7646 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7647 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
7651 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
7652 static inline int
7653 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
7655 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
7656 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
7657 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
7660 /* Do the values look the same? */
7661 static int
7662 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
7664 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
7665 rtx r1, r2;
7667 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
7668 return 0;
7670 switch (v1->val_class)
7672 case dw_val_class_const:
7673 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
7674 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
7675 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7676 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
7677 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
7678 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7679 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
7680 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
7681 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
7682 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
7683 case dw_val_class_vec:
7684 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
7685 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
7686 return 0;
7687 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
7688 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
7689 return 0;
7690 return 1;
7691 case dw_val_class_flag:
7692 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
7693 case dw_val_class_str:
7694 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
7696 case dw_val_class_addr:
7697 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
7698 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
7699 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
7700 return 0;
7701 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
7703 case dw_val_class_offset:
7704 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
7706 case dw_val_class_loc:
7707 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
7708 loc1 && loc2;
7709 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
7710 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
7711 return 0;
7712 return !loc1 && !loc2;
7714 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7715 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
7717 case dw_val_class_symview:
7718 return strcmp (v1->v.val_symbolic_view, v2->v.val_symbolic_view) == 0;
7720 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7721 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
7722 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7723 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7724 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7725 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
7726 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
7727 return 1;
7729 case dw_val_class_file:
7730 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
7731 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
7733 case dw_val_class_data8:
7734 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
7736 default:
7737 return 1;
7741 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
7743 static int
7744 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
7746 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
7747 return 0;
7749 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
7750 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
7751 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
7752 return 1;
7754 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
7757 /* Do the dies look the same? */
7759 static int
7760 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
7762 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
7763 dw_attr_node *a1;
7764 unsigned ix;
7766 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
7767 if (die1->die_mark)
7768 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
7769 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
7771 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
7772 return 0;
7774 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
7775 return 0;
7777 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
7778 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
7779 return 0;
7781 c1 = die1->die_child;
7782 c2 = die2->die_child;
7783 if (! c1)
7785 if (c2)
7786 return 0;
7788 else
7789 for (;;)
7791 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
7792 return 0;
7793 c1 = c1->die_sib;
7794 c2 = c2->die_sib;
7795 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
7797 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
7798 break;
7799 else
7800 return 0;
7804 return 1;
7807 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
7808 children, and set die_symbol. */
7810 static void
7811 compute_comp_unit_symbol (dw_die_ref unit_die)
7813 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
7814 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
7815 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
7816 char *p;
7817 int i, mark;
7818 unsigned char checksum[16];
7819 struct md5_ctx ctx;
7821 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
7822 the name filename of the unit. */
7824 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
7825 mark = 0;
7826 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
7827 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
7828 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
7830 /* When we this for comp_unit_die () we have a DW_AT_name that might
7831 not start with a letter but with anything valid for filenames and
7832 clean_symbol_name doesn't fix that up. Prepend 'g' if the first
7833 character is not a letter. */
7834 sprintf (name, "%s%s.", ISALPHA (*base) ? "" : "g", base);
7835 clean_symbol_name (name);
7837 p = name + strlen (name);
7838 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
7840 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
7841 p += 2;
7844 unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
7847 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
7849 static int
7850 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
7852 switch (die->die_tag)
7854 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7855 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7856 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7857 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7858 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7859 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7860 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7861 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7862 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7863 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7864 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7865 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7866 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7867 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7868 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7869 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7870 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7871 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7872 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7873 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7874 return 1;
7875 default:
7876 return 0;
7880 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
7881 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
7882 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
7883 compilations (functions). */
7885 static int
7886 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
7888 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
7889 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
7890 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
7891 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
7893 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
7894 return 0;
7896 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
7897 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
7898 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
7899 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
7900 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
7902 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
7904 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
7907 return is_type_die (c);
7910 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
7912 static inline bool
7913 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
7915 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7916 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7919 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
7921 static inline bool
7922 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
7924 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
7925 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
7926 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit
7927 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_skeleton_unit);
7930 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7932 static inline bool
7933 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7935 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7938 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7940 static inline bool
7941 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7943 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7944 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7947 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7949 static inline bool
7950 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7952 switch (die->die_tag)
7954 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7955 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7956 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7957 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7958 return true;
7959 default:
7960 return false;
7964 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7966 static inline bool
7967 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7969 dw_die_ref c;
7971 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7972 return false;
7973 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7974 return false;
7977 static char *
7978 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7980 char buf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7982 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7983 return xstrdup (buf);
7986 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7988 static int
7989 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7991 dw_attr_node *a;
7992 unsigned ix;
7994 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7995 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7996 return 1;
7998 return 0;
8001 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
8003 static int
8004 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
8006 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8008 if (decl == NULL)
8009 decl = die;
8010 return local_scope_p (decl);
8013 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
8014 subprogram. */
8016 static int
8017 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
8019 dw_die_ref c;
8021 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
8022 return 1;
8023 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
8024 return 0;
8027 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
8028 COMDAT .debug_types section or .debug_info section with DW_UT_*type
8029 unit type. */
8031 static int
8032 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
8034 switch (die->die_tag)
8036 case DW_TAG_class_type:
8037 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
8038 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
8039 case DW_TAG_union_type:
8040 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
8041 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
8042 if (is_declaration_die (die)
8043 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
8044 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
8045 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
8046 return 0;
8047 return 1;
8048 case DW_TAG_array_type:
8049 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
8050 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
8051 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
8052 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
8053 case DW_TAG_string_type:
8054 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
8055 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
8056 case DW_TAG_set_type:
8057 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
8058 case DW_TAG_base_type:
8059 case DW_TAG_const_type:
8060 case DW_TAG_file_type:
8061 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
8062 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
8063 case DW_TAG_typedef:
8064 default:
8065 return 0;
8069 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
8071 static dw_die_ref
8072 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
8074 dw_die_ref clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
8075 dw_attr_node *a;
8076 unsigned ix;
8078 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8079 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
8081 return clone;
8084 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
8086 static dw_die_ref
8087 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
8089 dw_die_ref c;
8090 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
8092 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
8094 return clone;
8097 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
8099 static dw_die_ref
8100 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
8102 dw_die_ref clone;
8103 dw_die_ref decl;
8104 dw_attr_node *a;
8105 unsigned ix;
8107 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
8108 if (is_declaration_die (die))
8109 return clone_die (die);
8111 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
8112 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8113 if (decl != NULL)
8115 clone = clone_die (decl);
8116 if (die->comdat_type_p)
8117 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
8118 return clone;
8121 clone = new_die_raw (die->die_tag);
8123 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8125 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
8126 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
8127 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
8129 switch (a->dw_attr)
8131 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
8132 case DW_AT_artificial:
8133 case DW_AT_containing_type:
8134 case DW_AT_external:
8135 case DW_AT_name:
8136 case DW_AT_type:
8137 case DW_AT_virtuality:
8138 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
8139 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
8140 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
8141 break;
8142 case DW_AT_byte_size:
8143 case DW_AT_alignment:
8144 default:
8145 break;
8149 if (die->comdat_type_p)
8150 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
8152 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
8153 return clone;
8157 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
8159 struct decl_table_entry
8161 dw_die_ref orig;
8162 dw_die_ref copy;
8165 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
8167 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8169 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
8171 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
8172 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
8173 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
8176 inline hashval_t
8177 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
8179 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
8182 inline bool
8183 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
8184 const die_struct *entry2)
8186 return entry1->orig == entry2;
8189 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
8191 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
8192 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
8193 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
8194 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
8196 static dw_die_ref
8197 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
8198 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8200 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
8201 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
8202 dw_die_ref copy;
8203 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
8204 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
8206 if (decl_table)
8208 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
8209 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
8210 INSERT);
8211 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8213 entry = *slot;
8214 return entry->copy;
8217 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
8218 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8219 entry->orig = die;
8220 entry->copy = NULL;
8221 *slot = entry;
8224 if (parent != NULL)
8226 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
8227 if (spec != NULL)
8228 parent = spec;
8229 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
8230 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
8233 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
8234 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
8236 if (decl_table)
8238 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
8239 entry->copy = copy;
8242 return copy;
8244 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
8245 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
8246 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
8247 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
8248 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
8250 static dw_die_ref
8251 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
8253 dw_die_ref decl;
8254 dw_die_ref new_decl;
8255 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
8257 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8258 if (decl == NULL)
8259 decl = die;
8260 else
8262 unsigned ix;
8263 dw_die_ref c;
8264 dw_attr_node *a;
8266 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
8267 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
8268 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
8270 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
8271 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
8272 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
8273 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8275 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
8277 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
8279 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
8280 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
8281 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
8282 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
8285 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
8288 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
8289 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
8291 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
8292 if (new_decl != NULL)
8294 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
8295 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
8299 return orig_parent;
8302 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
8303 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
8305 static void
8306 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
8308 if (node->new_die != NULL)
8309 return;
8311 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
8313 if (node->parent != NULL)
8315 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
8316 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
8320 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
8321 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
8322 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
8324 static void
8325 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
8327 skeleton_chain_node node;
8328 dw_die_ref c;
8329 dw_die_ref first;
8330 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8331 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8333 node.parent = parent;
8335 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
8336 if (c)
8337 next = c->die_sib;
8338 if (c) do {
8339 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8340 prev = c;
8341 c = next;
8342 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8343 node.old_die = c;
8344 node.new_die = NULL;
8345 if (is_declaration_die (c))
8347 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
8349 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
8350 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
8351 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
8352 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
8353 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8354 c = prev;
8356 else if (c->comdat_type_p)
8358 /* This is the skeleton of earlier break_out_comdat_types
8359 type. Clone the existing DIE, but keep the children
8360 under the original (which is in the main CU). */
8361 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8363 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8364 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8365 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8366 c = clone;
8367 continue;
8369 else
8371 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
8372 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
8373 all the original's children, where the original came from
8374 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
8375 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
8376 move_all_children (c, clone);
8378 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
8379 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
8380 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
8381 the original. */
8382 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
8384 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
8385 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
8386 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
8387 node.old_die = clone;
8388 node.new_die = c;
8389 c = clone;
8392 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8393 } while (next != NULL);
8396 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
8398 static dw_die_ref
8399 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
8401 skeleton_chain_node node;
8403 node.old_die = die;
8404 node.new_die = NULL;
8405 node.parent = NULL;
8407 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
8408 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
8409 at least a declaration in its place. */
8410 if (die->die_parent != NULL
8411 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
8412 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
8413 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
8415 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
8416 return node.new_die;
8419 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
8420 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
8421 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
8422 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
8423 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
8424 skeleton tree. */
8426 static dw_die_ref
8427 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
8428 dw_die_ref prev)
8430 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
8432 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
8433 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
8434 that DIE. */
8435 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
8437 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
8438 if (skeleton == NULL)
8439 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8440 else
8442 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
8443 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
8445 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
8446 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
8447 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
8448 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
8449 references to it. */
8450 if (orig_parent != NULL)
8452 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
8453 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
8455 else
8456 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
8459 return skeleton;
8462 static void
8463 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8464 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8465 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
8467 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
8468 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
8469 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
8471 static dw_die_ref
8472 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
8473 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8474 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8476 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
8478 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
8479 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
8481 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
8482 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
8483 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
8485 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
8486 bool existed;
8487 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
8488 if (existed)
8489 return die_copy;
8491 die_copy = clone_die (die);
8492 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
8493 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8494 return die_copy;
8497 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
8498 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
8500 static void
8501 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
8502 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8503 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8505 dw_attr_node *a;
8506 unsigned i;
8508 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
8510 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8512 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
8513 continue;
8515 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8517 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
8519 case DW_OP_call2:
8520 case DW_OP_call4:
8521 case DW_OP_call_ref:
8522 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
8523 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
8524 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
8525 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
8526 type_node,
8527 copied_dwarf_procs);
8529 default:
8530 break;
8536 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
8537 rewrite references to point to the copies.
8539 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
8540 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
8541 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
8542 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
8544 static void
8545 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
8546 comdat_type_node *type_node,
8547 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
8549 dw_die_ref c;
8551 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8552 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
8553 type_node,
8554 copied_dwarf_procs));
8557 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types or .debug_info
8558 DW_UT_*type sections for each type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT
8559 section. */
8561 static void
8562 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
8564 dw_die_ref c;
8565 dw_die_ref first;
8566 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
8567 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
8568 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
8570 first = c = die->die_child;
8571 if (c)
8572 next = c->die_sib;
8573 if (c) do {
8574 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
8575 prev = c;
8576 c = next;
8577 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
8578 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
8580 dw_die_ref replacement;
8581 comdat_type_node *type_node;
8583 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
8584 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8586 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
8587 add it to the list of comdat types. */
8588 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
8589 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
8590 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
8591 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
8592 type_node->root_die = unit;
8593 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
8594 comdat_type_list = type_node;
8596 /* Generate the type signature. */
8597 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
8599 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
8600 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
8601 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
8602 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
8603 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
8605 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
8606 add_child_die (unit, c);
8608 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
8609 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
8610 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
8611 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
8612 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
8613 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
8615 if (replacement != NULL)
8616 c = replacement;
8618 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
8619 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
8620 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
8621 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
8623 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
8624 break_out_comdat_types (c);
8626 } while (next != NULL);
8629 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
8630 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
8632 static dw_die_ref
8633 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8635 dw_die_ref c;
8636 dw_die_ref clone;
8637 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8638 decl_table_entry **slot;
8640 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8641 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
8642 else
8643 clone = clone_die (die);
8645 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
8646 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
8648 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
8649 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
8650 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
8651 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
8653 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8654 entry->orig = die;
8655 entry->copy = clone;
8656 *slot = entry;
8658 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
8659 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
8660 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8662 return clone;
8665 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
8666 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
8667 type_unit). */
8669 static void
8670 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
8672 dw_die_ref c;
8673 dw_attr_node *a;
8674 unsigned ix;
8676 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8678 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8680 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
8681 decl_table_entry **slot;
8682 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
8684 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
8685 continue;
8687 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
8688 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
8689 INSERT);
8691 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8693 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
8694 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
8695 entry = *slot;
8696 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
8698 else
8700 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
8701 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
8703 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
8704 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
8705 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
8706 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
8707 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
8708 entry->orig = targ;
8709 entry->copy = copy;
8710 *slot = entry;
8712 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
8713 children. */
8714 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
8716 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
8717 targ, c,
8718 add_child_die (copy,
8719 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
8722 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
8723 type unit. */
8724 mark_dies (copy);
8726 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
8727 into the new type unit. */
8728 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
8729 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
8730 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
8731 decl_table);
8733 add_child_die (parent, copy);
8734 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
8736 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
8737 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
8738 get visited otherwise. */
8739 if (parent != unit)
8741 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
8742 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
8743 parent->die_mark = 1;
8744 while (parent->die_parent
8745 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
8747 parent = parent->die_parent;
8748 parent->die_mark = 1;
8750 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
8756 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8759 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8760 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8761 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8762 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8763 don't have an external reference. */
8765 static void
8766 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8768 mark_dies (unit);
8769 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8770 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8771 unmark_dies (unit);
8774 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8775 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8776 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8778 static void
8779 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8781 dw_die_ref c;
8783 if (! die->die_child)
8784 return;
8786 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8787 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8789 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8792 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8794 static void
8795 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8797 dw_die_ref c;
8798 dw_attr_node *a;
8799 unsigned ix;
8801 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8802 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8803 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8805 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8808 /* During assign_location_list_indexes and output_loclists_offset the
8809 current index, after it the number of assigned indexes (i.e. how
8810 large the .debug_loclists* offset table should be). */
8811 static unsigned int loc_list_idx;
8813 /* Output all location list offsets for the DIE and its children. */
8815 static void
8816 output_loclists_offsets (dw_die_ref die)
8818 dw_die_ref c;
8819 dw_attr_node *a;
8820 unsigned ix;
8822 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8823 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8825 dw_loc_list_ref l = AT_loc_list (a);
8826 if (l->offset_emitted)
8827 continue;
8828 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l->ll_symbol,
8829 loc_section_label, NULL);
8830 gcc_assert (l->hash == loc_list_idx);
8831 loc_list_idx++;
8832 l->offset_emitted = true;
8835 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_loclists_offsets (c));
8838 /* Recursively set indexes of location lists. */
8840 static void
8841 assign_location_list_indexes (dw_die_ref die)
8843 dw_die_ref c;
8844 dw_attr_node *a;
8845 unsigned ix;
8847 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8848 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8850 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
8851 if (!list->num_assigned)
8853 list->num_assigned = true;
8854 list->hash = loc_list_idx++;
8858 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_location_list_indexes (c));
8861 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8862 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8863 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8864 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8865 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8866 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8868 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8869 references. */
8871 struct external_ref
8873 dw_die_ref type;
8874 dw_die_ref stub;
8875 unsigned n_refs;
8878 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8880 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8882 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8883 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8886 inline hashval_t
8887 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8889 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8890 hashval_t h = 0;
8892 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8893 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8894 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8895 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8896 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8897 else
8899 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8900 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8901 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8902 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8904 return h;
8907 inline bool
8908 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8910 return r1->type == r2->type;
8913 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8915 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8917 static struct external_ref *
8918 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8920 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8921 external_ref **slot;
8923 ref.type = die;
8924 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8925 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8926 return *slot;
8928 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8929 ref_p->type = die;
8930 *slot = ref_p;
8931 return ref_p;
8934 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8936 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8937 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8939 static void
8940 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8942 dw_die_ref c;
8943 dw_attr_node *a;
8944 unsigned ix;
8945 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8947 if (is_type_die (die)
8948 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8950 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8951 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8952 ref_p->stub = die;
8955 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8956 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8957 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8958 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8959 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8960 && is_type_die (c))
8962 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8963 ref_p->n_refs++;
8966 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8969 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8970 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8971 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8974 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8976 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8978 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8980 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8981 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8982 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8983 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8984 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8985 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8987 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8989 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8990 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8991 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8993 else
8995 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8996 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8997 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
9000 stub->die_mark++;
9001 ref_p->stub = stub;
9003 return 1;
9006 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
9007 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
9008 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
9009 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
9011 static external_ref_hash_type *
9012 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
9014 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
9015 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
9016 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
9017 return map;
9020 /* The following 3 variables are temporaries that are computed only during the
9021 build_abbrev_table call and used and released during the following
9022 optimize_abbrev_table call. */
9024 /* First abbrev_id that can be optimized based on usage. */
9025 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_start;
9027 /* Maximum abbrev_id of a base type plus one (we can't optimize DIEs with
9028 abbrev_id smaller than this, because they must be already sized
9029 during build_abbrev_table). */
9030 static unsigned int abbrev_opt_base_type_end;
9032 /* Vector of usage counts during build_abbrev_table. Indexed by
9033 abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start. */
9034 static vec<unsigned int> abbrev_usage_count;
9036 /* Vector of all DIEs added with die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start. */
9037 static vec<dw_die_ref> sorted_abbrev_dies;
9039 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
9040 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
9041 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
9042 die are visited recursively. */
9044 static void
9045 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
9047 unsigned int abbrev_id = 0;
9048 dw_die_ref c;
9049 dw_attr_node *a;
9050 unsigned ix;
9051 dw_die_ref abbrev;
9053 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
9054 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
9055 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
9056 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9057 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
9058 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
9060 struct external_ref *ref_p;
9061 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
9063 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
9064 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
9065 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
9066 else
9067 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
9068 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
9071 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
9073 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
9074 unsigned ix;
9075 bool ok = true;
9077 if (abbrev_id == 0)
9078 continue;
9079 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
9080 continue;
9081 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
9082 continue;
9084 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
9085 continue;
9087 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
9089 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
9090 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
9091 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
9093 ok = false;
9094 break;
9097 if (ok)
9098 break;
9101 if (abbrev_id >= vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table))
9103 vec_safe_push (abbrev_die_table, die);
9104 if (abbrev_opt_start)
9105 abbrev_usage_count.safe_push (0);
9107 if (abbrev_opt_start && abbrev_id >= abbrev_opt_start)
9109 abbrev_usage_count[abbrev_id - abbrev_opt_start]++;
9110 sorted_abbrev_dies.safe_push (die);
9113 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9114 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
9117 /* Callback function for sorted_abbrev_dies vector sorting. We sort
9118 by die_abbrev's usage count, from the most commonly used
9119 abbreviation to the least. */
9121 static int
9122 die_abbrev_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
9124 dw_die_ref die1 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p1;
9125 dw_die_ref die2 = *(const dw_die_ref *) p2;
9127 gcc_checking_assert (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
9128 gcc_checking_assert (die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_start);
9130 if (die1->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end
9131 && die2->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9133 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
9134 > abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
9135 return -1;
9136 if (abbrev_usage_count[die1->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start]
9137 < abbrev_usage_count[die2->die_abbrev - abbrev_opt_start])
9138 return 1;
9141 /* Stabilize the sort. */
9142 if (die1->die_abbrev < die2->die_abbrev)
9143 return -1;
9144 if (die1->die_abbrev > die2->die_abbrev)
9145 return 1;
9147 return 0;
9150 /* Convert dw_val_class_const and dw_val_class_unsigned_const class attributes
9151 of DIEs in between sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id] and abbrev_dies[end_id - 1]
9152 into dw_val_class_const_implicit or
9153 dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit. */
9155 static void
9156 optimize_implicit_const (unsigned int first_id, unsigned int end,
9157 vec<bool> &implicit_consts)
9159 /* It never makes sense if there is just one DIE using the abbreviation. */
9160 if (end < first_id + 2)
9161 return;
9163 dw_attr_node *a;
9164 unsigned ix, i;
9165 dw_die_ref die = sorted_abbrev_dies[first_id];
9166 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9167 if (implicit_consts[ix])
9169 enum dw_val_class new_class = dw_val_class_none;
9170 switch (AT_class (a))
9172 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9173 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) AT_unsigned (a) < 0)
9174 continue;
9176 /* The .debug_abbrev section will grow by
9177 size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)) and we avoid the constants
9178 in all the DIEs using that abbreviation. */
9179 if (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)) * (end - first_id)
9180 <= (unsigned) size_of_sleb128 (AT_unsigned (a)))
9181 continue;
9183 new_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit;
9184 break;
9186 case dw_val_class_const:
9187 new_class = dw_val_class_const_implicit;
9188 break;
9190 case dw_val_class_file:
9191 new_class = dw_val_class_file_implicit;
9192 break;
9194 default:
9195 continue;
9197 for (i = first_id; i < end; i++)
9198 (*sorted_abbrev_dies[i]->die_attr)[ix].dw_attr_val.val_class
9199 = new_class;
9203 /* Attempt to optimize abbreviation table from abbrev_opt_start
9204 abbreviation above. */
9206 static void
9207 optimize_abbrev_table (void)
9209 if (abbrev_opt_start
9210 && vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > abbrev_opt_start
9211 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) > 127))
9213 auto_vec<bool, 32> implicit_consts;
9214 sorted_abbrev_dies.qsort (die_abbrev_cmp);
9216 unsigned int abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_start - 1;
9217 unsigned int first_id = ~0U;
9218 unsigned int last_abbrev_id = 0;
9219 unsigned int i;
9220 dw_die_ref die;
9221 if (abbrev_opt_base_type_end > abbrev_opt_start)
9222 abbrev_id = abbrev_opt_base_type_end - 1;
9223 /* Reassign abbreviation ids from abbrev_opt_start above, so that
9224 most commonly used abbreviations come first. */
9225 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (sorted_abbrev_dies, i, die)
9227 dw_attr_node *a;
9228 unsigned ix;
9230 /* If calc_base_type_die_sizes has been called, the CU and
9231 base types after it can't be optimized, because we've already
9232 calculated their DIE offsets. We've sorted them first. */
9233 if (die->die_abbrev < abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9234 continue;
9235 if (die->die_abbrev != last_abbrev_id)
9237 last_abbrev_id = die->die_abbrev;
9238 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
9239 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
9240 abbrev_id++;
9241 (*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id] = die;
9242 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9244 first_id = i;
9245 implicit_consts.truncate (0);
9247 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9248 switch (AT_class (a))
9250 case dw_val_class_const:
9251 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9252 case dw_val_class_file:
9253 implicit_consts.safe_push (true);
9254 break;
9255 default:
9256 implicit_consts.safe_push (false);
9257 break;
9261 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9263 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9264 if (!implicit_consts[ix])
9265 continue;
9266 else
9268 dw_attr_node *other_a
9269 = &(*(*abbrev_die_table)[abbrev_id]->die_attr)[ix];
9270 if (!dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_attr_val,
9271 &other_a->dw_attr_val))
9272 implicit_consts[ix] = false;
9275 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9277 gcc_assert (abbrev_id == vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) - 1);
9278 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && first_id != ~0U)
9279 optimize_implicit_const (first_id, i, implicit_consts);
9282 abbrev_opt_start = 0;
9283 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = 0;
9284 abbrev_usage_count.release ();
9285 sorted_abbrev_dies.release ();
9288 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
9290 static int
9291 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
9293 int log;
9295 if (value == 0)
9296 log = 0;
9297 else
9298 log = floor_log2 (value);
9300 log = log / 8;
9301 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
9303 return log;
9306 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
9307 .debug_info section. */
9309 static unsigned long
9310 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
9312 unsigned long size = 0;
9313 dw_attr_node *a;
9314 unsigned ix;
9315 enum dwarf_form form;
9317 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
9318 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9320 switch (AT_class (a))
9322 case dw_val_class_addr:
9323 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9325 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9326 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9328 else
9329 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9330 break;
9331 case dw_val_class_offset:
9332 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9333 break;
9334 case dw_val_class_loc:
9336 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9338 /* Block length. */
9339 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9340 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
9341 else
9342 size += constant_size (lsize);
9343 size += lsize;
9345 break;
9346 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9347 case dw_val_class_view_list:
9348 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && dwarf_version >= 5)
9350 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
9351 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash);
9353 else
9354 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9355 break;
9356 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9357 if (value_format (a) == DW_FORM_rnglistx)
9359 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
9360 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
9361 size += size_of_uleb128 (r->idx);
9363 else
9364 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9365 break;
9366 case dw_val_class_const:
9367 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9368 break;
9369 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9371 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9372 if (dwarf_version == 3
9373 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9374 && csize >= 4)
9375 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
9376 else
9377 size += csize;
9379 break;
9380 case dw_val_class_symview:
9381 if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
9382 size += 1;
9383 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
9384 size += 2;
9385 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
9386 size += 4;
9387 else
9388 size += 8;
9389 break;
9390 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9391 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9392 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9393 /* These occupy no size in the DIE, just an extra sleb128 in
9394 .debug_abbrev. */
9395 break;
9396 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9397 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9398 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9399 size++; /* block */
9400 break;
9401 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9402 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9403 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
9404 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
9405 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
9406 size++; /* block */
9407 break;
9408 case dw_val_class_vec:
9409 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9410 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9411 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9412 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9413 break;
9414 case dw_val_class_flag:
9415 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9416 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9417 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9418 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9419 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9420 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9421 the same abbrev entry. */
9422 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9423 else
9424 size += 1;
9425 break;
9426 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9427 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9429 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
9430 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9431 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9432 it's always sized as an offset. */
9433 if (use_debug_types)
9434 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9435 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9436 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9437 else
9438 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9440 else
9441 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9442 break;
9443 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9444 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9445 break;
9446 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9447 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9449 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
9450 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9452 else
9453 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9454 break;
9455 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9456 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9457 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9458 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9459 break;
9460 case dw_val_class_str:
9461 form = AT_string_form (a);
9462 if (form == DW_FORM_strp || form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
9463 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9464 else if (form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx))
9465 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
9466 else
9467 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9468 break;
9469 case dw_val_class_file:
9470 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9471 break;
9472 case dw_val_class_data8:
9473 size += 8;
9474 break;
9475 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9476 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9477 break;
9478 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9479 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9480 break;
9481 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9482 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
9483 break;
9484 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9486 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
9488 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
9489 data. */
9490 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
9492 break;
9493 default:
9494 gcc_unreachable ();
9498 return size;
9501 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9502 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9503 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9504 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9506 static void
9507 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9509 dw_die_ref c;
9511 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
9512 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
9513 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9514 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
9516 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
9518 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9519 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
9520 next_die_offset += 1;
9523 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
9524 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
9525 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
9526 values for the base types. */
9528 static void
9529 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
9531 unsigned long die_offset = (dwarf_split_debug_info
9532 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
9533 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
9534 unsigned int i;
9535 dw_die_ref base_type;
9536 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9537 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
9538 #endif
9540 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
9541 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
9543 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
9544 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
9545 && prev->die_sib == base_type
9546 && base_type->die_child == NULL
9547 && base_type->die_abbrev);
9548 prev = base_type;
9549 #endif
9550 if (abbrev_opt_start
9551 && base_type->die_abbrev >= abbrev_opt_base_type_end)
9552 abbrev_opt_base_type_end = base_type->die_abbrev + 1;
9553 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
9554 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
9558 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
9559 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
9560 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
9561 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
9563 static void
9564 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9566 dw_die_ref c;
9568 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
9570 die->die_mark = 1;
9571 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
9574 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
9576 static void
9577 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9579 dw_die_ref c;
9581 if (! use_debug_types)
9582 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
9584 die->die_mark = 0;
9585 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
9588 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
9590 static void
9591 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
9593 dw_die_ref c;
9594 dw_attr_node *a;
9595 unsigned ix;
9597 if (!die->die_mark)
9598 return;
9599 die->die_mark = 0;
9601 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
9603 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9604 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9605 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
9608 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
9609 from a pruned a type. */
9611 static bool
9612 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
9614 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
9615 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
9616 enough information to be useful. */
9617 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
9618 return false;
9620 if (table == pubname_table)
9622 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
9623 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
9624 Don't output them if that is the case. */
9625 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
9626 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
9627 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
9628 return false;
9630 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
9631 return true;
9634 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
9635 pruned. */
9636 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
9637 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
9640 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
9641 generated for the compilation unit. */
9643 static unsigned long
9644 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9646 unsigned long size;
9647 unsigned i;
9648 pubname_entry *p;
9649 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
9651 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
9652 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
9653 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
9654 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
9656 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9657 return size;
9660 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
9662 static unsigned long
9663 size_of_aranges (void)
9665 unsigned long size;
9667 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
9669 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
9670 if (text_section_used)
9671 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9672 if (cold_text_section_used)
9673 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9674 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9676 unsigned fde_idx;
9677 dw_fde_ref fde;
9679 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9681 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9682 continue;
9683 if (!fde->in_std_section)
9684 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9685 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9686 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9690 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
9691 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9692 return size;
9695 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
9697 static enum dwarf_form
9698 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9700 switch (AT_class (a))
9702 case dw_val_class_addr:
9703 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
9704 switch (a->dw_attr)
9706 case DW_AT_low_pc:
9707 case DW_AT_high_pc:
9708 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
9709 case DW_AT_trampoline:
9710 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9711 ? DW_FORM_addr : dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_addrx));
9712 default:
9713 break;
9715 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9717 case 1:
9718 return DW_FORM_data1;
9719 case 2:
9720 return DW_FORM_data2;
9721 case 4:
9722 return DW_FORM_data4;
9723 case 8:
9724 return DW_FORM_data8;
9725 default:
9726 gcc_unreachable ();
9728 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9729 case dw_val_class_view_list:
9730 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9731 && dwarf_version >= 5
9732 && AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned)
9733 return DW_FORM_loclistx;
9734 /* FALLTHRU */
9735 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9736 /* For range lists in DWARF 5, use DW_FORM_rnglistx from .debug_info.dwo
9737 but in .debug_info use DW_FORM_sec_offset, which is shorter if we
9738 care about sizes of .debug* sections in shared libraries and
9739 executables and don't take into account relocations that affect just
9740 relocatable objects - for DW_FORM_rnglistx we'd have to emit offset
9741 table in the .debug_rnglists section. */
9742 if (dwarf_split_debug_info
9743 && dwarf_version >= 5
9744 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_range_list
9745 && rnglist_idx
9746 && a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9747 return DW_FORM_rnglistx;
9748 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9749 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
9750 /* FALLTHRU */
9751 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9752 case dw_val_class_offset:
9753 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
9755 case 4:
9756 return DW_FORM_data4;
9757 case 8:
9758 return DW_FORM_data8;
9759 default:
9760 gcc_unreachable ();
9762 case dw_val_class_loc:
9763 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9764 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
9765 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
9767 case 1:
9768 return DW_FORM_block1;
9769 case 2:
9770 return DW_FORM_block2;
9771 case 4:
9772 return DW_FORM_block4;
9773 default:
9774 gcc_unreachable ();
9776 case dw_val_class_const:
9777 return DW_FORM_sdata;
9778 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9779 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
9781 case 1:
9782 return DW_FORM_data1;
9783 case 2:
9784 return DW_FORM_data2;
9785 case 4:
9786 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
9787 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
9788 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
9789 a large constant. */
9790 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9791 return DW_FORM_udata;
9792 return DW_FORM_data4;
9793 case 8:
9794 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
9795 return DW_FORM_udata;
9796 return DW_FORM_data8;
9797 default:
9798 gcc_unreachable ();
9800 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
9801 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
9802 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
9803 return DW_FORM_implicit_const;
9804 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9805 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9807 case 8:
9808 return DW_FORM_data2;
9809 case 16:
9810 return DW_FORM_data4;
9811 case 32:
9812 return DW_FORM_data8;
9813 case 64:
9814 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9815 return DW_FORM_data16;
9816 /* FALLTHRU */
9817 default:
9818 return DW_FORM_block1;
9820 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9821 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9823 case 8:
9824 return DW_FORM_data1;
9825 case 16:
9826 return DW_FORM_data2;
9827 case 32:
9828 return DW_FORM_data4;
9829 case 64:
9830 return DW_FORM_data8;
9831 case 128:
9832 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
9833 return DW_FORM_data16;
9834 /* FALLTHRU */
9835 default:
9836 return DW_FORM_block1;
9838 case dw_val_class_symview:
9839 /* ??? We might use uleb128, but then we'd have to compute
9840 .debug_info offsets in the assembler. */
9841 if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
9842 return DW_FORM_data1;
9843 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
9844 return DW_FORM_data2;
9845 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
9846 return DW_FORM_data4;
9847 else
9848 return DW_FORM_data8;
9849 case dw_val_class_vec:
9850 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9851 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
9853 case 1:
9854 return DW_FORM_block1;
9855 case 2:
9856 return DW_FORM_block2;
9857 case 4:
9858 return DW_FORM_block4;
9859 default:
9860 gcc_unreachable ();
9862 case dw_val_class_flag:
9863 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9865 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9866 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9867 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9868 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9869 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9870 the same abbrev entry. */
9871 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
9872 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
9874 return DW_FORM_flag;
9875 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9876 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9877 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
9878 else
9879 return DW_FORM_ref;
9880 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9881 return DW_FORM_data;
9882 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9883 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
9884 ? DW_FORM_addr : dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_addrx));
9885 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9886 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9887 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
9888 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
9889 case dw_val_class_str:
9890 return AT_string_form (a);
9891 case dw_val_class_file:
9892 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
9894 case 1:
9895 return DW_FORM_data1;
9896 case 2:
9897 return DW_FORM_data2;
9898 case 4:
9899 return DW_FORM_data4;
9900 default:
9901 gcc_unreachable ();
9904 case dw_val_class_data8:
9905 return DW_FORM_data8;
9907 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9908 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9910 case 1:
9911 return DW_FORM_data1;
9912 case 2:
9913 return DW_FORM_data2;
9914 case 4:
9915 return DW_FORM_data4;
9916 case 8:
9917 return DW_FORM_data8;
9918 default:
9919 gcc_unreachable ();
9922 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9923 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
9924 ? DW_FORM_udata
9925 : DW_FORM_sdata);
9926 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9927 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
9929 case 1:
9930 return DW_FORM_block1;
9931 case 2:
9932 return DW_FORM_block2;
9933 case 4:
9934 return DW_FORM_block4;
9935 default:
9936 gcc_unreachable ();
9939 default:
9940 gcc_unreachable ();
9944 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
9946 static void
9947 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
9949 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
9951 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
9954 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
9956 static void
9957 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
9959 unsigned ix;
9960 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
9962 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
9963 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
9964 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
9966 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
9967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
9968 else
9969 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
9971 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
9973 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
9974 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
9975 output_value_format (a_attr);
9976 if (value_format (a_attr) == DW_FORM_implicit_const)
9978 if (AT_class (a_attr) == dw_val_class_file_implicit)
9980 int f = maybe_emit_file (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9981 const char *filename = a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename;
9982 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (f, "(%s)", filename);
9984 else
9985 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int, NULL);
9989 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9990 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
9994 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
9995 table. */
9997 static void
9998 output_abbrev_section (void)
10000 unsigned int abbrev_id;
10001 dw_die_ref abbrev;
10003 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (abbrev_die_table, abbrev_id, abbrev)
10004 if (abbrev_id != 0)
10005 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev);
10007 /* Terminate the table. */
10008 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10011 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10012 expression. */
10014 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10015 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, var_loc_view vbegin,
10016 const char *end, var_loc_view vend,
10017 const char *section)
10019 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
10021 retlist->begin = begin;
10022 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
10023 retlist->end = end;
10024 retlist->expr = expr;
10025 retlist->section = section;
10026 retlist->vbegin = vbegin;
10027 retlist->vend = vend;
10029 return retlist;
10032 /* Return true iff there's any nonzero view number in the loc list. */
10034 static bool
10035 loc_list_has_views (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10037 if (!debug_variable_location_views)
10038 return false;
10040 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc = list;
10041 loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
10042 if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (loc->vbegin) || !ZERO_VIEW_P (loc->vend))
10043 return true;
10045 return false;
10048 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
10049 hasn't got one yet. */
10051 static inline void
10052 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10054 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
10055 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10057 if (!loc_list_has_views (list))
10058 return;
10060 if (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
10062 /* Use the same label_num for the view list. */
10063 label_num--;
10064 list->vl_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LVUS");
10066 else
10067 list->vl_symbol = list->ll_symbol;
10070 /* Generate a symbol for the list, but only if we really want to emit
10071 it as a list. */
10073 static inline void
10074 maybe_gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
10076 if (!list || (!list->dw_loc_next && !loc_list_has_views (list)))
10077 return;
10079 gen_llsym (list);
10082 /* Determine whether or not to skip loc_list entry CURR. If SIZEP is
10083 NULL, don't consider size of the location expression. If we're not
10084 to skip it, and SIZEP is non-null, store the size of CURR->expr's
10085 representation in *SIZEP. */
10087 static bool
10088 skip_loc_list_entry (dw_loc_list_ref curr, unsigned long *sizep = NULL)
10090 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
10091 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0
10092 && curr->vbegin == curr->vend && !curr->force)
10093 return true;
10095 if (!sizep)
10096 return false;
10098 unsigned long size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10100 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
10101 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
10102 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
10103 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
10104 if (dwarf_version < 5 && size > 0xffff)
10105 return true;
10107 *sizep = size;
10109 return false;
10112 /* Output a view pair loclist entry for CURR, if it requires one. */
10114 static void
10115 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (dw_loc_list_ref curr)
10117 if (!dwarf2out_locviews_in_loclist ())
10118 return;
10120 if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin) && ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10121 return;
10123 #ifdef DW_LLE_view_pair
10124 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_view_pair, "DW_LLE_view_pair");
10126 if (dwarf2out_as_locview_support)
10128 if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin))
10129 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Location view begin");
10130 else
10132 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10133 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vbegin);
10134 dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label, "Location view begin");
10137 if (ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10138 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Location view end");
10139 else
10141 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10142 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vend);
10143 dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label, "Location view end");
10146 else
10148 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vbegin, "Location view begin");
10149 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vend, "Location view end");
10151 #endif /* DW_LLE_view_pair */
10153 return;
10156 /* Output the location list given to us. */
10158 static void
10159 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10161 int vcount = 0, lcount = 0;
10163 if (list_head->emitted)
10164 return;
10165 list_head->emitted = true;
10167 if (list_head->vl_symbol && dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
10169 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->vl_symbol);
10171 for (dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head; curr != NULL;
10172 curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10174 unsigned long size;
10176 if (skip_loc_list_entry (curr, &size))
10177 continue;
10179 vcount++;
10181 /* ?? dwarf_split_debug_info? */
10182 if (dwarf2out_as_locview_support)
10184 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10186 if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vbegin))
10188 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vbegin);
10189 dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label,
10190 "View list begin (%s)",
10191 list_head->vl_symbol);
10193 else
10194 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0,
10195 "View list begin (%s)",
10196 list_head->vl_symbol);
10198 if (!ZERO_VIEW_P (curr->vend))
10200 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", curr->vend);
10201 dw2_asm_output_symname_uleb128 (label,
10202 "View list end (%s)",
10203 list_head->vl_symbol);
10205 else
10206 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0,
10207 "View list end (%s)",
10208 list_head->vl_symbol);
10210 else
10212 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vbegin,
10213 "View list begin (%s)",
10214 list_head->vl_symbol);
10215 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->vend,
10216 "View list end (%s)",
10217 list_head->vl_symbol);
10222 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10224 const char *last_section = NULL;
10225 const char *base_label = NULL;
10227 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
10228 for (dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head; curr != NULL;
10229 curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10231 unsigned long size;
10233 /* Skip this entry? If we skip it here, we must skip it in the
10234 view list above as well. */
10235 if (skip_loc_list_entry (curr, &size))
10236 continue;
10238 lcount++;
10240 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10242 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10244 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10245 /* For -gsplit-dwarf, emit DW_LLE_starx_length, which has
10246 uleb128 index into .debug_addr and uleb128 length. */
10247 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_startx_length,
10248 "DW_LLE_startx_length (%s)",
10249 list_head->ll_symbol);
10250 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
10251 "Location list range start index "
10252 "(%s)", curr->begin);
10253 /* FIXME: This will ICE ifndef HAVE_AS_LEB128.
10254 For that case we probably need to emit DW_LLE_startx_endx,
10255 but we'd need 2 .debug_addr entries rather than just one. */
10256 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
10257 "Location list length (%s)",
10258 list_head->ll_symbol);
10260 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections && HAVE_AS_LEB128)
10262 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10263 /* If all code is in .text section, the base address is
10264 already provided by the CU attributes. Use
10265 DW_LLE_offset_pair where both addresses are uleb128 encoded
10266 offsets against that base. */
10267 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
10268 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
10269 list_head->ll_symbol);
10270 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, curr->section,
10271 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10272 list_head->ll_symbol);
10273 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->section,
10274 "Location list end address (%s)",
10275 list_head->ll_symbol);
10277 else if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
10279 /* Otherwise, find out how many consecutive entries could share
10280 the same base entry. If just one, emit DW_LLE_start_length,
10281 otherwise emit DW_LLE_base_address for the base address
10282 followed by a series of DW_LLE_offset_pair. */
10283 if (last_section == NULL || curr->section != last_section)
10285 dw_loc_list_ref curr2;
10286 for (curr2 = curr->dw_loc_next; curr2 != NULL;
10287 curr2 = curr2->dw_loc_next)
10289 if (strcmp (curr2->begin, curr2->end) == 0
10290 && !curr2->force)
10291 continue;
10292 break;
10294 if (curr2 == NULL || curr->section != curr2->section)
10295 last_section = NULL;
10296 else
10298 last_section = curr->section;
10299 base_label = curr->begin;
10300 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_base_address,
10301 "DW_LLE_base_address (%s)",
10302 list_head->ll_symbol);
10303 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, base_label,
10304 "Base address (%s)",
10305 list_head->ll_symbol);
10308 /* Only one entry with the same base address. Use
10309 DW_LLE_start_length with absolute address and uleb128
10310 length. */
10311 if (last_section == NULL)
10313 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_length,
10315 "DW_LLE_start_length (%s)",
10316 list_head->ll_symbol);
10317 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10318 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10319 list_head->ll_symbol);
10320 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, curr->begin,
10321 "Location list length "
10322 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10324 /* Otherwise emit DW_LLE_offset_pair, relative to above emitted
10325 DW_LLE_base_address. */
10326 else
10328 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10329 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_offset_pair,
10330 "DW_LLE_offset_pair (%s)",
10331 list_head->ll_symbol);
10332 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->begin, base_label,
10333 "Location list begin address "
10334 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10335 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (curr->end, base_label,
10336 "Location list end address "
10337 "(%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10340 /* The assembler does not support .uleb128 directive. Emit
10341 DW_LLE_start_end with a pair of absolute addresses. */
10342 else
10344 dwarf2out_maybe_output_loclist_view_pair (curr);
10345 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_start_end,
10346 "DW_LLE_start_end (%s)",
10347 list_head->ll_symbol);
10348 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10349 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10350 list_head->ll_symbol);
10351 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10352 "Location list end address (%s)",
10353 list_head->ll_symbol);
10356 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10358 /* For -gsplit-dwarf -gdwarf-{2,3,4} emit index into .debug_addr
10359 and 4 byte length. */
10360 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
10361 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
10362 list_head->ll_symbol);
10363 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
10364 "Location list range start index (%s)",
10365 curr->begin);
10366 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
10367 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
10368 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
10369 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
10370 "Location list range length (%s)",
10371 list_head->ll_symbol);
10373 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10375 /* Pair of relative addresses against start of text section. */
10376 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10377 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10378 list_head->ll_symbol);
10379 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10380 "Location list end address (%s)",
10381 list_head->ll_symbol);
10383 else
10385 /* Pair of absolute addresses. */
10386 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10387 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10388 list_head->ll_symbol);
10389 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10390 "Location list end address (%s)",
10391 list_head->ll_symbol);
10394 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10395 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10396 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Location expression size");
10397 else
10399 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10400 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "Location expression size");
10403 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
10406 /* And finally list termination. */
10407 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10408 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_end_of_list,
10409 "DW_LLE_end_of_list (%s)", list_head->ll_symbol);
10410 else if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10411 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
10412 "Location list terminator (%s)",
10413 list_head->ll_symbol);
10414 else
10416 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10417 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10418 list_head->ll_symbol);
10419 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10420 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10421 list_head->ll_symbol);
10424 gcc_assert (!list_head->vl_symbol
10425 || vcount == lcount * (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute () ? 1 : 0));
10428 /* Output a range_list offset into the .debug_ranges or .debug_rnglists
10429 section. Emit a relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise,
10430 emit an indirect reference. */
10432 static void
10433 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10435 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10437 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
10439 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10441 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
10442 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
10443 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10445 else
10447 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10448 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10449 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10450 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10451 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10452 *p = '\0';
10455 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10457 dw_ranges *r = &(*ranges_table)[a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset];
10458 gcc_assert (rnglist_idx);
10459 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r->idx, "%s", name);
10461 else
10462 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10463 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10464 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
10467 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
10469 static void
10470 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10472 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
10474 gcc_assert (sym);
10475 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
10476 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10477 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10478 else if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10480 gcc_assert (AT_loc_list (a)->num_assigned);
10481 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_loc_list (a)->hash, "%s (%s)",
10482 dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr),
10483 sym);
10485 else
10486 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
10487 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10490 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
10492 static void
10493 output_view_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
10495 char *sym = (*AT_loc_list_ptr (a))->vl_symbol;
10497 gcc_assert (sym);
10498 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10499 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
10500 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10501 else
10502 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10503 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
10506 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
10508 static void
10509 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
10511 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10513 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
10515 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
10516 return;
10518 switch (AT_class (a))
10520 case dw_val_class_addr:
10521 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10522 break;
10523 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10524 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10525 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
10526 break;
10527 default:
10528 gcc_unreachable ();
10532 /* Output a type signature. */
10534 static inline void
10535 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10537 int i;
10539 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10540 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10543 /* Output a discriminant value. */
10545 static inline void
10546 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
10548 if (discr_value->pos)
10549 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
10550 else
10551 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
10554 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
10555 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10557 static void
10558 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10560 dw_attr_node *a;
10561 dw_die_ref c;
10562 unsigned long size;
10563 unsigned ix;
10565 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
10566 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10567 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10569 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
10571 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10573 switch (AT_class (a))
10575 case dw_val_class_addr:
10576 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10577 break;
10579 case dw_val_class_offset:
10580 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10581 "%s", name);
10582 break;
10584 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10585 output_range_list_offset (a);
10586 break;
10588 case dw_val_class_loc:
10589 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10591 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10592 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10593 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
10594 else
10595 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10597 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
10598 break;
10600 case dw_val_class_const:
10601 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10602 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10603 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10604 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10605 break;
10607 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10609 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10610 if (dwarf_version == 3
10611 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
10612 && csize >= 4)
10613 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10614 else
10615 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10617 break;
10619 case dw_val_class_symview:
10621 int vsize;
10622 if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xff)
10623 vsize = 1;
10624 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffff)
10625 vsize = 2;
10626 else if (symview_upper_bound <= 0xffffffff)
10627 vsize = 4;
10628 else
10629 vsize = 8;
10630 dw2_asm_output_addr (vsize, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_symbolic_view,
10631 "%s", name);
10633 break;
10635 case dw_val_class_const_implicit:
10636 if (flag_debug_asm)
10637 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10638 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ")\n",
10639 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_int (a));
10640 break;
10642 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const_implicit:
10643 if (flag_debug_asm)
10644 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s ("
10645 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX ")\n",
10646 ASM_COMMENT_START, name, AT_unsigned (a));
10647 break;
10649 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10651 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10653 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10654 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10655 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
10656 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10657 NULL);
10659 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10661 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10662 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10664 else
10666 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10667 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10670 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10671 first, "%s", name);
10672 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10673 second, NULL);
10675 break;
10677 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
10679 int i;
10680 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
10681 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10682 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > DWARF_LARGEST_DATA_FORM_BITS)
10683 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
10684 * l, NULL);
10686 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10687 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10689 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10690 "%s", name);
10691 name = "";
10693 else
10694 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
10696 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
10697 "%s", name);
10698 name = "";
10701 break;
10703 case dw_val_class_vec:
10705 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10706 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10707 unsigned int i;
10708 unsigned char *p;
10710 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10711 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10712 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10714 elt_size /= 2;
10715 len *= 2;
10717 for (i = 0, p = (unsigned char *) a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10718 i < len;
10719 i++, p += elt_size)
10720 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10721 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10722 break;
10725 case dw_val_class_flag:
10726 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10728 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10729 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10730 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10731 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10732 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10733 the same abbrev entry. */
10734 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
10735 if (flag_debug_asm)
10736 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
10737 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
10738 break;
10740 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10741 break;
10743 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10744 output_loc_list_offset (a);
10745 break;
10747 case dw_val_class_view_list:
10748 output_view_list_offset (a);
10749 break;
10751 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10752 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10754 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
10756 comdat_type_node *type_node
10757 = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10759 gcc_assert (type_node);
10760 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10762 else
10764 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10765 int size;
10767 gcc_assert (sym);
10768 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10769 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10770 offset. */
10771 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10772 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10773 else
10774 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10775 /* ??? We cannot unconditionally output die_offset if
10776 non-zero - others might create references to those
10777 DIEs via symbols.
10778 And we do not clear its DIE offset after outputting it
10779 (and the label refers to the actual DIEs, not the
10780 DWARF CU unit header which is when using label + offset
10781 would be the correct thing to do).
10782 ??? This is the reason for the with_offset flag. */
10783 if (AT_ref (a)->with_offset)
10784 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10785 debug_info_section, "%s", name);
10786 else
10787 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10788 name);
10791 else
10793 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10794 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10795 "%s", name);
10797 break;
10799 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10801 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10803 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10804 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10805 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10806 "%s", name);
10808 break;
10810 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10811 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
10812 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10813 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10814 "%s", name);
10815 #else
10816 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10817 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
10818 "%s", name);
10819 #endif
10820 break;
10822 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10823 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
10824 break;
10826 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10827 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10828 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10829 break;
10831 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10832 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10833 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10834 break;
10836 case dw_val_class_loclistsptr:
10837 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10838 debug_loc_section, "%s", name);
10839 break;
10841 case dw_val_class_str:
10842 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
10843 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10844 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10845 debug_str_section,
10846 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10847 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_line_strp)
10848 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10849 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10850 debug_line_str_section,
10851 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10852 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx))
10853 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
10854 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10855 else
10856 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10857 break;
10859 case dw_val_class_file:
10861 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10863 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10864 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10865 break;
10868 case dw_val_class_file_implicit:
10869 if (flag_debug_asm)
10870 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s (%d, %s)\n",
10871 ASM_COMMENT_START, name,
10872 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file),
10873 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10874 break;
10876 case dw_val_class_data8:
10878 int i;
10880 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10881 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10882 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10883 break;
10886 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
10887 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10888 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
10889 break;
10891 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
10892 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
10893 break;
10895 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
10897 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
10898 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
10900 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
10901 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
10902 "%s: block size", name);
10904 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
10906 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
10907 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
10908 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10909 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
10910 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
10911 else
10912 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
10913 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
10915 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
10916 if (list->dw_discr_range)
10917 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
10919 break;
10922 default:
10923 gcc_unreachable ();
10927 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10929 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10930 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
10932 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10935 /* Output the dwarf version number. */
10937 static void
10938 output_dwarf_version ()
10940 /* ??? For now, if -gdwarf-6 is specified, we output version 5 with
10941 views in loclist. That will change eventually. */
10942 if (dwarf_version == 6)
10944 static bool once;
10945 if (!once)
10947 warning (0,
10948 "-gdwarf-6 is output as version 5 with incompatibilities");
10949 once = true;
10951 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 5, "DWARF version number");
10953 else
10954 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version, "DWARF version number");
10957 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10958 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10960 static void
10961 output_compilation_unit_header (enum dwarf_unit_type ut)
10963 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10965 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10966 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10967 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10968 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10969 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10970 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10973 output_dwarf_version ();
10974 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
10976 const char *name;
10977 switch (ut)
10979 case DW_UT_compile: name = "DW_UT_compile"; break;
10980 case DW_UT_type: name = "DW_UT_type"; break;
10981 case DW_UT_split_compile: name = "DW_UT_split_compile"; break;
10982 case DW_UT_split_type: name = "DW_UT_split_type"; break;
10983 default: gcc_unreachable ();
10985 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ut, "%s", name);
10986 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10988 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10989 debug_abbrev_section,
10990 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10991 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10992 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10995 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10997 static void
10998 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty,
10999 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
11001 const char *secname, *oldsym;
11002 char *tmp;
11004 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
11005 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
11006 return;
11008 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
11009 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
11010 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
11011 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
11012 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11013 mark_dies (die);
11015 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
11017 /* For now, optimize only the main CU, in order to optimize the rest
11018 we'd need to see all of them earlier. Leave the rest for post-linking
11019 tools like DWZ. */
11020 if (die == comp_unit_die ())
11021 abbrev_opt_start = vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table);
11023 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
11025 optimize_abbrev_table ();
11027 delete extern_map;
11029 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11030 next_die_offset = (dwo_id
11031 ? DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
11032 : DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE);
11033 calc_die_sizes (die);
11035 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11036 if (oldsym && die->comdat_type_p)
11038 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
11040 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
11041 secname = tmp;
11042 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
11043 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11045 else
11047 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
11048 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
11049 info_section_emitted = true;
11052 /* For LTO cross unit DIE refs we want a symbol on the start of the
11053 debuginfo section, not on the CU DIE. */
11054 if ((flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload) && oldsym)
11056 /* ??? No way to get visibility assembled without a decl. */
11057 tree decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, VAR_DECL,
11058 get_identifier (oldsym), char_type_node);
11059 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = true;
11060 TREE_STATIC (decl) = true;
11061 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = true;
11062 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
11063 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = true;
11064 targetm.asm_out.assemble_visibility (decl, VISIBILITY_HIDDEN);
11065 #ifdef ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
11066 /* We prefer a .weak because that handles duplicates from duplicate
11067 archive members in a graceful way. */
11068 ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11069 #else
11070 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11071 #endif
11072 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, oldsym);
11075 /* Output debugging information. */
11076 output_compilation_unit_header (dwo_id
11077 ? DW_UT_split_compile : DW_UT_compile);
11078 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11080 if (dwo_id != NULL)
11081 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11082 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
11084 output_die (die);
11086 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
11087 output_pubnames. */
11088 if (oldsym)
11090 unmark_dies (die);
11091 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
11095 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
11096 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
11097 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
11099 static inline bool
11100 want_pubnames (void)
11102 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11103 return false;
11104 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
11105 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
11106 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
11109 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
11111 static void
11112 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
11114 if (want_pubnames ())
11115 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
11118 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
11120 static inline void
11121 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
11122 const char *str)
11124 dw_attr_node attr;
11125 struct indirect_string_node *node;
11127 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
11128 skeleton_debug_str_hash
11129 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
11131 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
11132 find_string_form (node);
11133 if (node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx))
11134 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
11136 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
11137 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
11138 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
11139 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
11140 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
11143 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
11144 debug_types. */
11146 static void
11147 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
11149 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
11150 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
11152 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_dwo_name), dwo_file_name);
11153 if (comp_dir != NULL)
11154 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
11155 add_AT_pubnames (die);
11156 add_AT_lineptr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_addr_base), debug_addr_section_label);
11159 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
11161 static void
11162 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit,
11163 const unsigned char *dwo_id)
11165 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
11166 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
11167 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
11169 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
11170 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
11172 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
11173 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
11174 header. */
11175 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11176 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11177 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit "
11178 "DWARF extension");
11180 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11181 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_SKELETON_HEADER_SIZE
11182 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
11183 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
11184 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
11185 output_dwarf_version ();
11186 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11188 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_UT_skeleton, "DW_UT_skeleton");
11189 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11191 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
11192 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section,
11193 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11194 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11195 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11196 else
11197 for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11198 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dwo_id[i], i == 0 ? "DWO id" : NULL);
11200 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
11201 output_die (comp_unit);
11203 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
11204 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
11205 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
11207 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
11209 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
11212 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
11214 static void
11215 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
11217 const char *secname;
11218 char *tmp;
11219 int i;
11220 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11221 tree comdat_key;
11222 #endif
11224 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11225 mark_dies (node->root_die);
11227 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
11229 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
11231 delete extern_map;
11232 extern_map = NULL;
11234 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11235 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11236 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
11238 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11239 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
11241 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
11242 secname = ".debug_info";
11243 else
11244 secname = ".debug_info.dwo";
11246 else if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
11247 secname = ".debug_types";
11248 else
11249 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
11251 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11252 sprintf (tmp, dwarf_version >= 5 ? "wi." : "wt.");
11253 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11254 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11255 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
11256 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
11257 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
11258 comdat_key);
11259 #else
11260 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11261 sprintf (tmp, (dwarf_version >= 5
11262 ? ".gnu.linkonce.wi." : ".gnu.linkonce.wt."));
11263 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11264 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11265 secname = tmp;
11266 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11267 #endif
11269 /* Output debugging information. */
11270 output_compilation_unit_header (dwarf_split_debug_info
11271 ? DW_UT_split_type : DW_UT_type);
11272 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
11273 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
11274 "Offset to Type DIE");
11275 output_die (node->root_die);
11277 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
11280 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
11282 static const char *
11283 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
11285 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
11286 return NULL;
11287 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
11290 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
11292 static void
11293 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
11295 pubname_entry e;
11297 e.die = die;
11298 e.name = xstrdup (str);
11299 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
11302 static void
11303 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11305 if (!want_pubnames ())
11306 return;
11308 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
11309 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
11310 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
11311 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
11312 faster than searching the index. */
11313 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
11314 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
11316 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11318 if (name)
11319 add_pubname_string (name, die);
11323 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
11325 static void
11326 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
11328 pubname_entry e;
11330 gcc_assert (scope_name);
11331 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
11332 e.die = die;
11333 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
11336 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
11338 static void
11339 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11341 pubname_entry e;
11343 if (!want_pubnames ())
11344 return;
11346 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11347 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
11348 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
11350 tree scope = NULL;
11351 const char *scope_name = "";
11352 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
11353 const char *name;
11355 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
11356 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11358 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
11359 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
11360 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
11361 else
11362 scope_name = "";
11365 if (TYPE_P (decl))
11366 name = type_tag (decl);
11367 else
11368 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
11370 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
11371 it to the table. */
11372 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
11374 e.die = die;
11375 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
11376 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
11379 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
11380 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
11381 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
11382 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
11383 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
11384 enums don't have names. */
11385 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
11387 dw_die_ref c;
11389 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
11394 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
11396 static void
11397 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
11399 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
11400 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
11402 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
11404 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
11406 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
11407 byte. */
11408 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
11409 switch (die->die_tag)
11411 case DW_TAG_typedef:
11412 case DW_TAG_base_type:
11413 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
11414 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11415 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11416 break;
11417 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
11418 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11419 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11420 if (!is_cxx ())
11421 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11422 break;
11423 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
11424 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11425 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
11426 if (!is_ada ())
11427 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11428 break;
11429 case DW_TAG_constant:
11430 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11431 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11432 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11433 break;
11434 case DW_TAG_variable:
11435 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
11436 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
11437 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
11438 break;
11439 case DW_TAG_namespace:
11440 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
11441 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11442 break;
11443 case DW_TAG_class_type:
11444 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
11445 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
11446 case DW_TAG_union_type:
11447 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
11448 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
11449 if (!is_cxx ())
11450 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
11451 break;
11452 default:
11453 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
11454 break;
11456 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
11457 "GDB-index flags");
11460 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
11464 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
11465 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
11467 static void
11468 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
11470 unsigned i;
11471 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
11472 pubname_entry *pub;
11474 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11476 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11477 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11478 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11479 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11480 "Pub Info Length");
11483 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
11484 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF pubnames/pubtypes version");
11486 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11487 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
11488 debug_skeleton_info_section,
11489 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11490 else
11491 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11492 debug_info_section,
11493 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11494 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
11495 "Compilation Unit Length");
11497 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
11499 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
11501 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
11503 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11504 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
11505 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
11507 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
11508 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
11509 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
11510 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
11511 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
11513 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
11515 if (type_node != NULL)
11516 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
11517 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
11518 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
11521 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
11525 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11528 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
11530 static void
11531 output_pubtables (void)
11533 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
11534 return;
11536 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
11537 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
11538 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
11539 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
11540 simply won't look for the section. */
11541 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
11542 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
11546 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
11547 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
11548 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
11550 static void
11551 output_aranges (void)
11553 unsigned i;
11554 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
11556 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
11558 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11559 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11560 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11561 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
11562 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
11565 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
11566 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF aranges version");
11567 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11568 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
11569 debug_skeleton_info_section,
11570 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11571 else
11572 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11573 debug_info_section,
11574 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11575 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
11576 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
11578 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
11579 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
11581 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
11582 pointer size. */
11583 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
11584 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11585 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
11586 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
11589 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
11590 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
11591 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
11592 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
11593 confused with the terminator. */
11594 if (text_section_used)
11596 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
11597 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
11598 text_section_label, "Length");
11600 if (cold_text_section_used)
11602 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
11603 "Address");
11604 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
11605 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
11608 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
11610 unsigned fde_idx;
11611 dw_fde_ref fde;
11613 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
11615 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
11616 continue;
11617 if (!fde->in_std_section)
11619 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
11620 "Address");
11621 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
11622 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
11624 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11626 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
11627 "Address");
11628 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
11629 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
11634 /* Output the terminator words. */
11635 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11636 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11639 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return its index into
11640 ranges_table vector. */
11642 static unsigned int
11643 add_ranges_num (int num, bool maybe_new_sec)
11645 dw_ranges r = { NULL, num, 0, maybe_new_sec };
11646 vec_safe_push (ranges_table, r);
11647 return vec_safe_length (ranges_table) - 1;
11650 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11651 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. MAYBE_NEW_SEC is true if
11652 this entry might be in a different section from previous range. */
11654 static unsigned int
11655 add_ranges (const_tree block, bool maybe_new_sec)
11657 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0, maybe_new_sec);
11660 /* Note that (*rnglist_table)[offset] is either a head of a rnglist
11661 chain, or middle entry of a chain that will be directly referred to. */
11663 static void
11664 note_rnglist_head (unsigned int offset)
11666 if (dwarf_version < 5 || (*ranges_table)[offset].label)
11667 return;
11668 (*ranges_table)[offset].label = gen_internal_sym ("LLRL");
11671 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
11672 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
11673 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
11674 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
11676 static void
11677 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
11678 bool *added, bool force_direct)
11680 unsigned int in_use = vec_safe_length (ranges_by_label);
11681 unsigned int offset;
11682 dw_ranges_by_label rbl = { begin, end };
11683 vec_safe_push (ranges_by_label, rbl);
11684 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1, true);
11685 if (!*added)
11687 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
11688 *added = true;
11689 note_rnglist_head (offset);
11693 /* Emit .debug_ranges section. */
11695 static void
11696 output_ranges (void)
11698 unsigned i;
11699 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
11700 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11701 dw_ranges *r;
11703 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11704 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11705 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11707 int block_num = r->num;
11709 if (block_num > 0)
11711 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11712 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11714 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11715 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11717 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11718 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11719 base of the text section. */
11720 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11722 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11723 text_section_label,
11724 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11725 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11726 text_section_label, NULL);
11729 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11730 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11731 about whether the target supports cross-section
11732 arithmetic. */
11733 else
11735 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11736 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11737 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11740 fmt = NULL;
11743 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11744 else if (block_num < 0)
11746 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11748 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11750 gcc_unreachable ();
11751 #if 0
11752 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11753 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11754 the #if 0 above. */
11755 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11756 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11757 text_section_label,
11758 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11759 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11760 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11761 text_section_label, NULL);
11762 #endif
11764 else
11766 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11767 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin,
11768 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11769 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11770 (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end,
11771 NULL);
11774 else
11776 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11777 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11778 fmt = start_fmt;
11783 /* Non-zero if .debug_line_str should be used for .debug_line section
11784 strings or strings that are likely shareable with those. */
11785 #define DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR \
11786 (!DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET \
11787 && (DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) != 0 \
11788 /* FIXME: there is no .debug_line_str.dwo section, \
11789 for -gsplit-dwarf we should use DW_FORM_strx instead. */ \
11790 && !dwarf_split_debug_info)
11792 /* Assign .debug_rnglists indexes. */
11794 static void
11795 index_rnglists (void)
11797 unsigned i;
11798 dw_ranges *r;
11800 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11801 if (r->label)
11802 r->idx = rnglist_idx++;
11805 /* Emit .debug_rnglists section. */
11807 static void
11808 output_rnglists (unsigned generation)
11810 unsigned i;
11811 dw_ranges *r;
11812 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11813 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11814 char basebuf[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11816 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
11817 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
11818 /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
11819 See also init_sections_and_labels. */
11820 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11821 2 + generation * 4);
11822 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
11823 3 + generation * 4);
11824 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11825 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11826 "Initial length escape value indicating "
11827 "64-bit DWARF extension");
11828 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11829 "Length of Range Lists");
11830 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11831 output_dwarf_version ();
11832 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
11833 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
11834 /* Emit the offset table only for -gsplit-dwarf. If we don't care
11835 about relocation sizes and primarily care about the size of .debug*
11836 sections in linked shared libraries and executables, then
11837 the offset table plus corresponding DW_FORM_rnglistx uleb128 indexes
11838 into it are usually larger than just DW_FORM_sec_offset offsets
11839 into the .debug_rnglists section. */
11840 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? rnglist_idx : 0,
11841 "Offset Entry Count");
11842 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
11844 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_base_label);
11845 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11846 if (r->label)
11847 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, r->label,
11848 ranges_base_label, NULL);
11851 const char *lab = "";
11852 unsigned int len = vec_safe_length (ranges_table);
11853 const char *base = NULL;
11854 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (ranges_table, i, r)
11856 int block_num = r->num;
11858 if (r->label)
11860 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, r->label);
11861 lab = r->label;
11863 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128 && (r->label || r->maybe_new_sec))
11864 base = NULL;
11865 if (block_num > 0)
11867 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11868 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11870 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11871 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11873 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11875 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11876 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11877 base of the text section. */
11878 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11880 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11881 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11882 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, text_section_label,
11883 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11884 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, text_section_label,
11885 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11886 continue;
11888 if (base == NULL)
11890 dw_ranges *r2 = NULL;
11891 if (i < len - 1)
11892 r2 = &(*ranges_table)[i + 1];
11893 if (r2
11894 && r2->num != 0
11895 && r2->label == NULL
11896 && !r2->maybe_new_sec)
11898 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_base_address,
11899 "DW_RLE_base_address (%s)", lab);
11900 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11901 "Base address (%s)", lab);
11902 strcpy (basebuf, blabel);
11903 base = basebuf;
11906 if (base)
11908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_offset_pair,
11909 "DW_RLE_offset_pair (%s)", lab);
11910 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (blabel, base,
11911 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11912 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, base,
11913 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11914 continue;
11916 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11917 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11918 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11919 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11920 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11921 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11923 else
11925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11926 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11927 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11928 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11929 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11930 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11934 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11935 else if (block_num < 0)
11937 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11938 const char *blabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].begin;
11939 const char *elabel = (*ranges_by_label)[lab_idx].end;
11941 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11942 gcc_unreachable ();
11943 if (HAVE_AS_LEB128)
11945 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_length,
11946 "DW_RLE_start_length (%s)", lab);
11947 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11948 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11949 dw2_asm_output_delta_uleb128 (elabel, blabel,
11950 "Range length (%s)", lab);
11952 else
11954 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_start_end,
11955 "DW_RLE_start_end (%s)", lab);
11956 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11957 "Range begin address (%s)", lab);
11958 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11959 "Range end address (%s)", lab);
11962 else
11963 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_RLE_end_of_list,
11964 "DW_RLE_end_of_list (%s)", lab);
11966 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11969 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11970 struct file_info
11972 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11973 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11974 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11975 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11976 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11979 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11980 files. */
11981 struct dir_info
11983 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11984 int length; /* Path length. */
11985 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11986 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11987 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11990 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11991 the directories in the path. */
11993 static int
11994 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11996 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11997 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11998 const unsigned char *cp1;
11999 const unsigned char *cp2;
12001 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
12002 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
12003 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
12004 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
12005 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. We want the one with
12006 the directory to sort after the one without, so all no directory files
12007 are at the start (normally only the compilation unit file). */
12008 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
12009 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
12011 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
12012 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
12014 while (1)
12016 ++cp1;
12017 ++cp2;
12018 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above,
12019 but now we want longer directory prefixes before shorter ones. */
12020 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
12021 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
12022 return ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
12023 - (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname));
12025 /* Character of current path component the same? */
12026 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
12027 return *cp1 - *cp2;
12031 struct file_name_acquire_data
12033 struct file_info *files;
12034 int used_files;
12035 int max_files;
12038 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
12041 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
12043 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
12044 struct file_info *fi;
12045 const char *f;
12047 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
12049 if (! d->emitted_number)
12050 return 1;
12052 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
12054 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
12056 /* Skip all leading "./". */
12057 f = d->filename;
12058 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
12059 f += 2;
12061 /* Create a new array entry. */
12062 fi->path = f;
12063 fi->length = strlen (f);
12064 fi->file_idx = d;
12066 /* Search for the file name part. */
12067 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
12068 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
12070 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
12072 if (g != NULL)
12074 if (f == NULL || f < g)
12075 f = g;
12078 #endif
12080 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
12081 return 1;
12084 /* Helper function for output_file_names. Emit a FORM encoded
12085 string STR, with assembly comment start ENTRY_KIND and
12086 index IDX */
12088 static void
12089 output_line_string (enum dwarf_form form, const char *str,
12090 const char *entry_kind, unsigned int idx)
12092 switch (form)
12094 case DW_FORM_string:
12095 dw2_asm_output_nstring (str, -1, "%s: %#x", entry_kind, idx);
12096 break;
12097 case DW_FORM_line_strp:
12098 if (!debug_line_str_hash)
12099 debug_line_str_hash
12100 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
12102 struct indirect_string_node *node;
12103 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_line_str_hash);
12104 set_indirect_string (node);
12105 node->form = form;
12106 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
12107 debug_line_str_section, "%s: %#x: \"%s\"",
12108 entry_kind, 0, node->str);
12109 break;
12110 default:
12111 gcc_unreachable ();
12115 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
12116 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
12117 slowdowns with many input files. */
12119 static void
12120 output_file_names (void)
12122 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
12123 int numfiles;
12124 struct file_info *files;
12125 struct dir_info *dirs;
12126 int *saved;
12127 int *savehere;
12128 int *backmap;
12129 int ndirs;
12130 int idx_offset;
12131 int i;
12133 if (!last_emitted_file)
12135 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12137 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Directory entry format count");
12138 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Directories count");
12139 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "File name entry format count");
12140 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "File names count");
12142 else
12144 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12145 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12147 return;
12150 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
12152 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
12153 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
12154 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
12156 fnad.files = files;
12157 fnad.used_files = 0;
12158 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
12159 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
12160 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
12162 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
12164 /* Find all the different directories used. */
12165 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
12166 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
12167 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
12168 dirs[0].count = 1;
12169 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
12170 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
12171 ndirs = 1;
12173 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
12174 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
12175 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
12176 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
12178 /* Same directory as last entry. */
12179 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
12180 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
12182 else
12184 int j;
12186 /* This is a new directory. */
12187 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
12188 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
12189 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
12190 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
12191 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
12193 /* Search for a prefix. */
12194 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
12195 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
12196 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
12197 && dirs[j].length > 1
12198 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
12199 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
12200 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
12201 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
12203 ++ndirs;
12206 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
12207 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
12208 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
12209 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
12210 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
12211 results in most cases and never is much off. */
12212 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12213 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12215 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
12216 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
12218 int j;
12219 int total;
12221 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
12222 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
12223 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
12224 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
12226 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
12228 savehere[j] = 0;
12229 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
12231 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
12232 dirs[j] path. */
12233 int k;
12235 k = dirs[j].prefix;
12236 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
12237 k = dirs[k].prefix;
12239 if (k == (int) i)
12241 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
12242 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
12243 dirs[i]. */
12244 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
12245 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
12250 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
12251 directory. */
12252 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
12254 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
12255 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
12256 if (savehere[j] > 0)
12258 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
12259 saved[j] = savehere[j];
12261 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
12262 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
12267 /* Emit the directory name table. */
12268 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
12269 enum dwarf_form str_form = DW_FORM_string;
12270 enum dwarf_form idx_form = DW_FORM_udata;
12271 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12273 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
12274 if (comp_dir == NULL)
12275 comp_dir = "";
12276 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Directory entry format count");
12277 if (DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
12278 str_form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
12279 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
12280 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
12281 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
12282 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ndirs + idx_offset, "Directories count");
12283 if (str_form == DW_FORM_string)
12285 dw2_asm_output_nstring (comp_dir, -1, "Directory Entry: %#x", 0);
12286 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12287 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
12288 dirs[i].length
12289 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
12290 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
12292 else
12294 output_line_string (str_form, comp_dir, "Directory Entry", 0);
12295 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12297 const char *str
12298 = ggc_alloc_string (dirs[i].path,
12299 dirs[i].length
12300 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR);
12301 output_line_string (str_form, str, "Directory Entry",
12302 (unsigned) i + idx_offset);
12306 else
12308 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12309 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
12310 dirs[i].length
12311 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
12312 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
12314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12317 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
12318 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
12319 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
12320 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
12321 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12322 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
12324 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12326 const char *filename0 = get_AT_string (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_name);
12327 if (filename0 == NULL)
12328 filename0 = "";
12329 /* DW_LNCT_directory_index can use DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data1 and
12330 DW_FORM_data2. Choose one based on the number of directories
12331 and how much space would they occupy in each encoding.
12332 If we have at most 256 directories, all indexes fit into
12333 a single byte, so DW_FORM_data1 is most compact (if there
12334 are at most 128 directories, DW_FORM_udata would be as
12335 compact as that, but not shorter and slower to decode). */
12336 if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 256)
12337 idx_form = DW_FORM_data1;
12338 /* If there are more than 65536 directories, we have to use
12339 DW_FORM_udata, DW_FORM_data2 can't refer to them.
12340 Otherwise, compute what space would occupy if all the indexes
12341 used DW_FORM_udata - sum - and compare that to how large would
12342 be DW_FORM_data2 encoding, and pick the more efficient one. */
12343 else if (ndirs + idx_offset <= 65536)
12345 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT sum = 1;
12346 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12348 int file_idx = backmap[i];
12349 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
12350 sum += size_of_uleb128 (dir_idx);
12352 if (sum >= HOST_WIDE_INT_UC (2) * (numfiles + 1))
12353 idx_form = DW_FORM_data2;
12355 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12356 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 4, "File name entry format count");
12357 #else
12358 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "File name entry format count");
12359 #endif
12360 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_path, "DW_LNCT_path");
12361 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (str_form, "%s",
12362 get_DW_FORM_name (str_form));
12363 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_directory_index,
12364 "DW_LNCT_directory_index");
12365 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (idx_form, "%s",
12366 get_DW_FORM_name (idx_form));
12367 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12368 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_timestamp, "DW_LNCT_timestamp");
12369 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
12370 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_LNCT_size, "DW_LNCT_size");
12371 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (DW_FORM_udata, "DW_FORM_udata");
12372 #endif
12373 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (numfiles + 1, "File names count");
12375 output_line_string (str_form, filename0, "File Entry", 0);
12377 /* Include directory index. */
12378 if (idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12379 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12380 0, NULL);
12381 else
12382 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12384 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12385 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12386 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12387 #endif
12390 /* Now write all the file names. */
12391 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12393 int file_idx = backmap[i];
12394 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
12396 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12397 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
12399 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
12400 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
12402 int ver;
12403 long long cdt;
12404 long siz;
12405 int maxfilelen = (strlen (files[file_idx].path)
12406 + dirs[dir_idx].length
12407 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1);
12408 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
12410 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
12411 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
12412 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
12414 output_line_string (str_form, filebuf, "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
12416 /* Include directory index. */
12417 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12418 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12419 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12420 else
12421 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12423 /* Modification time. */
12424 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
12425 &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
12426 ? cdt : 0, NULL);
12428 /* File length in bytes. */
12429 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path,
12430 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
12431 ? siz : 0, NULL);
12432 #else
12433 output_line_string (str_form,
12434 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length,
12435 "File Entry", (unsigned) i + 1);
12437 /* Include directory index. */
12438 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && idx_form != DW_FORM_udata)
12439 dw2_asm_output_data (idx_form == DW_FORM_data1 ? 1 : 2,
12440 dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12441 else
12442 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12444 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12445 continue;
12447 /* Modification time. */
12448 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12450 /* File length in bytes. */
12451 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12452 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12455 if (dwarf_version < 5)
12456 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12460 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
12462 static void
12463 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
12465 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12466 unsigned int current_line = 1;
12467 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
12468 dw_line_info_entry *ent, *prev_addr;
12469 size_t i;
12470 unsigned int view;
12472 view = 0;
12474 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
12476 switch (ent->opcode)
12478 case LI_set_address:
12479 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
12480 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
12481 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
12482 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
12483 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
12484 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
12485 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
12487 view = 0;
12489 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
12490 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
12491 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s%s", line_label,
12492 debug_variable_location_views
12493 ? ", reset view to 0" : "");
12494 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12495 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12496 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12498 prev_addr = ent;
12499 break;
12501 case LI_adv_address:
12503 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
12504 char prev_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12505 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (prev_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, prev_addr->val);
12507 view++;
12509 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc, "fixed advance PC, increment view to %i", view);
12510 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_label,
12511 "from %s to %s", prev_label, line_label);
12513 prev_addr = ent;
12514 break;
12517 case LI_set_line:
12518 if (ent->val == current_line)
12520 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
12521 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
12522 "copy line %u", current_line);
12524 else
12526 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
12527 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12529 current_line = ent->val;
12530 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12532 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
12533 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
12534 This takes 1 byte. */
12535 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12536 "line %u", current_line);
12538 else
12540 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
12541 depending on the value being encoded. */
12542 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12543 "advance to line %u", current_line);
12544 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12545 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
12548 break;
12550 case LI_set_file:
12551 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
12552 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12553 break;
12555 case LI_set_column:
12556 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
12557 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12558 break;
12560 case LI_negate_stmt:
12561 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
12562 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
12563 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
12564 break;
12566 case LI_set_prologue_end:
12567 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
12568 "set prologue end");
12569 break;
12571 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
12572 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
12573 "set epilogue begin");
12574 break;
12576 case LI_set_discriminator:
12577 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
12578 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
12579 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
12580 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
12581 break;
12585 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
12586 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
12587 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12588 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12589 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
12591 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
12592 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12593 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12596 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
12597 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
12599 static void
12600 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
12602 static unsigned int generation;
12603 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12604 char p1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES], p2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12605 bool saw_one = false;
12606 int opc;
12608 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, generation);
12609 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, generation);
12610 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, generation);
12611 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, generation++);
12613 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12615 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12616 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12617 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12618 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
12619 "Length of Source Line Info");
12622 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
12624 output_dwarf_version ();
12625 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
12627 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
12628 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
12630 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
12631 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
12633 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
12634 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
12635 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
12636 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
12637 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
12638 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
12639 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
12640 and don't let the target override. */
12641 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
12643 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
12644 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12645 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12646 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12647 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12648 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12649 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12650 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12651 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12652 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12653 "Special Opcode Base");
12655 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12657 int n_op_args;
12658 switch (opc)
12660 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12661 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12662 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12663 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12664 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12665 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12666 n_op_args = 1;
12667 break;
12668 default:
12669 n_op_args = 0;
12670 break;
12673 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12674 opc, n_op_args);
12677 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12678 output_file_names ();
12679 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12680 if (prologue_only)
12682 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12683 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12684 return;
12687 if (separate_line_info)
12689 dw_line_info_table *table;
12690 size_t i;
12692 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
12693 if (table->in_use)
12695 output_one_line_info_table (table);
12696 saw_one = true;
12699 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12701 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12702 saw_one = true;
12705 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12706 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12707 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12708 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12709 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
12710 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12711 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12713 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12714 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12717 /* Return true if DW_AT_endianity should be emitted according to REVERSE. */
12719 static inline bool
12720 need_endianity_attribute_p (bool reverse)
12722 return reverse && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict);
12725 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12726 a DIE that describes the given type. REVERSE is true if the type is
12727 to be interpreted in the reverse storage order wrt the target order.
12729 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12730 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12732 static dw_die_ref
12733 base_type_die (tree type, bool reverse)
12735 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12736 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12737 bool fpt_used = false;
12738 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
12739 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
12741 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12742 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12743 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12744 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12746 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12748 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12749 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12750 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12751 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12752 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12753 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12755 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12756 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12757 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12759 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12760 break;
12763 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12764 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
12766 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
12767 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
12769 fpt_used = true;
12770 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12771 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
12772 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
12773 break;
12776 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12778 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12779 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12780 else
12781 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12783 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12784 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12785 else
12786 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12788 if (!dwarf_strict
12789 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
12790 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
12791 break;
12793 case REAL_TYPE:
12794 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12796 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12797 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12798 else
12799 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12801 else
12802 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12803 break;
12805 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12806 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12807 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12808 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12809 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12810 else
12811 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12812 break;
12814 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12815 a user defined type for it. */
12816 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12817 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12818 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12819 else
12820 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12821 break;
12823 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12824 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12825 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12826 break;
12828 default:
12829 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12830 gcc_unreachable ();
12833 base_type_result = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_base_type);
12835 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12836 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12837 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12839 if (need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse))
12840 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_endianity,
12841 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? DW_END_little : DW_END_big);
12843 add_alignment_attribute (base_type_result, type);
12845 if (fpt_used)
12847 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
12849 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
12850 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
12851 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
12852 break;
12854 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
12855 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
12856 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
12857 break;
12859 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
12860 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
12861 yet. */
12862 if (!dwarf_strict)
12864 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
12865 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
12866 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
12868 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
12869 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
12870 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
12871 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
12873 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
12875 break;
12877 default:
12878 gcc_unreachable ();
12882 if (type_bias)
12883 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
12884 dw_scalar_form_constant
12885 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
12886 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
12887 NULL);
12889 return base_type_result;
12892 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
12893 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
12895 static inline bool
12896 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
12898 if (is_cxx ())
12900 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
12901 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
12902 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
12903 return true;
12905 return false;
12908 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12909 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12911 static inline int
12912 is_base_type (tree type)
12914 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12916 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12917 case REAL_TYPE:
12918 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12919 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12920 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12921 return 1;
12923 case VOID_TYPE:
12924 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12925 case RECORD_TYPE:
12926 case UNION_TYPE:
12927 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12928 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12929 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12930 case METHOD_TYPE:
12931 case POINTER_TYPE:
12932 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12933 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12934 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12935 case LANG_TYPE:
12936 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12937 return 0;
12939 default:
12940 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
12941 return 0;
12942 gcc_unreachable ();
12945 return 0;
12948 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12949 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12950 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12951 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12952 ERROR_MARK node. */
12954 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12955 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12957 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12958 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12959 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12960 return 0;
12961 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
12962 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12963 else
12964 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12967 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
12969 static inline offset_int
12970 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12972 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12973 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12974 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12975 return 0;
12976 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12977 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12978 else
12979 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12982 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12983 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12985 static dw_die_ref
12986 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
12987 dw_die_ref context_die)
12989 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12990 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12992 if (context_die == NULL)
12993 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12995 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12997 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12999 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
13000 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
13001 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
13004 add_alignment_attribute (subrange_die, type);
13006 if (low)
13007 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
13008 if (high)
13009 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
13010 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
13011 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
13012 dw_scalar_form_constant
13013 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
13014 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
13015 NULL);
13017 return subrange_die;
13020 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
13021 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
13022 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
13024 static int
13025 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
13027 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
13028 /* The C++ front-end correctly marks reference-typed
13029 variables as readonly, but from a language (and debug
13030 info) standpoint they are not const-qualified. */
13031 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != REFERENCE_TYPE
13032 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
13033 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
13034 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
13037 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
13038 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
13039 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
13041 static int
13042 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
13044 tree t;
13045 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
13047 type_quals &= qual_mask;
13048 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
13050 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
13051 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
13053 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
13055 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
13056 && check_base_type (t, type))
13058 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
13060 if (rank > best_rank)
13062 best_rank = rank;
13063 best_qual = q;
13068 return best_qual;
13071 struct dwarf_qual_info_t { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
13072 static const dwarf_qual_info_t dwarf_qual_info[] =
13074 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
13075 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
13076 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
13077 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type }
13079 static const unsigned int dwarf_qual_info_size
13080 = sizeof (dwarf_qual_info) / sizeof (dwarf_qual_info[0]);
13082 /* If DIE is a qualified DIE of some base DIE with the same parent,
13083 return the base DIE, otherwise return NULL. Set MASK to the
13084 qualifiers added compared to the returned DIE. */
13086 static dw_die_ref
13087 qualified_die_p (dw_die_ref die, int *mask, unsigned int depth)
13089 unsigned int i;
13090 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13091 if (die->die_tag == dwarf_qual_info[i].t)
13092 break;
13093 if (i == dwarf_qual_info_size)
13094 return NULL;
13095 if (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) != 1)
13096 return NULL;
13097 dw_die_ref type = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_type);
13098 if (type == NULL || type->die_parent != die->die_parent)
13099 return NULL;
13100 *mask |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
13101 if (depth)
13103 dw_die_ref ret = qualified_die_p (type, mask, depth - 1);
13104 if (ret)
13105 return ret;
13107 return type;
13110 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
13111 entry that chains the modifiers specified by CV_QUALS in front of the
13112 given type. REVERSE is true if the type is to be interpreted in the
13113 reverse storage order wrt the target order. */
13115 static dw_die_ref
13116 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, bool reverse,
13117 dw_die_ref context_die)
13119 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
13120 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
13121 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
13122 tree item_type = NULL;
13123 tree qualified_type;
13124 tree name, low, high;
13125 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
13126 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
13127 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
13128 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC |
13129 ENCODE_QUAL_ADDR_SPACE(~0U));
13130 const bool reverse_base_type
13131 = need_endianity_attribute_p (reverse) && is_base_type (type);
13133 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
13134 return NULL;
13136 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
13138 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
13140 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
13141 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, reverse, context_die);
13144 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
13146 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
13147 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
13148 to handle it. */
13149 if (dwarf_version < 3)
13150 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
13152 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
13153 if (dwarf_version < 5)
13154 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
13156 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
13157 this type. */
13158 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
13160 if (qualified_type == sizetype)
13162 /* Try not to expose the internal sizetype type's name. */
13163 if (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
13164 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
13166 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
13168 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
13169 && (TYPE_PRECISION (t)
13170 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type))
13171 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
13172 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type)));
13173 qualified_type = t;
13175 else if (qualified_type == sizetype
13176 && TREE_CODE (sizetype) == TREE_CODE (size_type_node)
13177 && TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) == TYPE_PRECISION (size_type_node)
13178 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype) == TYPE_UNSIGNED (size_type_node))
13179 qualified_type = size_type_node;
13182 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
13183 if (qualified_type)
13185 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
13187 /* DW_AT_endianity doesn't come from a qualifier on the type, so it is
13188 dealt with specially: the DIE with the attribute, if it exists, is
13189 placed immediately after the regular DIE for the same base type. */
13190 if (mod_type_die
13191 && (!reverse_base_type
13192 || ((mod_type_die = mod_type_die->die_sib) != NULL
13193 && get_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_endianity))))
13194 return mod_type_die;
13197 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
13199 /* Handle C typedef types. */
13200 if (name
13201 && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
13202 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
13203 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
13205 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
13207 /* Skip the typedef for base types with DW_AT_endianity, no big deal. */
13208 if (qualified_type == dtype && !reverse_base_type)
13210 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
13212 /* Typedef variants that have an abstract origin don't get their own
13213 type DIE (see gen_typedef_die), so fall back on the ultimate
13214 abstract origin instead. */
13215 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
13216 return modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (origin), cv_quals, reverse,
13217 context_die);
13219 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
13220 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
13221 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
13223 else
13225 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
13226 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
13227 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
13228 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
13229 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
13230 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
13231 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name), cv_quals,
13232 reverse, context_die);
13233 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
13237 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
13239 if (cv_quals)
13241 int sub_quals = 0, first_quals = 0;
13242 unsigned i;
13243 dw_die_ref first = NULL, last = NULL;
13245 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
13246 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
13247 qualifiers. */
13248 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
13249 cv_qual_mask);
13250 if (sub_quals && use_debug_types)
13252 bool needed = false;
13253 /* If emitting type units, make sure the order of qualifiers
13254 is canonical. Thus, start from unqualified type if
13255 an earlier qualifier is missing in sub_quals, but some later
13256 one is present there. */
13257 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13258 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
13259 needed = true;
13260 else if (needed && (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals))
13262 sub_quals = 0;
13263 break;
13266 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, reverse, context_die);
13267 if (mod_scope && mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_parent == mod_scope)
13269 /* As not all intermediate qualified DIEs have corresponding
13270 tree types, ensure that qualified DIEs in the same scope
13271 as their DW_AT_type are emitted after their DW_AT_type,
13272 only with other qualified DIEs for the same type possibly
13273 in between them. Determine the range of such qualified
13274 DIEs now (first being the base type, last being corresponding
13275 last qualified DIE for it). */
13276 unsigned int count = 0;
13277 first = qualified_die_p (mod_type_die, &first_quals,
13278 dwarf_qual_info_size);
13279 if (first == NULL)
13280 first = mod_type_die;
13281 gcc_assert ((first_quals & ~sub_quals) == 0);
13282 for (count = 0, last = first;
13283 count < (1U << dwarf_qual_info_size);
13284 count++, last = last->die_sib)
13286 int quals = 0;
13287 if (last == mod_scope->die_child)
13288 break;
13289 if (qualified_die_p (last->die_sib, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size)
13290 != first)
13291 break;
13295 for (i = 0; i < dwarf_qual_info_size; i++)
13296 if (dwarf_qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
13298 dw_die_ref d;
13299 if (first && first != last)
13301 for (d = first->die_sib; ; d = d->die_sib)
13303 int quals = 0;
13304 qualified_die_p (d, &quals, dwarf_qual_info_size);
13305 if (quals == (first_quals | dwarf_qual_info[i].q))
13306 break;
13307 if (d == last)
13309 d = NULL;
13310 break;
13313 if (d)
13315 mod_type_die = d;
13316 continue;
13319 if (first)
13321 d = new_die_raw (dwarf_qual_info[i].t);
13322 add_child_die_after (mod_scope, d, last);
13323 last = d;
13325 else
13326 d = new_die (dwarf_qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
13327 if (mod_type_die)
13328 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
13329 mod_type_die = d;
13330 first_quals |= dwarf_qual_info[i].q;
13333 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
13335 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
13336 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
13338 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
13339 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
13340 else
13341 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
13343 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
13345 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
13346 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
13347 add_alignment_attribute (mod_type_die, type);
13348 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13350 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
13351 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
13353 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
13354 if (action >= 0)
13356 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
13357 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
13359 else
13361 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
13362 dw_loc_descr_ref d
13363 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13364 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
13368 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
13369 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
13370 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
13372 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
13373 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
13374 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
13375 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
13376 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13378 else if (is_base_type (type))
13380 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type, reverse);
13382 /* The DIE with DW_AT_endianity is placed right after the naked DIE. */
13383 if (reverse_base_type)
13385 dw_die_ref after_die
13386 = modified_type_die (type, cv_quals, false, context_die);
13387 add_child_die_after (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die, after_die);
13389 else
13390 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), mod_type_die);
13392 add_pubtype (type, mod_type_die);
13394 else
13396 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13398 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
13399 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
13400 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
13401 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
13402 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
13403 ..._TYPE node. */
13404 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
13405 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
13407 /* For function/method types, can't just use type_main_variant here,
13408 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
13409 but try to canonicalize. */
13410 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
13411 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
13412 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
13413 && check_base_type (t, main)
13414 && check_lang_type (t, type))
13415 return lookup_type_die (t);
13416 return lookup_type_die (type);
13418 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
13419 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
13420 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
13421 else
13422 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
13423 not the main variant. */
13424 return lookup_type_die (type);
13427 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
13428 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
13429 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
13430 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
13431 if the base type already has the same name. */
13432 if (name
13433 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
13434 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
13435 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
13436 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
13437 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
13438 && DECL_NAME (name))))
13440 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
13441 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
13442 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
13443 useful source coordinates anyway. */
13444 name = DECL_NAME (name);
13445 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
13447 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
13448 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
13450 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
13451 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
13452 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
13455 if (qualified_type && !reverse_base_type)
13456 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
13458 if (item_type)
13459 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
13460 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
13461 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
13462 types are possible in Ada. */
13463 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
13464 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
13465 reverse,
13466 context_die);
13468 if (sub_die != NULL)
13469 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
13471 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
13472 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
13473 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
13475 return mod_type_die;
13478 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
13479 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
13480 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
13482 static void
13483 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
13485 tree parms, args;
13486 int parms_num, i;
13487 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
13488 int non_default;
13490 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
13491 return;
13493 if (TYPE_P (t))
13494 die = lookup_type_die (t);
13495 else if (DECL_P (t))
13496 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
13498 gcc_assert (die);
13500 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
13501 if (!parms)
13502 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
13503 or function. End of story. */
13504 return;
13506 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
13507 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
13508 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
13509 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
13510 else
13511 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
13512 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
13514 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
13515 dw_die_ref parm_die;
13517 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
13518 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
13519 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
13520 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
13522 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
13524 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
13525 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
13526 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
13527 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
13528 an argument pack. */
13529 if (arg_pack_elems)
13530 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
13531 arg_pack_elems,
13532 die);
13533 else
13534 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
13535 true /* emit name */, die);
13536 if (i >= non_default)
13537 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
13542 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
13543 the representation of a generic type parameter.
13544 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
13545 ARG is the argument to PARM.
13546 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
13547 name of the PARM.
13548 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
13549 as a child node. */
13551 static dw_die_ref
13552 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
13553 bool emit_name_p,
13554 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13556 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
13557 const char *name = NULL;
13559 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
13560 return NULL;
13562 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
13563 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
13564 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
13565 and arguments. */
13566 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13567 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
13568 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
13569 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
13570 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
13571 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
13572 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13573 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
13574 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
13575 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
13576 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
13577 name of the template template argument. */
13578 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
13579 parent_die, parm);
13580 else
13581 gcc_unreachable ();
13583 if (tmpl_die)
13585 tree tmpl_type;
13587 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
13588 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
13589 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
13590 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
13591 the die. */
13592 if (emit_name_p)
13594 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
13595 gcc_assert (name);
13596 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
13599 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13601 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
13602 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
13603 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
13604 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
13605 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
13606 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
13607 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
13608 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
13609 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
13610 false, parent_die);
13612 else
13614 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
13615 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
13616 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
13618 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
13619 to the name of the argument. */
13620 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
13621 if (name)
13622 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
13625 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13626 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
13627 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
13628 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
13629 of ARG.
13630 We must be careful here:
13631 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
13632 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
13633 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
13634 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
13635 emitted after cgraph computations.
13636 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
13637 after cgraph is ready. */
13638 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
13641 return tmpl_die;
13644 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13645 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13646 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
13648 static dw_die_ref
13649 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13650 tree parm_pack_args,
13651 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13653 dw_die_ref die;
13654 int j;
13656 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13658 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13659 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13660 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13661 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13662 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13663 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13664 die);
13665 return die;
13668 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13669 an enumerated type. */
13671 static inline int
13672 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13674 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13677 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13679 static unsigned int
13680 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13682 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13684 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13686 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13687 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13689 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13690 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13691 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13693 #endif
13695 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13696 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
13697 return regno;
13700 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13701 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13702 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13704 static void
13705 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13707 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13709 if (*list_head != NULL)
13711 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13712 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13715 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13716 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13720 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13721 zero if there is none. */
13723 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13724 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13726 rtx regs;
13728 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13729 return 0;
13731 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13732 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13733 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13734 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13735 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13736 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13737 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13739 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13741 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13743 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13744 initialized);
13745 if (result)
13746 add_loc_descr (&result,
13747 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13749 return result;
13752 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13754 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
13755 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13756 else
13758 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13759 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13760 return 0;
13761 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
13765 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13766 a given hard register number. */
13768 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13769 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13771 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13773 if (regno <= 31)
13774 reg_loc_descr
13775 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13776 else
13777 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13779 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13780 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13782 return reg_loc_descr;
13785 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13786 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13788 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13789 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13790 enum var_init_status initialized)
13792 int size, i;
13793 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13795 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13796 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13798 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
13799 int nregs;
13801 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13802 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
13804 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13805 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13806 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13808 #endif
13810 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13811 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
13813 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
13814 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)).is_constant (&size))
13815 return NULL;
13816 size /= nregs;
13818 loc_result = NULL;
13819 while (nregs--)
13821 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13823 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13824 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13825 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13826 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13827 ++reg;
13829 return loc_result;
13832 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13834 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13836 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
13837 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0))).is_constant (&size))
13838 return NULL;
13839 loc_result = NULL;
13841 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13843 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13845 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13846 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13847 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13848 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13851 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13852 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13853 return loc_result;
13856 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13858 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
13859 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
13860 and DW_OP_shl. */
13862 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13863 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
13865 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
13866 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13867 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13868 return ret;
13871 /* Return a location descriptor that designates constant POLY_I. */
13873 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13874 int_loc_descriptor (poly_int64 poly_i)
13876 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13878 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
13879 if (!poly_i.is_constant (&i))
13881 /* Create location descriptions for the non-constant part and
13882 add any constant offset at the end. */
13883 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL;
13884 HOST_WIDE_INT constant = poly_i.coeffs[0];
13885 for (unsigned int j = 1; j < NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS; ++j)
13887 HOST_WIDE_INT coeff = poly_i.coeffs[j];
13888 if (coeff != 0)
13890 dw_loc_descr_ref start = ret;
13891 unsigned int factor;
13892 int bias;
13893 unsigned int regno = targetm.dwarf_poly_indeterminate_value
13894 (j, &factor, &bias);
13896 /* Add COEFF * ((REGNO / FACTOR) - BIAS) to the value:
13897 add COEFF * (REGNO / FACTOR) now and subtract
13898 COEFF * BIAS from the final constant part. */
13899 constant -= coeff * bias;
13900 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_reg_loc_descr (regno, 0));
13901 if (coeff % factor == 0)
13902 coeff /= factor;
13903 else
13905 int amount = exact_log2 (factor);
13906 gcc_assert (amount >= 0);
13907 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (amount));
13908 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13910 if (coeff != 1)
13912 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (coeff));
13913 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13915 if (start)
13916 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13919 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, constant);
13920 return ret;
13923 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13924 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13925 if (i >= 0)
13927 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
13928 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
13929 if (i <= 31)
13930 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13931 else if (i <= 0xff)
13932 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13933 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13934 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13935 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
13936 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13937 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
13938 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13939 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13940 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
13941 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13942 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13943 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
13944 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
13945 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13947 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
13948 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
13949 <= 4)
13951 /* As i >= 2**31, the double cast above will yield a negative number.
13952 Since wrapping is defined in DWARF expressions we can output big
13953 positive integers as small negative ones, regardless of the size
13954 of host wide ints.
13956 Here, since the evaluator will handle 32-bit values and since i >=
13957 2**31, we know it's going to be interpreted as a negative literal:
13958 store it this way if we can do better than 5 bytes this way. */
13959 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
13961 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13962 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13964 /* Past this point, i >= 0x100000000 and thus DW_OP_constu will take at
13965 least 6 bytes: see if we can do better before falling back to it. */
13966 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
13967 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13968 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes. */
13969 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
13970 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
13971 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
13972 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13973 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
13974 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes. */
13975 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
13976 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
13977 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13978 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
13979 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
13980 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
13981 else
13982 op = DW_OP_constu;
13984 else
13986 if (i >= -0x80)
13987 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13988 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13989 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13990 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
13992 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
13994 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
13995 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13996 return ret;
13998 op = DW_OP_const4s;
14000 else
14002 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
14003 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
14005 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
14006 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14007 return ret;
14009 op = DW_OP_consts;
14013 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
14016 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
14018 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14019 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14021 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
14022 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
14023 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
14025 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
14026 if (i <= max_int)
14027 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
14029 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
14030 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
14031 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
14033 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
14034 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
14035 wrapping, we know that:
14036 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14037 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
14038 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
14039 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
14040 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
14041 DW_OP_const4s. */
14042 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14043 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
14044 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
14046 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
14048 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
14049 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
14050 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
14051 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
14053 /* So we finally have:
14054 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
14055 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
14056 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
14059 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
14060 return new_loc_descr
14061 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
14062 ? DW_OP_const4u
14063 : DW_OP_const8u,
14064 i, 0);
14067 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
14068 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
14069 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
14070 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
14072 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14073 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
14075 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
14076 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
14078 switch (kind)
14080 case LT_EXPR:
14081 op = DW_OP_lt;
14082 break;
14083 case LE_EXPR:
14084 op = DW_OP_le;
14085 break;
14086 case GT_EXPR:
14087 op = DW_OP_gt;
14088 break;
14089 case GE_EXPR:
14090 op = DW_OP_ge;
14091 break;
14092 default:
14093 gcc_unreachable ();
14096 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14097 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14099 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
14100 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
14101 three cases:
14103 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
14104 return: a OP(signed) b;
14106 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
14107 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
14108 are flipped.
14110 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
14111 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
14112 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14113 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14114 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
14115 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
14116 zero. */
14117 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
14118 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
14119 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14121 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
14122 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
14123 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14124 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
14126 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
14127 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
14128 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
14129 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
14130 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14131 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14132 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14134 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
14135 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14136 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14137 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14138 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14140 return ret;
14143 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
14144 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
14146 static dw_loc_list_ref
14147 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
14148 enum tree_code kind)
14150 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
14151 return NULL;
14153 add_loc_list (&left, right);
14154 if (left == NULL)
14155 return NULL;
14157 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
14158 return left;
14161 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
14162 without actually allocating it. */
14164 static unsigned long
14165 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
14167 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
14168 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
14169 + 1;
14172 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
14173 actually allocating it. */
14175 static unsigned long
14176 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14178 unsigned long s;
14180 if (i >= 0)
14182 int clz, ctz;
14183 if (i <= 31)
14184 return 1;
14185 else if (i <= 0xff)
14186 return 2;
14187 else if (i <= 0xffff)
14188 return 3;
14189 clz = clz_hwi (i);
14190 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
14191 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
14192 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14193 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14194 - clz - 5);
14195 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
14196 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14197 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14198 - clz - 8);
14199 else if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > 0x7fffffff
14200 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i)
14201 <= 4)
14202 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (int32_t) i);
14203 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
14204 return 5;
14205 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
14206 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
14207 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14208 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14209 - clz - 8);
14210 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
14211 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14212 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14213 - clz - 16);
14214 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
14215 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14216 && s > 6)
14217 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14218 - clz - 32);
14219 else
14220 return 1 + s;
14222 else
14224 if (i >= -0x80)
14225 return 2;
14226 else if (i >= -0x8000)
14227 return 3;
14228 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
14230 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
14232 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
14233 if (s < 5)
14234 return s;
14236 return 5;
14238 else
14240 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
14241 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
14243 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
14244 if (s < r)
14245 return s;
14247 return r;
14252 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
14253 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
14255 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14256 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
14258 int litsize;
14259 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14261 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14262 return NULL;
14264 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
14265 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
14266 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
14267 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
14268 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
14269 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
14270 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
14272 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
14273 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14274 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14275 return loc_result;
14278 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14279 size, 0);
14280 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
14281 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
14282 return loc_result;
14285 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
14287 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14288 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, poly_int64 offset,
14289 enum var_init_status initialized)
14291 unsigned int regno;
14292 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
14293 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
14295 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
14296 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
14297 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
14298 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
14299 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
14301 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
14302 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
14303 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
14305 if (elim != reg)
14307 elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
14308 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
14309 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14310 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
14311 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
14312 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
14313 : stack_pointer_rtx));
14315 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
14316 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
14317 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
14318 access stack variables. */
14319 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
14320 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
14322 int base_reg
14323 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
14324 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
14325 : REGNO (elim));
14326 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
14329 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
14330 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
14331 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
14332 if (offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
14333 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
14334 else
14336 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, 0, 0);
14337 loc_descr_plus_const (&ret, offset);
14338 return ret;
14343 regno = REGNO (reg);
14344 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
14345 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
14347 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
14348 if (leaf_reg != -1)
14349 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
14351 #endif
14352 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
14354 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
14355 if (!optimize && fde
14356 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno)
14357 && offset.is_constant (&const_offset))
14359 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
14360 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
14361 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
14362 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
14363 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
14364 else in other part of the routine. */
14365 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, const_offset, 0);
14368 result = new_reg_loc_descr (regno, offset);
14370 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14371 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14373 return result;
14376 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
14378 static inline int
14379 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
14381 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
14382 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14383 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
14384 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
14387 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
14388 failed. */
14390 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14391 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
14393 tree base;
14394 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
14396 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
14397 return NULL;
14399 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
14400 if (base == NULL
14401 || !VAR_P (base)
14402 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
14403 return NULL;
14405 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
14406 if (loc_result == NULL)
14407 return NULL;
14409 if (maybe_ne (MEM_OFFSET (mem), 0))
14410 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
14412 return loc_result;
14415 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
14416 expression. */
14418 static void
14419 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
14421 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
14423 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
14424 if (expr)
14425 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
14426 if (rtl)
14428 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
14429 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
14431 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
14435 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
14437 static bool
14438 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
14440 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
14442 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != UNSPEC)
14444 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14445 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
14446 return false;
14449 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, and
14450 the target hook doesn't explicitly allow it in debug info, assume
14451 we can't express it in the debug info. */
14452 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
14453 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
14454 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
14455 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
14456 if (flag_checking
14457 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
14458 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
14459 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
14460 inform (current_function_decl
14461 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
14462 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
14463 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
14464 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
14465 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
14466 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
14467 XINT (rtl, 1));
14468 #else
14469 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
14470 XINT (rtl, 1));
14471 #endif
14472 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14473 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
14474 return false;
14477 if (CONST_POLY_INT_P (rtl))
14478 return false;
14480 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
14482 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14483 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
14484 return false;
14487 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
14488 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
14489 We should really identify / validate expressions
14490 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
14491 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
14492 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14494 case SYMBOL_REF:
14495 break;
14496 case NOT:
14497 case NEG:
14498 return false;
14499 default:
14500 return true;
14503 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
14505 bool marked;
14506 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
14507 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
14508 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
14509 if (!marked)
14511 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14512 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
14513 return false;
14517 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
14518 return false;
14520 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
14521 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
14522 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
14523 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
14524 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
14525 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
14527 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
14529 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
14531 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14532 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
14533 return false;
14537 return true;
14540 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
14541 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
14542 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
14544 static bool
14545 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
14547 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
14548 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
14550 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
14552 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
14553 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
14554 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
14555 return false;
14556 return true;
14559 return true;
14562 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
14563 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
14565 static dw_die_ref
14566 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
14568 dw_die_ref type_die;
14569 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
14571 if (type == NULL)
14572 return NULL;
14573 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
14575 case INTEGER_TYPE:
14576 case REAL_TYPE:
14577 break;
14578 default:
14579 return NULL;
14581 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
14582 if (!type_die)
14583 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
14584 comp_unit_die ());
14585 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
14586 return NULL;
14587 return type_die;
14590 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
14591 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
14592 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
14593 possible. */
14595 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14596 convert_descriptor_to_mode (scalar_int_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
14598 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
14599 dw_die_ref type_die;
14600 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14602 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14604 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0));
14605 return op;
14607 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
14608 if (type_die == NULL)
14609 return NULL;
14610 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14611 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14612 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14613 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14614 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
14615 return op;
14618 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
14620 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14621 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
14622 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14624 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
14625 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14626 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14627 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
14629 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
14630 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
14632 return ret;
14635 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14636 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14637 and in which OP_MODE is bigger than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
14639 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14640 scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (enum dwarf_location_atom op,
14641 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14642 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14644 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
14645 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14647 if (type_die == NULL)
14648 return NULL;
14649 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14650 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14651 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14652 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14653 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14654 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14655 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14656 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14657 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14658 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14659 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14662 /* Subroutine of scompare_loc_descriptor for the case in which we're
14663 comparing two scalar integer operands OP0 and OP1 that have mode OP_MODE,
14664 and in which OP_MODE is smaller than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. */
14666 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14667 scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14668 scalar_int_mode op_mode,
14669 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
14671 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14672 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
14673 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
14674 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
14676 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14677 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14679 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14681 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
14682 whether they are zero extended or not. */
14683 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14684 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14685 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14686 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14687 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14688 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
14689 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14690 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14691 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14692 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
14693 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14695 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
14696 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
14697 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
14698 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
14700 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
14701 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
14702 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14703 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14704 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
14705 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
14706 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
14707 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14708 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
14710 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
14711 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14712 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14713 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
14714 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14717 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14718 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14719 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14720 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (UINTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
14721 else
14723 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14724 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14726 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14729 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14731 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14732 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14733 machine_mode mem_mode)
14735 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14736 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14738 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14739 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14740 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
14741 return NULL;
14743 scalar_int_mode int_op_mode;
14744 if (dwarf_strict
14745 && dwarf_version < 5
14746 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode)
14747 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14748 return NULL;
14750 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14751 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14752 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14753 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14755 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14756 return NULL;
14758 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (op_mode, &int_op_mode))
14760 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14761 return scompare_loc_descriptor_narrow (op, rtl, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14763 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14764 return scompare_loc_descriptor_wide (op, int_op_mode, op0, op1);
14766 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14769 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
14771 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14772 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
14773 machine_mode mem_mode)
14775 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14777 machine_mode test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14778 if (test_op_mode == VOIDmode)
14779 test_op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
14781 scalar_int_mode op_mode;
14782 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (test_op_mode, &op_mode))
14783 return NULL;
14785 if (dwarf_strict
14786 && dwarf_version < 5
14787 && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14788 return NULL;
14790 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
14791 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14792 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
14793 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14795 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14796 return NULL;
14798 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14800 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
14801 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
14802 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
14804 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
14806 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14807 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
14808 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14809 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14810 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14812 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14813 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14815 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14816 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
14817 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
14818 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
14819 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
14821 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14822 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14825 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14827 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14828 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14829 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14830 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14831 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14832 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14833 else
14834 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14835 bias, 0));
14837 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14840 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
14842 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14843 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14844 machine_mode mem_mode)
14846 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14847 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14848 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14850 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
14851 if (dwarf_strict
14852 && dwarf_version < 5
14853 && (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14854 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14855 return NULL;
14857 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14858 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14859 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14860 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14862 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14863 return NULL;
14865 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14866 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14867 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14868 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14870 /* Checked by the caller. */
14871 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
14872 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14874 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (int_mode);
14875 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14876 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14877 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14878 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14880 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14882 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14883 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14884 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14885 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14888 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14889 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14891 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14892 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14893 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14894 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14895 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14897 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14898 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14900 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 0);
14901 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14902 if (type_die == NULL)
14903 return NULL;
14904 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14905 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14906 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14907 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14908 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14909 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14910 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14911 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14912 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14913 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14916 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14917 op = DW_OP_lt;
14918 else
14919 op = DW_OP_gt;
14920 ret = op0;
14921 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14922 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14923 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14924 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14925 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14926 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14927 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14928 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14929 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14930 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
14931 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
14932 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14933 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, ret);
14934 return ret;
14937 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
14938 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
14939 convert back to unsigned. */
14941 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14942 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
14943 scalar_int_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
14945 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
14947 if (type_die == NULL)
14948 return NULL;
14949 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14950 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14951 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14952 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14953 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14954 return NULL;
14955 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14956 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14957 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14958 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14959 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14960 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
14961 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14962 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14963 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14964 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14965 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
14966 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14967 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
14970 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
14971 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14972 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
14973 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
14974 for the mode):
14975 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14976 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14977 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
14978 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14979 L3: DW_OP_drop
14980 L4: DW_OP_nop
14982 CTZ is similar:
14983 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14984 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14985 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14986 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14987 L3: DW_OP_drop
14988 L4: DW_OP_nop
14990 FFS is similar:
14991 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
14992 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
14993 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14994 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14995 L3: DW_OP_drop
14996 L4: DW_OP_nop */
14998 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14999 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15000 machine_mode mem_mode)
15002 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15003 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
15004 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15005 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15006 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
15007 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
15008 rtx msb;
15010 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
15011 return NULL;
15013 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15014 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15015 if (op0 == NULL)
15016 return NULL;
15017 ret = op0;
15018 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
15020 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
15021 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
15023 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
15024 valv = 0;
15025 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
15026 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
15027 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15028 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15029 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15030 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
15031 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
15032 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15033 if (tmp == NULL)
15034 return NULL;
15035 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15036 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15037 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
15038 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
15039 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
15040 mode, mem_mode,
15041 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15042 if (l1label == NULL)
15043 return NULL;
15044 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15045 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15046 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15047 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15048 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
15049 msb = const1_rtx;
15050 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15051 msb = GEN_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
15052 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
15053 else
15054 msb = immed_wide_int_const
15055 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
15056 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
15057 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
15058 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
15059 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
15060 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
15061 else
15062 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
15063 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15064 if (tmp == NULL)
15065 return NULL;
15066 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15067 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15068 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15069 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
15070 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15071 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15072 if (tmp == NULL)
15073 return NULL;
15074 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15075 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
15076 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15077 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15078 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
15079 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15080 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15081 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15082 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15083 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
15084 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
15085 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
15086 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15087 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15088 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15089 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15090 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15091 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
15092 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15093 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
15094 return ret;
15097 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
15098 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
15099 const0 DW_OP_swap
15100 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
15101 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
15102 L2: DW_OP_drop
15104 PARITY is similar:
15105 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
15106 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
15107 L2: DW_OP_drop */
15109 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15110 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15111 machine_mode mem_mode)
15113 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15114 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15115 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15117 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
15118 return NULL;
15120 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15121 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15122 if (op0 == NULL)
15123 return NULL;
15124 ret = op0;
15125 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15126 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15127 if (tmp == NULL)
15128 return NULL;
15129 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15130 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15131 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15132 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15133 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15134 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15135 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15136 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
15137 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15138 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15139 if (tmp == NULL)
15140 return NULL;
15141 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15142 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15143 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
15144 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
15145 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15146 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15147 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15148 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15149 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15150 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15151 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15152 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15153 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15154 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15155 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15156 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15157 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15158 return ret;
15161 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
15162 constS const0
15163 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
15164 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
15165 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
15166 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
15167 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
15169 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15170 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15171 machine_mode mem_mode)
15173 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
15174 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
15175 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
15177 if (BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
15178 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
15179 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
15180 return NULL;
15182 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15183 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15184 if (op0 == NULL)
15185 return NULL;
15187 ret = op0;
15188 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
15189 mode, mem_mode,
15190 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15191 if (tmp == NULL)
15192 return NULL;
15193 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15194 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15195 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15196 if (tmp == NULL)
15197 return NULL;
15198 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15199 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
15200 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
15201 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
15202 mode, mem_mode,
15203 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15204 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15205 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
15206 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15207 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15208 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
15209 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15210 if (tmp == NULL)
15211 return NULL;
15212 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15213 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15214 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
15215 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15216 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
15217 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15218 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
15219 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
15220 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15221 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15222 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
15223 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15224 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
15225 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
15226 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15227 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
15228 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15229 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15230 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
15231 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
15232 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15233 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
15234 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15235 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
15236 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15237 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
15238 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15239 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
15240 return ret;
15243 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
15244 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
15245 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
15246 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
15248 ROTATERT is similar:
15249 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
15250 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
15251 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
15253 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15254 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, scalar_int_mode mode,
15255 machine_mode mem_mode)
15257 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15258 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
15259 int i;
15261 if (is_narrower_int_mode (GET_MODE (rtlop1), mode))
15262 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
15263 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15264 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15265 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
15266 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15267 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
15268 return NULL;
15269 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15270 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
15272 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15273 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
15274 mode, mem_mode,
15275 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15276 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15277 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
15278 ? DW_OP_const4u
15279 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
15280 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
15281 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
15282 else
15283 mask[i] = NULL;
15284 if (mask[i] == NULL)
15285 return NULL;
15286 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15288 ret = op0;
15289 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
15290 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15291 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15292 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
15294 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
15295 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15296 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
15298 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15299 if (mask[0] != NULL)
15300 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
15301 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
15302 if (mask[1] != NULL)
15304 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15305 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
15306 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15308 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
15310 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
15311 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15312 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
15314 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
15315 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
15316 return ret;
15319 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
15320 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
15322 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15323 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
15325 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15326 dw_die_ref ref;
15328 if (dwarf_strict)
15329 return NULL;
15330 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
15331 /* With LTO during LTRANS we get the late DIE that refers to the early
15332 DIE, thus we add another indirection here. This seems to confuse
15333 gdb enough to make gcc.dg/guality/pr68860-1.c FAIL with LTO. */
15334 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
15335 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
15336 if (ref)
15338 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15339 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15340 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15342 else
15344 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15345 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
15347 return ret;
15350 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
15351 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
15352 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
15353 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
15355 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
15356 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
15357 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
15358 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
15360 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
15362 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
15363 autoincrement addressing modes.
15365 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
15367 dw_loc_descr_ref
15368 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
15369 machine_mode mem_mode,
15370 enum var_init_status initialized)
15372 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
15373 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15374 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
15375 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
15376 poly_int64 offset;
15378 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15379 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15381 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
15382 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
15383 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
15384 zeroth element of the array. */
15386 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15388 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
15389 return NULL;
15391 scalar_int_mode int_mode, inner_mode, op1_mode;
15392 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15394 case POST_INC:
15395 case POST_DEC:
15396 case POST_MODIFY:
15397 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
15399 case SUBREG:
15400 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15401 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15402 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
15403 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15404 contains the given subreg. */
15405 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15406 break;
15407 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
15408 /* FALLTHRU */
15409 case TRUNCATE:
15410 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
15411 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15412 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15413 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
15414 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15415 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15416 || (int_mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
15417 #endif
15419 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15421 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
15422 inner_mode,
15423 mem_mode, initialized);
15424 break;
15426 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15427 break;
15428 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15429 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (inner), &inner_mode)
15430 ? GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
15431 : known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))))
15433 dw_die_ref type_die;
15434 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15436 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
15437 GET_MODE (inner),
15438 mem_mode, initialized);
15439 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
15440 break;
15441 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15442 if (type_die == NULL)
15444 mem_loc_result = NULL;
15445 break;
15447 if (maybe_ne (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))))
15448 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15449 else
15450 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_reinterpret), 0, 0);
15451 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15452 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15453 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15454 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15455 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15456 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15458 /* Convert it to untyped afterwards. */
15459 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15460 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15463 break;
15465 case REG:
15466 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15467 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15468 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
15469 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
15470 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15471 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
15472 #endif
15475 dw_die_ref type_die;
15476 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
15478 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15479 break;
15480 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15481 break;
15482 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15483 if (type_die == NULL)
15484 break;
15486 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
15487 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
15488 break;
15489 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_regval_type),
15490 dbx_regnum, 0);
15491 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15492 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15493 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15494 break;
15496 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
15497 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
15498 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
15499 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
15500 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
15501 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
15502 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
15503 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
15504 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
15505 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
15506 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
15507 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
15508 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
15509 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15510 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15511 else if (stack_realign_drap
15512 && crtl->drap_reg
15513 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
15514 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
15516 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
15517 out, use DRAP instead. */
15518 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
15519 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15521 break;
15523 case SIGN_EXTEND:
15524 case ZERO_EXTEND:
15525 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15526 || !is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode))
15527 break;
15528 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
15529 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15530 if (op0 == 0)
15531 break;
15532 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
15533 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15534 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15535 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
15536 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
15537 masking. */
15538 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= 4)
15540 mem_loc_result = op0;
15541 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15542 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (inner_mode)));
15543 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
15545 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15547 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
15548 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
15549 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
15550 op = DW_OP_shra;
15551 else
15552 op = DW_OP_shr;
15553 mem_loc_result = op0;
15554 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
15555 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15556 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
15557 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15559 else if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15561 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
15562 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15564 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (inner_mode,
15565 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
15566 if (type_die1 == NULL)
15567 break;
15568 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15569 if (type_die2 == NULL)
15570 break;
15571 mem_loc_result = op0;
15572 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15573 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15574 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
15575 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15576 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15577 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15578 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15579 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
15580 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15581 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
15583 break;
15585 case MEM:
15587 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15588 if (new_rtl != rtl)
15590 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
15591 initialized);
15592 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
15593 return mem_loc_result;
15596 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15597 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
15598 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15599 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
15600 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15601 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
15603 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15604 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15606 dw_die_ref type_die;
15607 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
15608 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
15610 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15611 return NULL;
15612 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
15613 return NULL;
15614 type_die
15615 = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
15616 if (type_die == NULL)
15617 return NULL;
15618 deref = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_deref_type), size, 0);
15619 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15620 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15621 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15622 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
15624 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15625 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
15626 else
15627 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15628 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
15629 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0));
15631 break;
15633 case LO_SUM:
15634 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
15636 case LABEL_REF:
15637 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
15638 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
15639 pool. */
15640 case CONST:
15641 case SYMBOL_REF:
15642 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15643 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15644 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15645 && (int_mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
15646 #endif
15648 break;
15649 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
15650 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
15652 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15654 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
15655 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15656 break;
15658 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
15660 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
15661 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
15662 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr ((dwarf_version >= 5
15663 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
15664 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address),
15665 0, 0);
15666 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
15668 break;
15671 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15673 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
15674 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15676 case NOT:
15677 op = DW_OP_not;
15678 goto try_const_unop;
15679 case NEG:
15680 op = DW_OP_neg;
15681 goto try_const_unop;
15682 try_const_unop:
15683 rtx arg;
15684 arg = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
15685 if (!CONSTANT_P (arg))
15686 arg = gen_rtx_CONST (int_mode, arg);
15687 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (arg, int_mode, mem_mode,
15688 initialized);
15689 if (op0)
15691 mem_loc_result = op0;
15692 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15694 break;
15695 default:
15696 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode,
15697 mem_mode, initialized);
15698 break;
15700 break;
15703 symref:
15704 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15705 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15706 break;
15708 case CONCAT:
15709 case CONCATN:
15710 case VAR_LOCATION:
15711 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15712 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
15713 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
15714 return 0;
15716 case ENTRY_VALUE:
15717 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
15718 return NULL;
15719 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
15721 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15722 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15723 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15724 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15725 else
15727 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
15728 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
15729 return NULL;
15730 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
15731 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15734 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
15735 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
15737 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
15738 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15739 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
15740 return NULL;
15742 else
15743 gcc_unreachable ();
15744 if (op0 == NULL)
15745 return NULL;
15746 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_entry_value), 0, 0);
15747 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15748 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
15749 break;
15751 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
15752 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
15753 break;
15755 case PRE_MODIFY:
15756 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
15757 PLUS code below. */
15758 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15759 goto plus;
15761 case PRE_INC:
15762 case PRE_DEC:
15763 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
15764 below. */
15765 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15766 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
15767 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
15768 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
15769 mode));
15771 /* fall through */
15773 case PLUS:
15774 plus:
15775 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
15776 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15777 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15778 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
15779 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx))
15780 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15781 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
15782 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15783 else
15785 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15786 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15787 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
15788 break;
15790 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15791 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
15792 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15793 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15794 else
15796 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15797 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15798 if (op1 == 0)
15799 return NULL;
15800 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15801 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15802 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15805 break;
15807 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
15808 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
15809 case MINUS:
15810 op = DW_OP_minus;
15811 goto do_binop;
15813 case MULT:
15814 op = DW_OP_mul;
15815 goto do_binop;
15817 case DIV:
15818 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15819 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15820 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15822 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15823 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15824 int_mode, mem_mode);
15825 break;
15827 op = DW_OP_div;
15828 goto do_binop;
15830 case UMOD:
15831 op = DW_OP_mod;
15832 goto do_binop;
15834 case ASHIFT:
15835 op = DW_OP_shl;
15836 goto do_shift;
15838 case ASHIFTRT:
15839 op = DW_OP_shra;
15840 goto do_shift;
15842 case LSHIFTRT:
15843 op = DW_OP_shr;
15844 goto do_shift;
15846 do_shift:
15847 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15848 break;
15849 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), int_mode, mem_mode,
15850 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15852 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15853 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (rtlop1), &op1_mode)
15854 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op1_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode))
15855 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (int_mode, rtlop1);
15856 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, int_mode, mem_mode,
15857 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15860 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15861 break;
15863 mem_loc_result = op0;
15864 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15865 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15866 break;
15868 case AND:
15869 op = DW_OP_and;
15870 goto do_binop;
15872 case IOR:
15873 op = DW_OP_or;
15874 goto do_binop;
15876 case XOR:
15877 op = DW_OP_xor;
15878 goto do_binop;
15880 do_binop:
15881 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15882 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15883 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15884 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15886 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15887 break;
15889 mem_loc_result = op0;
15890 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15891 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15892 break;
15894 case MOD:
15895 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15896 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15897 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15899 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
15900 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
15901 int_mode, mem_mode);
15902 break;
15905 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15906 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15907 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15908 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15910 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
15911 break;
15913 mem_loc_result = op0;
15914 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15915 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15916 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
15917 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15918 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
15919 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
15920 break;
15922 case UDIV:
15923 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15924 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
15926 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15928 op = DW_OP_div;
15929 goto do_binop;
15931 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
15932 base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1),
15933 int_mode, mem_mode);
15935 break;
15937 case NOT:
15938 op = DW_OP_not;
15939 goto do_unop;
15941 case ABS:
15942 op = DW_OP_abs;
15943 goto do_unop;
15945 case NEG:
15946 op = DW_OP_neg;
15947 goto do_unop;
15949 do_unop:
15950 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15951 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15953 if (op0 == 0)
15954 break;
15956 mem_loc_result = op0;
15957 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15958 break;
15960 case CONST_INT:
15961 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
15962 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15963 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15964 || (int_mode == Pmode
15965 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
15966 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
15967 #endif
15970 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15971 break;
15973 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
15974 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15975 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
15977 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
15978 scalar_int_mode amode;
15979 if (type_die == NULL)
15980 return NULL;
15981 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
15982 && (int_mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0)
15983 .exists (&amode))
15984 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
15985 /* const DW_OP_convert <XXX> vs.
15986 DW_OP_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
15987 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
15988 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode))
15990 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15991 op0 = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
15992 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15993 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15994 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15995 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15996 return mem_loc_result;
15998 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0,
15999 INTVAL (rtl));
16000 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16001 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16002 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16003 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
16004 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
16005 else
16007 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16008 = dw_val_class_const_double;
16009 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16010 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
16013 break;
16015 case CONST_DOUBLE:
16016 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16018 dw_die_ref type_die;
16020 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
16021 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
16022 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
16023 the value is always a floating point constant.
16025 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
16026 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
16027 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
16028 if (mode == VOIDmode
16029 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
16030 && maybe_ne (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
16031 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT)))
16032 break;
16033 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
16034 if (type_die == NULL)
16035 return NULL;
16036 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
16037 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16038 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16039 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16040 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
16041 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
16043 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16044 = dw_val_class_const_double;
16045 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16046 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
16048 else
16049 #endif
16051 scalar_float_mode float_mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (mode);
16052 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (float_mode);
16053 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
16055 insert_float (rtl, array);
16056 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16057 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
16058 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
16059 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16062 break;
16064 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
16065 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16067 dw_die_ref type_die;
16069 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode));
16070 if (type_die == NULL)
16071 return NULL;
16072 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_const_type), 0, 0);
16073 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16074 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16075 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16076 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
16077 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
16078 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
16079 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, mode);
16081 break;
16083 case CONST_POLY_INT:
16084 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (rtx_to_poly_int64 (rtl));
16085 break;
16087 case EQ:
16088 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
16089 break;
16091 case GE:
16092 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
16093 break;
16095 case GT:
16096 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
16097 break;
16099 case LE:
16100 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
16101 break;
16103 case LT:
16104 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
16105 break;
16107 case NE:
16108 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
16109 break;
16111 case GEU:
16112 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
16113 break;
16115 case GTU:
16116 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
16117 break;
16119 case LEU:
16120 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
16121 break;
16123 case LTU:
16124 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
16125 break;
16127 case UMIN:
16128 case UMAX:
16129 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
16130 break;
16131 /* FALLTHRU */
16132 case SMIN:
16133 case SMAX:
16134 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
16135 break;
16137 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
16138 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
16139 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
16140 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
16141 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16142 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &inner_mode)
16143 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16144 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16145 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
16146 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
16147 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_mode)))
16149 int shift, size;
16150 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), inner_mode,
16151 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16152 if (op0 == 0)
16153 break;
16154 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
16155 op = DW_OP_shra;
16156 else
16157 op = DW_OP_shr;
16158 mem_loc_result = op0;
16159 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
16160 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
16161 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16162 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) - shift - size;
16163 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16165 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
16166 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16167 - shift - size));
16168 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
16170 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16172 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
16173 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
16174 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16177 break;
16179 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
16181 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
16182 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
16183 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
16184 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
16185 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16186 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
16187 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16188 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
16189 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16190 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
16191 break;
16193 mem_loc_result = op1;
16194 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
16195 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
16196 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
16197 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
16198 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
16199 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
16200 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
16201 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16202 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
16204 break;
16206 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
16207 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
16208 case FLOAT:
16209 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
16210 case FIX:
16211 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
16212 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
16214 dw_die_ref type_die;
16215 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
16217 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
16218 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16219 if (op0 == NULL)
16220 break;
16221 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)), &int_mode)
16222 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
16223 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
16225 type_die = base_type_for_mode (int_mode,
16226 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
16227 if (type_die == NULL)
16228 break;
16229 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
16230 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16231 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16232 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16233 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
16235 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
16236 if (type_die == NULL)
16237 break;
16238 cvt = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_convert), 0, 0);
16239 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16240 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
16241 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16242 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
16243 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16244 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
16245 || GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
16247 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (int_mode, op0);
16248 if (op0 == NULL)
16249 break;
16251 mem_loc_result = op0;
16253 break;
16255 case CLZ:
16256 case CTZ:
16257 case FFS:
16258 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16259 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16260 break;
16262 case POPCOUNT:
16263 case PARITY:
16264 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16265 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16266 break;
16268 case BSWAP:
16269 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16270 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16271 break;
16273 case ROTATE:
16274 case ROTATERT:
16275 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
16276 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, int_mode, mem_mode);
16277 break;
16279 case COMPARE:
16280 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
16281 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
16282 natively. */
16283 case SS_MULT:
16284 case US_MULT:
16285 case SS_DIV:
16286 case US_DIV:
16287 case SS_PLUS:
16288 case US_PLUS:
16289 case SS_MINUS:
16290 case US_MINUS:
16291 case SS_NEG:
16292 case US_NEG:
16293 case SS_ABS:
16294 case SS_ASHIFT:
16295 case US_ASHIFT:
16296 case SS_TRUNCATE:
16297 case US_TRUNCATE:
16298 case UNORDERED:
16299 case ORDERED:
16300 case UNEQ:
16301 case UNGE:
16302 case UNGT:
16303 case UNLE:
16304 case UNLT:
16305 case LTGT:
16306 case FRACT_CONVERT:
16307 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
16308 case SAT_FRACT:
16309 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
16310 case SQRT:
16311 case ASM_OPERANDS:
16312 case VEC_MERGE:
16313 case VEC_SELECT:
16314 case VEC_CONCAT:
16315 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
16316 case VEC_SERIES:
16317 case UNSPEC:
16318 case HIGH:
16319 case FMA:
16320 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
16321 case CONST_VECTOR:
16322 case CONST_FIXED:
16323 case CLRSB:
16324 case CLOBBER:
16325 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
16326 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
16327 TLS UNSPECs. */
16328 break;
16330 case CONST_STRING:
16331 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
16332 goto symref;
16334 /* RTL sequences inside PARALLEL record a series of DWARF operations for
16335 the expression. An UNSPEC rtx represents a raw DWARF operation,
16336 new_loc_descr is called for it to build the operation directly.
16337 Otherwise mem_loc_descriptor is called recursively. */
16338 case PARALLEL:
16340 int index = 0;
16341 dw_loc_descr_ref exp_result = NULL;
16343 for (; index < XVECLEN (rtl, 0); index++)
16345 rtx elem = XVECEXP (rtl, 0, index);
16346 if (GET_CODE (elem) == UNSPEC)
16348 /* Each DWARF operation UNSPEC contain two operands, if
16349 one operand is not used for the operation, const0_rtx is
16350 passed. */
16351 gcc_assert (XVECLEN (elem, 0) == 2);
16353 HOST_WIDE_INT dw_op = XINT (elem, 1);
16354 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 0));
16355 HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2 = INTVAL (XVECEXP (elem, 0, 1));
16356 exp_result
16357 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) dw_op, oprnd1,
16358 oprnd2);
16360 else
16361 exp_result
16362 = mem_loc_descriptor (elem, mode, mem_mode,
16363 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16365 if (!mem_loc_result)
16366 mem_loc_result = exp_result;
16367 else
16368 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, exp_result);
16371 break;
16374 default:
16375 if (flag_checking)
16377 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
16378 gcc_unreachable ();
16380 break;
16383 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16384 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16386 return mem_loc_result;
16389 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
16390 This is typically a complex variable. */
16392 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16393 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
16395 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
16396 unsigned int size0, size1;
16397 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)).is_constant (&size0)
16398 || !GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)).is_constant (&size1))
16399 return 0;
16401 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
16402 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
16403 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16404 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
16405 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16407 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
16408 return 0;
16410 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
16411 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size0);
16413 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
16414 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size1);
16416 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16417 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16419 return cc_loc_result;
16422 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
16423 locations. */
16425 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16426 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
16428 unsigned int i;
16429 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
16430 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
16431 unsigned int size;
16433 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
16435 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
16436 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
16438 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
16439 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)).is_constant (&size))
16440 return NULL;
16442 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16443 if (ref == NULL)
16444 return NULL;
16446 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
16447 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, size);
16450 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
16451 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
16453 return cc_loc_result;
16456 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_implicit_pointer
16457 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
16459 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16460 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16462 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
16463 dw_die_ref ref;
16465 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
16466 return NULL;
16467 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
16468 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
16469 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
16470 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
16471 ret = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
16472 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
16473 if (ref)
16475 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
16476 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
16477 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
16479 else
16481 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
16482 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
16484 return ret;
16487 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
16488 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
16489 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
16490 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
16491 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
16493 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
16494 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
16495 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
16497 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
16499 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16500 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
16501 enum var_init_status initialized)
16503 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
16504 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
16506 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
16508 case SUBREG:
16509 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
16510 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
16511 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
16512 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
16513 contains the given subreg. */
16514 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
16515 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
16516 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
16517 else
16518 goto do_default;
16519 break;
16521 case REG:
16522 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
16523 break;
16525 case MEM:
16526 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16527 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
16528 if (loc_result == NULL)
16529 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
16530 if (loc_result == NULL)
16532 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
16533 if (new_rtl != rtl)
16534 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
16536 break;
16538 case CONCAT:
16539 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
16540 initialized);
16541 break;
16543 case CONCATN:
16544 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
16545 break;
16547 case VAR_LOCATION:
16548 /* Single part. */
16549 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
16551 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
16552 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16553 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
16554 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
16555 break;
16558 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
16559 /* FALLTHRU */
16561 case PARALLEL:
16563 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
16564 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
16565 machine_mode mode;
16566 int i, size;
16568 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
16569 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
16570 VOIDmode, initialized);
16571 if (loc_result == NULL)
16572 return NULL;
16573 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
16574 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
16575 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
16576 return NULL;
16577 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
16578 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
16580 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
16582 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
16583 VOIDmode, initialized);
16584 if (temp == NULL)
16585 return NULL;
16586 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
16587 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
16588 /* At present we only track constant-sized pieces. */
16589 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
16590 return NULL;
16591 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
16594 break;
16596 case CONST_INT:
16597 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
16599 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
16600 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode),
16601 INTVAL (rtl));
16603 break;
16605 case CONST_DOUBLE:
16606 if (mode == VOIDmode)
16607 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16609 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16611 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
16613 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
16614 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
16615 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
16616 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
16617 scalar_mode smode = as_a <scalar_mode> (mode);
16618 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16619 GET_MODE_SIZE (smode), 0);
16620 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
16621 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (smode))
16623 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
16624 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
16625 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
16627 else
16628 #endif
16630 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (smode);
16631 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
16633 insert_float (rtl, array);
16634 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16635 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
16636 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
16637 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16640 break;
16642 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
16643 if (mode == VOIDmode)
16644 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16646 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16648 int_mode = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode);
16649 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16650 GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode), 0);
16651 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
16652 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
16653 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = rtx_mode_t (rtl, int_mode);
16655 break;
16657 case CONST_VECTOR:
16658 if (mode == VOIDmode)
16659 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16661 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16663 unsigned int length;
16664 if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
16665 return NULL;
16667 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
16668 unsigned char *array
16669 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
16670 unsigned int i;
16671 unsigned char *p;
16672 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
16674 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
16675 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16677 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16678 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16680 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16681 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
16683 break;
16685 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16686 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16688 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16689 insert_float (elt, p);
16691 break;
16693 default:
16694 gcc_unreachable ();
16697 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
16698 length * elt_size, 0);
16699 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
16700 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
16701 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
16702 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
16704 break;
16706 case CONST:
16707 if (mode == VOIDmode
16708 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16709 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
16710 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
16712 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
16713 break;
16715 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16716 case SYMBOL_REF:
16717 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16718 break;
16719 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16720 case LABEL_REF:
16721 if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16722 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16723 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16725 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
16726 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16727 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
16729 break;
16731 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
16732 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
16733 break;
16735 case PLUS:
16736 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
16737 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
16739 loc_result
16740 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
16741 break;
16743 /* FALLTHRU */
16744 do_default:
16745 default:
16746 if ((is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
16747 && GET_MODE (rtl) == int_mode
16748 && GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16749 && dwarf_version >= 4)
16750 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
16752 /* Value expression. */
16753 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16754 if (loc_result)
16755 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
16756 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16758 break;
16761 return loc_result;
16764 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
16765 address ranges where a given location is valid.
16766 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
16767 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
16768 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
16769 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
16771 static const char *
16772 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
16774 const char *secname;
16776 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
16777 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
16778 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
16779 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
16780 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
16781 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
16782 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
16783 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
16784 else
16785 secname = text_section_label;
16787 return secname;
16790 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
16792 static bool
16793 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
16795 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
16796 || VAR_P (decl))
16797 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
16800 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16801 for VARLOC. */
16803 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16804 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
16805 enum var_init_status initialized)
16807 int have_address = 0;
16808 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16809 machine_mode mode;
16811 if (want_address != 2)
16813 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
16814 /* Single part. */
16815 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
16817 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
16818 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
16819 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16820 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
16821 if (MEM_P (varloc))
16823 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
16824 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
16825 mode, initialized);
16826 if (descr)
16827 have_address = 1;
16828 else
16830 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
16831 if (x != varloc)
16832 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
16833 initialized);
16836 else
16837 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
16839 else
16840 return 0;
16842 else
16844 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
16845 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
16846 else
16847 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
16848 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
16849 have_address = 1;
16852 if (!descr)
16853 return 0;
16855 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16856 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16858 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16860 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16861 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16862 return 0;
16864 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16865 have_address = 1;
16867 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16868 if (want_address && !have_address)
16870 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16871 "Want address and only have value");
16872 return 0;
16875 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16876 if (!want_address && have_address)
16878 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16879 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16881 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16883 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16884 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16885 return 0;
16887 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16888 op = DW_OP_deref;
16889 else
16890 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16892 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16895 return descr;
16898 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
16899 if it is not possible. */
16901 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16902 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16904 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
16905 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
16906 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
16907 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
16908 else
16909 return NULL;
16912 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
16913 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
16915 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16916 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
16918 rtx p;
16919 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
16920 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
16921 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
16922 rtx varloc;
16923 enum var_init_status initialized;
16925 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
16926 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16927 return NULL;
16929 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
16930 descr = NULL;
16931 descr_tail = &descr;
16933 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
16935 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
16936 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
16937 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
16938 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
16939 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
16941 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
16942 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
16944 padsize += bitsize;
16945 continue;
16947 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
16948 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
16949 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
16950 if (cur_descr == NULL)
16952 padsize += bitsize;
16953 continue;
16956 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
16957 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
16958 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
16959 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
16960 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
16961 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
16963 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
16964 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16965 last = *tail;
16967 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
16969 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
16970 last = *tail;
16973 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
16975 padsize += bitsize;
16976 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
16977 addr_table entries it uses. */
16978 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16979 continue;
16982 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
16983 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
16984 if (padsize)
16986 if (padsize > decl_size)
16988 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16989 goto discard_descr;
16991 decl_size -= padsize;
16992 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
16993 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16995 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
16996 goto discard_descr;
16998 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16999 padsize = 0;
17001 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
17002 descr_tail = tail;
17003 if (bitsize > decl_size)
17004 goto discard_descr;
17005 decl_size -= bitsize;
17006 if (last == NULL)
17008 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
17009 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
17010 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
17012 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
17013 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
17014 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
17018 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
17019 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
17020 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
17021 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
17022 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
17023 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
17024 else
17025 break;
17027 while (1);
17028 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
17029 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
17030 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
17031 adjustment. */
17032 if (MEM_P (varloc))
17034 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize;
17035 if (!poly_uint64 (MEM_SIZE (varloc)).is_constant (&memsize))
17036 goto discard_descr;
17037 memsize *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
17038 if (memsize != bitsize)
17040 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
17041 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
17042 goto discard_descr;
17043 if (memsize < bitsize)
17044 goto discard_descr;
17045 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
17046 offset = memsize - bitsize;
17050 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
17051 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
17052 goto discard_descr;
17053 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17057 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
17058 the decl. */
17059 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
17061 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
17062 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
17063 goto discard_descr;
17065 return descr;
17067 discard_descr:
17068 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
17069 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
17070 return NULL;
17073 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
17074 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
17075 function. */
17077 static dw_loc_list_ref
17078 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
17080 const char *endname, *secname;
17081 var_loc_view endview;
17082 rtx varloc;
17083 enum var_init_status initialized;
17084 struct var_loc_node *node;
17085 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
17086 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17087 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
17088 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
17090 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
17091 actually construct the list of locations.
17092 The first location information is what is passed to the
17093 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
17094 locations just get added on to that list.
17095 Note that we only know the start address for a location
17096 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
17097 the range [current location start, next location start].
17098 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
17099 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
17101 if (cfun && crtl->has_bb_partition)
17103 bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
17104 in_cold_section_p = first_function_block_is_cold;
17105 if (loc_list->last_before_switch == NULL)
17106 in_cold_section_p = !in_cold_section_p;
17107 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17108 in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
17110 else
17111 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17113 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
17115 bool range_across_switch = false;
17116 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
17117 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
17119 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
17121 descr = NULL;
17122 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
17123 inside DWARF expressions. */
17124 if (want_address == 2)
17125 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
17127 else
17129 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
17130 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
17131 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
17133 if (descr)
17135 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
17136 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
17137 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
17138 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
17139 of first partition and second one starting at the
17140 beginning of second partition. */
17141 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
17142 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
17143 && current_function_decl)
17145 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
17146 endview = 0;
17147 range_across_switch = true;
17149 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
17150 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
17151 else if (node->next)
17152 endname = node->next->label, endview = node->next->view;
17153 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
17154 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
17155 else if (!current_function_decl)
17156 endname = text_end_label, endview = 0;
17157 else
17159 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
17160 current_function_funcdef_no);
17161 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
17162 endview = 0;
17165 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, node->view,
17166 endname, endview, secname);
17167 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
17168 && node == loc_list->first
17169 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
17170 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
17171 (*listp)->force = true;
17172 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
17176 if (cfun
17177 && crtl->has_bb_partition
17178 && node == loc_list->last_before_switch)
17180 bool save_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
17181 in_cold_section_p = !first_function_block_is_cold;
17182 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
17183 in_cold_section_p = save_in_cold_section_p;
17186 if (range_across_switch)
17188 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
17189 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
17190 else
17192 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
17193 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
17194 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
17195 initialized);
17197 gcc_assert (descr);
17198 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
17199 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
17200 if (node->next)
17201 endname = node->next->label, endview = node->next->view;
17202 else
17203 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end, endview = 0;
17204 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin, 0,
17205 endname, endview, secname);
17206 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
17210 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
17211 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
17212 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
17213 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
17214 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
17215 available. */
17216 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
17217 gen_llsym (list);
17218 else
17219 maybe_gen_llsym (list);
17221 return list;
17224 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
17225 as location description. */
17227 static bool
17228 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
17230 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
17231 return !list->ll_symbol;
17234 /* Duplicate a single element of location list. */
17236 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
17237 copy_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17239 dw_loc_descr_ref copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
17240 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
17241 return copy;
17244 /* To each location in list LIST append loc descr REF. */
17246 static void
17247 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17249 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
17250 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
17251 list = list->dw_loc_next;
17252 while (list)
17254 copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
17255 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
17256 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
17257 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
17258 list = list->dw_loc_next;
17262 /* To each location in list LIST prepend loc descr REF. */
17264 static void
17265 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
17267 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
17268 dw_loc_descr_ref ref_end = list->expr;
17269 add_loc_descr (&ref, list->expr);
17270 list->expr = ref;
17271 list = list->dw_loc_next;
17272 while (list)
17274 dw_loc_descr_ref end = list->expr;
17275 list->expr = copy = copy_loc_descr (ref);
17276 while (copy->dw_loc_next != ref_end)
17277 copy = copy->dw_loc_next = copy_loc_descr (copy->dw_loc_next);
17278 copy->dw_loc_next = end;
17279 list = list->dw_loc_next;
17283 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
17284 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
17285 to expression in RET on each position in program.
17286 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
17288 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
17289 element. General case would involve sorting the lists in program order
17290 and merging them that will need some additional work.
17291 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
17292 structures. */
17294 static void
17295 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
17297 if (!list)
17298 return;
17299 if (!*ret)
17301 *ret = list;
17302 return;
17304 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
17306 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
17307 return;
17309 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
17311 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
17312 *ret = list;
17313 return;
17315 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
17316 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
17317 " location lists.\n");
17318 *ret = NULL;
17319 return;
17322 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
17323 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
17325 static dw_loc_descr_ref
17326 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
17328 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
17329 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
17331 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
17333 gcc_assert (!rtl);
17334 return 0;
17336 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
17338 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
17339 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
17340 populated. */
17341 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
17343 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
17344 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
17345 return 0;
17347 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
17348 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
17351 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
17352 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
17353 it into simple arithmetics.
17355 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
17357 static dw_loc_list_ref
17358 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
17359 loc_descr_context *context)
17361 tree obj, offset;
17362 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
17363 machine_mode mode;
17364 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17365 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
17367 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
17368 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17369 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
17370 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
17371 if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos))
17373 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
17374 return 0;
17376 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
17378 expansion_failed (obj,
17379 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
17380 return 0;
17382 if (!offset && known_eq (bitpos, 0))
17383 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
17384 context);
17385 else if (toplev
17386 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
17387 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
17389 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
17390 if (!list_ret)
17391 return 0;
17392 if (offset)
17394 /* Variable offset. */
17395 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
17396 if (list_ret1 == 0)
17397 return 0;
17398 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
17399 if (!list_ret)
17400 return 0;
17401 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17402 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
17404 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
17405 if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
17406 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17407 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, value, 0));
17408 else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
17409 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
17410 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
17411 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
17413 return list_ret;
17416 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
17417 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
17418 operations that are skipped. */
17420 static void
17421 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
17422 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
17424 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
17426 nops.add (loc);
17427 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
17431 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
17432 P. */
17434 bool
17435 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17437 ggc_free (loc);
17438 return true;
17441 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
17442 finishes LOC. */
17444 static void
17445 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
17447 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
17448 return;
17450 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
17451 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
17453 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
17454 operations list. */
17455 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
17457 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
17459 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
17460 labels. */
17461 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
17462 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
17463 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
17464 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
17466 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
17467 iteration. */
17468 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
17469 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
17470 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
17473 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
17477 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
17479 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
17480 struct loc_descr_context
17482 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
17483 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
17484 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
17485 tree context_type;
17486 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
17487 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
17488 tree base_decl;
17489 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
17490 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
17491 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
17492 /* True if integral PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for the first argument passed
17493 by consumer. Used for DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes. */
17494 bool placeholder_arg;
17495 /* True if PLACEHOLDER_EXPR has been seen. */
17496 bool placeholder_seen;
17499 /* DWARF procedures generation
17501 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
17502 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
17503 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
17504 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
17506 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
17507 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
17508 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
17509 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
17510 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
17511 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
17513 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
17514 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
17516 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
17517 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
17518 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
17520 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
17521 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
17523 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
17524 single stack slot.
17526 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
17527 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
17528 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
17529 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
17530 returns. */
17532 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
17533 struct dwarf_procedure_info
17535 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
17536 currently translated. */
17537 tree fndecl;
17538 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
17539 unsigned args_count;
17542 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
17543 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
17544 equate it to this DIE. */
17546 static dw_die_ref
17547 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
17548 dw_die_ref parent_die)
17550 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17552 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17553 || location == NULL)
17554 return NULL;
17556 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, parent_die, fndecl);
17557 if (fndecl)
17558 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
17559 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
17560 return dwarf_proc_die;
17563 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
17564 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
17565 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
17567 static bool
17568 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
17570 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
17571 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
17572 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
17573 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
17576 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking: do the same but stop when coming across
17577 visited nodes. For each node we visit, register in FRAME_OFFSETS the frame
17578 offset *before* evaluating the corresponding operation. */
17580 static bool
17581 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17582 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
17583 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> &frame_offsets)
17585 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
17586 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
17587 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
17589 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
17591 bool existed;
17592 unsigned &l_frame_offset = frame_offsets.get_or_insert (l, &existed);
17594 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
17595 if (existed)
17597 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
17598 flow comes from. */
17599 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
17600 break;
17602 l_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
17604 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
17605 offset. */
17606 if (l->frame_offset_rel)
17608 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT off;
17609 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17611 case DW_OP_pick:
17612 off = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
17613 break;
17614 case DW_OP_dup:
17615 off = 0;
17616 break;
17617 case DW_OP_over:
17618 off = 1;
17619 break;
17620 default:
17621 gcc_unreachable ();
17623 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
17624 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
17625 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
17626 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
17627 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
17628 one, etc.).
17630 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
17631 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
17632 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
17633 off += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
17635 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
17636 if (off > 255)
17637 return false;
17639 if (off == 0)
17641 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_dup;
17642 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
17644 else if (off == 1)
17646 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_over;
17647 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = 0;
17649 else
17651 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_pick;
17652 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = off;
17656 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
17657 on the stack. */
17658 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17660 case DW_OP_deref:
17661 case DW_OP_swap:
17662 case DW_OP_rot:
17663 case DW_OP_abs:
17664 case DW_OP_neg:
17665 case DW_OP_not:
17666 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
17667 case DW_OP_skip:
17668 case DW_OP_reg0:
17669 case DW_OP_reg1:
17670 case DW_OP_reg2:
17671 case DW_OP_reg3:
17672 case DW_OP_reg4:
17673 case DW_OP_reg5:
17674 case DW_OP_reg6:
17675 case DW_OP_reg7:
17676 case DW_OP_reg8:
17677 case DW_OP_reg9:
17678 case DW_OP_reg10:
17679 case DW_OP_reg11:
17680 case DW_OP_reg12:
17681 case DW_OP_reg13:
17682 case DW_OP_reg14:
17683 case DW_OP_reg15:
17684 case DW_OP_reg16:
17685 case DW_OP_reg17:
17686 case DW_OP_reg18:
17687 case DW_OP_reg19:
17688 case DW_OP_reg20:
17689 case DW_OP_reg21:
17690 case DW_OP_reg22:
17691 case DW_OP_reg23:
17692 case DW_OP_reg24:
17693 case DW_OP_reg25:
17694 case DW_OP_reg26:
17695 case DW_OP_reg27:
17696 case DW_OP_reg28:
17697 case DW_OP_reg29:
17698 case DW_OP_reg30:
17699 case DW_OP_reg31:
17700 case DW_OP_bregx:
17701 case DW_OP_piece:
17702 case DW_OP_deref_size:
17703 case DW_OP_nop:
17704 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
17705 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
17706 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17707 break;
17709 case DW_OP_addr:
17710 case DW_OP_const1u:
17711 case DW_OP_const1s:
17712 case DW_OP_const2u:
17713 case DW_OP_const2s:
17714 case DW_OP_const4u:
17715 case DW_OP_const4s:
17716 case DW_OP_const8u:
17717 case DW_OP_const8s:
17718 case DW_OP_constu:
17719 case DW_OP_consts:
17720 case DW_OP_dup:
17721 case DW_OP_over:
17722 case DW_OP_pick:
17723 case DW_OP_lit0:
17724 case DW_OP_lit1:
17725 case DW_OP_lit2:
17726 case DW_OP_lit3:
17727 case DW_OP_lit4:
17728 case DW_OP_lit5:
17729 case DW_OP_lit6:
17730 case DW_OP_lit7:
17731 case DW_OP_lit8:
17732 case DW_OP_lit9:
17733 case DW_OP_lit10:
17734 case DW_OP_lit11:
17735 case DW_OP_lit12:
17736 case DW_OP_lit13:
17737 case DW_OP_lit14:
17738 case DW_OP_lit15:
17739 case DW_OP_lit16:
17740 case DW_OP_lit17:
17741 case DW_OP_lit18:
17742 case DW_OP_lit19:
17743 case DW_OP_lit20:
17744 case DW_OP_lit21:
17745 case DW_OP_lit22:
17746 case DW_OP_lit23:
17747 case DW_OP_lit24:
17748 case DW_OP_lit25:
17749 case DW_OP_lit26:
17750 case DW_OP_lit27:
17751 case DW_OP_lit28:
17752 case DW_OP_lit29:
17753 case DW_OP_lit30:
17754 case DW_OP_lit31:
17755 case DW_OP_breg0:
17756 case DW_OP_breg1:
17757 case DW_OP_breg2:
17758 case DW_OP_breg3:
17759 case DW_OP_breg4:
17760 case DW_OP_breg5:
17761 case DW_OP_breg6:
17762 case DW_OP_breg7:
17763 case DW_OP_breg8:
17764 case DW_OP_breg9:
17765 case DW_OP_breg10:
17766 case DW_OP_breg11:
17767 case DW_OP_breg12:
17768 case DW_OP_breg13:
17769 case DW_OP_breg14:
17770 case DW_OP_breg15:
17771 case DW_OP_breg16:
17772 case DW_OP_breg17:
17773 case DW_OP_breg18:
17774 case DW_OP_breg19:
17775 case DW_OP_breg20:
17776 case DW_OP_breg21:
17777 case DW_OP_breg22:
17778 case DW_OP_breg23:
17779 case DW_OP_breg24:
17780 case DW_OP_breg25:
17781 case DW_OP_breg26:
17782 case DW_OP_breg27:
17783 case DW_OP_breg28:
17784 case DW_OP_breg29:
17785 case DW_OP_breg30:
17786 case DW_OP_breg31:
17787 case DW_OP_fbreg:
17788 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
17789 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
17790 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
17791 ++frame_offset_;
17792 break;
17794 case DW_OP_drop:
17795 case DW_OP_xderef:
17796 case DW_OP_and:
17797 case DW_OP_div:
17798 case DW_OP_minus:
17799 case DW_OP_mod:
17800 case DW_OP_mul:
17801 case DW_OP_or:
17802 case DW_OP_plus:
17803 case DW_OP_shl:
17804 case DW_OP_shr:
17805 case DW_OP_shra:
17806 case DW_OP_xor:
17807 case DW_OP_bra:
17808 case DW_OP_eq:
17809 case DW_OP_ge:
17810 case DW_OP_gt:
17811 case DW_OP_le:
17812 case DW_OP_lt:
17813 case DW_OP_ne:
17814 case DW_OP_regx:
17815 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
17816 --frame_offset_;
17817 break;
17819 case DW_OP_call2:
17820 case DW_OP_call4:
17821 case DW_OP_call_ref:
17823 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
17824 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
17826 if (stack_usage == NULL)
17827 return false;
17828 frame_offset_ += *stack_usage;
17829 break;
17832 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
17833 case DW_OP_entry_value:
17834 case DW_OP_const_type:
17835 case DW_OP_regval_type:
17836 case DW_OP_deref_type:
17837 case DW_OP_convert:
17838 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
17839 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
17840 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
17841 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
17842 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
17843 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
17844 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
17845 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
17846 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
17847 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
17848 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
17849 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
17850 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
17851 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
17852 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
17853 /* Fall through... */
17855 default:
17856 gcc_unreachable ();
17859 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
17860 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
17862 case DW_OP_bra:
17863 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
17864 frame_offsets))
17865 return false;
17866 /* Fall through. */
17868 case DW_OP_skip:
17869 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
17870 break;
17872 case DW_OP_stack_value:
17873 return true;
17875 default:
17876 l = l->dw_loc_next;
17877 break;
17881 return true;
17884 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
17885 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
17886 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame
17887 offset *before* LOC is executed. Return if all relocations were
17888 successful. */
17890 static bool
17891 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
17892 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
17894 /* Associate to all visited operations the frame offset *before* evaluating
17895 this operation. */
17896 hash_map<dw_loc_descr_ref, unsigned> frame_offsets;
17898 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi,
17899 frame_offsets);
17902 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
17903 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
17905 static dw_die_ref
17906 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
17908 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
17909 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
17910 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
17911 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
17912 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
17914 tree cursor;
17915 unsigned i;
17917 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
17918 declaration. */
17919 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
17920 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
17921 return dwarf_proc_die;
17923 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard. */
17924 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
17925 return NULL;
17927 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
17928 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
17929 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
17930 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
17931 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
17932 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
17933 return NULL;
17935 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
17936 cursor != NULL_TREE;
17937 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
17938 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
17939 return NULL;
17941 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
17942 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
17943 return NULL;
17944 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
17945 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
17946 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
17947 return NULL;
17948 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
17950 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
17951 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
17952 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
17953 the moment. */
17954 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
17955 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
17956 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
17957 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
17958 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
17959 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
17960 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
17961 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
17962 if (!loc_body)
17963 return NULL;
17965 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
17966 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
17967 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
17968 epilogue = NULL;
17969 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
17971 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
17972 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
17973 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
17974 epilogue = op_couple;
17976 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
17977 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
17978 return NULL;
17980 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
17981 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
17982 not anymore, so give it another try. */
17983 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
17985 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
17986 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
17987 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
17988 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
17989 dwarf_proc_die
17990 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
17991 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
17993 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
17994 returns one stack slot. */
17995 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
17997 return dwarf_proc_die;
18001 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
18002 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
18003 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
18004 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
18005 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
18006 to refer to register values).
18008 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
18009 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
18010 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
18011 will not be generated.
18013 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
18014 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
18016 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
18017 and dpi fields were null. */
18019 static dw_loc_list_ref
18020 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
18021 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18023 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
18024 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
18025 int have_address = 0;
18026 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
18028 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
18029 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
18030 problem... */
18032 if (context != NULL
18033 && context->base_decl == loc
18034 && want_address == 0)
18036 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18037 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
18038 NULL, 0, NULL, 0, NULL);
18039 else
18040 return NULL;
18043 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
18045 case ERROR_MARK:
18046 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
18047 return 0;
18049 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
18050 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
18051 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
18052 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
18053 that the context allows. */
18054 if (context != NULL
18055 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
18056 && want_address >= 1)
18058 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18060 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
18061 have_address = 1;
18062 break;
18064 else
18065 return NULL;
18067 /* For DW_TAG_generic_subrange attributes, PLACEHOLDER_EXPR stands for
18068 the single argument passed by consumer. */
18069 else if (context != NULL
18070 && context->placeholder_arg
18071 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
18072 && want_address == 0)
18074 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 0, 0);
18075 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
18076 context->placeholder_seen = true;
18077 break;
18079 else
18080 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18081 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
18082 break;
18084 case CALL_EXPR:
18086 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
18087 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
18088 int i;
18089 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
18091 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
18092 goto call_expansion_failed;
18094 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
18095 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
18096 goto call_expansion_failed;
18098 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
18099 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
18100 goto call_expansion_failed;
18102 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
18103 be the top-most one on the stack. */
18104 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
18106 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
18107 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
18108 context);
18110 if (loc_descr == NULL)
18111 goto call_expansion_failed;
18113 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
18116 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
18117 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
18118 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
18119 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
18120 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18121 break;
18123 call_expansion_failed:
18124 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
18125 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
18126 return 0;
18129 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
18130 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
18131 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
18132 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
18133 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
18134 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
18135 return 0;
18137 case ADDR_EXPR:
18138 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
18139 e.g. for &this->field. */
18140 if (want_address)
18142 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
18143 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
18144 if (list_ret)
18145 have_address = 1;
18146 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
18147 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18148 have_address = 1;
18150 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
18151 if (!list_ret && !ret)
18152 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
18153 else
18155 if (want_address)
18156 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
18157 return NULL;
18159 break;
18161 case VAR_DECL:
18162 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
18164 rtx rtl;
18165 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
18166 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
18168 if (targetm.have_tls)
18170 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
18171 data. */
18172 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
18173 return 0;
18175 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
18176 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
18177 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
18178 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
18179 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
18180 operand shouldn't be. */
18181 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
18182 return 0;
18183 dtprel = dtprel_true;
18184 /* We check for DWARF 5 here because gdb did not implement
18185 DW_OP_form_tls_address until after 7.12. */
18186 tls_op = (dwarf_version >= 5 ? DW_OP_form_tls_address
18187 : DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address);
18189 else
18191 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
18192 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18193 return 0;
18194 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
18195 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
18196 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
18197 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
18198 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
18199 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
18202 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
18203 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
18204 return 0;
18206 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
18207 return 0;
18208 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
18209 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
18210 return 0;
18212 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
18213 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
18214 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18216 have_address = 1;
18217 break;
18219 /* FALLTHRU */
18221 case PARM_DECL:
18222 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
18223 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
18225 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
18226 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
18227 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
18228 with the stack frame size. */
18229 unsigned i = 0;
18230 tree cursor;
18232 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
18233 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
18234 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
18236 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
18237 must belong to the current function. */
18238 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
18240 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
18241 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
18242 break;
18244 /* FALLTHRU */
18246 case RESULT_DECL:
18247 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
18248 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
18249 want_address, context);
18250 /* FALLTHRU */
18252 case FUNCTION_DECL:
18254 rtx rtl;
18255 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
18257 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
18259 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
18260 have_address = want_address != 0;
18261 break;
18263 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
18264 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
18266 if (TREE_CODE (loc) != FUNCTION_DECL
18267 && early_dwarf
18268 && current_function_decl
18269 && want_address != 1
18270 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (loc)
18271 && (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc))
18272 || POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18273 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == current_function_decl
18274 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18275 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
18277 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (loc);
18278 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_variable_value, 0, 0);
18279 if (ref)
18281 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
18282 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
18283 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
18285 else
18287 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
18288 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = loc;
18290 break;
18292 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
18293 return 0;
18295 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
18297 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
18298 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18299 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
18300 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
18302 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
18304 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
18305 return 0;
18307 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
18308 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
18309 else
18311 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
18313 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
18314 if (want_address == 2)
18316 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
18317 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18318 have_address = 1;
18320 else
18322 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
18323 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
18324 if (MEM_P (rtl))
18326 mem_mode = mode;
18327 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
18328 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
18329 have_address = 1;
18331 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
18332 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18334 if (!ret)
18335 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
18336 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
18339 break;
18341 case MEM_REF:
18342 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
18344 have_address = 1;
18345 goto do_plus;
18347 /* Fallthru. */
18348 case INDIRECT_REF:
18349 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18350 have_address = 1;
18351 break;
18353 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
18354 case SSA_NAME:
18355 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
18356 return NULL;
18358 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
18359 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
18360 context);
18362 CASE_CONVERT:
18363 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18364 case SAVE_EXPR:
18365 case MODIFY_EXPR:
18366 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
18367 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
18368 context);
18370 case COMPONENT_REF:
18371 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
18372 case ARRAY_REF:
18373 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
18374 case REALPART_EXPR:
18375 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
18377 tree obj, offset;
18378 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
18379 machine_mode mode;
18380 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
18382 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
18383 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
18385 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
18387 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
18388 want_address == 2
18389 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
18390 && !offset ? 2 : 1,
18391 context);
18392 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
18393 for nonzero bitpos. */
18394 if (list_ret == 0)
18395 return 0;
18396 if (!multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
18397 || !multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
18399 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18400 "bitfield access");
18401 return 0;
18404 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
18406 /* Variable offset. */
18407 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
18408 if (list_ret1 == 0)
18409 return 0;
18410 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18411 if (!list_ret)
18412 return 0;
18413 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
18416 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
18417 if (bytepos.is_constant (&value) && value > 0)
18418 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
18419 value, 0));
18420 else if (maybe_ne (bytepos, 0))
18421 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
18423 have_address = 1;
18424 break;
18427 case INTEGER_CST:
18428 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
18429 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18430 have_address = 1;
18431 else if (want_address == 2
18432 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
18433 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
18434 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
18435 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
18436 have_address = 1;
18437 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
18438 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
18439 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
18440 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
18441 else
18443 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18444 "Integer operand is not host integer");
18445 return 0;
18447 break;
18449 case CONSTRUCTOR:
18450 case REAL_CST:
18451 case STRING_CST:
18452 case COMPLEX_CST:
18453 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
18454 have_address = 1;
18455 else if (TREE_CODE (loc) == CONSTRUCTOR)
18457 tree type = TREE_TYPE (loc);
18458 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18459 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
18460 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
18461 constructor_elt *ce;
18463 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
18465 /* This is very limited, but it's enough to output
18466 pointers to member functions, as long as the
18467 referenced function is defined in the current
18468 translation unit. */
18469 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (loc), cnt, ce)
18471 tree val = ce->value;
18473 tree field = ce->index;
18475 if (val)
18476 STRIP_NOPS (val);
18478 if (!field || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
18480 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18481 "bitfield in record type constructor");
18482 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18483 ret = NULL;
18484 break;
18487 HOST_WIDE_INT fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
18488 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = int_byte_position (field);
18489 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
18490 if (pos < offset)
18492 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18493 "out-of-order fields in record constructor");
18494 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18495 ret = NULL;
18496 break;
18498 if (pos > offset)
18500 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, pos - offset, 0);
18501 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18502 offset = pos;
18504 if (val && fieldsize != 0)
18506 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, want_address, context);
18507 if (!ret1)
18509 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18510 "unsupported expression in field");
18511 size = offset = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)-1;
18512 ret = NULL;
18513 break;
18515 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18517 if (fieldsize)
18519 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, fieldsize, 0);
18520 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18521 offset = pos + fieldsize;
18525 if (offset != size)
18527 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size - offset, 0);
18528 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
18529 offset = size;
18532 have_address = !!want_address;
18534 else
18535 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18536 "constructor of non-record type");
18538 else
18539 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
18540 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18541 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
18542 break;
18544 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
18545 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
18546 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
18547 op = DW_OP_and;
18548 goto do_binop;
18550 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
18551 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
18552 op = DW_OP_xor;
18553 goto do_binop;
18555 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
18556 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
18557 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
18558 op = DW_OP_or;
18559 goto do_binop;
18561 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
18562 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
18563 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
18564 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
18565 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
18566 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18567 return 0;
18568 op = DW_OP_div;
18569 goto do_binop;
18571 case MINUS_EXPR:
18572 op = DW_OP_minus;
18573 goto do_binop;
18575 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
18576 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
18577 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
18578 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
18579 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
18581 op = DW_OP_mod;
18582 goto do_binop;
18584 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18585 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18586 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
18587 return 0;
18589 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18590 if (list_ret == 0)
18591 return 0;
18592 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
18593 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
18594 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
18595 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
18596 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
18597 break;
18599 case MULT_EXPR:
18600 op = DW_OP_mul;
18601 goto do_binop;
18603 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
18604 op = DW_OP_shl;
18605 goto do_binop;
18607 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
18608 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
18609 goto do_binop;
18611 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
18612 case PLUS_EXPR:
18613 do_plus:
18614 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
18616 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
18617 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
18618 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
18619 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
18620 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
18621 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
18622 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
18623 offset_int wi_addend;
18624 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
18625 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
18627 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18628 if (list_ret == 0)
18629 return 0;
18631 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
18632 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
18633 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
18634 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
18635 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
18636 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
18637 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
18638 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
18639 : NULL;
18641 if (loc_naddend != NULL
18642 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
18643 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
18645 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
18646 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18647 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
18649 else
18651 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
18653 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
18654 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
18655 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
18657 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
18659 break;
18662 op = DW_OP_plus;
18663 goto do_binop;
18665 case LE_EXPR:
18666 op = DW_OP_le;
18667 goto do_comp_binop;
18669 case GE_EXPR:
18670 op = DW_OP_ge;
18671 goto do_comp_binop;
18673 case LT_EXPR:
18674 op = DW_OP_lt;
18675 goto do_comp_binop;
18677 case GT_EXPR:
18678 op = DW_OP_gt;
18679 goto do_comp_binop;
18681 do_comp_binop:
18682 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
18684 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18685 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18686 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
18687 TREE_CODE (loc));
18688 break;
18690 else
18691 goto do_binop;
18693 case EQ_EXPR:
18694 op = DW_OP_eq;
18695 goto do_binop;
18697 case NE_EXPR:
18698 op = DW_OP_ne;
18699 goto do_binop;
18701 do_binop:
18702 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18703 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18704 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
18705 return 0;
18707 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
18708 if (list_ret == 0)
18709 return 0;
18710 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18711 break;
18713 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
18714 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
18715 op = DW_OP_not;
18716 goto do_unop;
18718 case ABS_EXPR:
18719 op = DW_OP_abs;
18720 goto do_unop;
18722 case NEGATE_EXPR:
18723 op = DW_OP_neg;
18724 goto do_unop;
18726 do_unop:
18727 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18728 if (list_ret == 0)
18729 return 0;
18731 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
18732 break;
18734 case MIN_EXPR:
18735 case MAX_EXPR:
18737 const enum tree_code code =
18738 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
18740 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
18741 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
18742 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
18743 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
18746 /* fall through */
18748 case COND_EXPR:
18750 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
18751 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
18752 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
18753 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
18754 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
18756 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
18757 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
18758 return 0;
18760 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
18761 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
18763 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
18764 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
18765 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
18767 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
18768 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18769 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
18771 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
18772 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
18773 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
18774 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
18775 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
18777 break;
18779 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
18780 return 0;
18782 default:
18783 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
18784 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
18785 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
18786 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
18788 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18789 "language specific tree node");
18790 return 0;
18793 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
18794 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
18795 if (flag_checking)
18796 gcc_unreachable ();
18798 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
18799 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
18800 return NULL;
18803 if (!ret && !list_ret)
18804 return 0;
18806 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
18807 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
18809 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18811 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18812 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18813 return 0;
18815 if (ret)
18816 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18817 else
18818 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
18819 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
18820 have_address = 1;
18822 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
18823 if (want_address && !have_address)
18825 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18826 "Want address and only have value");
18827 return 0;
18830 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
18832 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
18833 if (!want_address && have_address)
18835 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
18837 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
18839 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18840 "DWARF address size mismatch");
18841 return 0;
18843 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
18844 op = DW_OP_deref;
18845 else
18846 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
18848 if (ret)
18849 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18850 else
18851 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
18853 if (ret)
18854 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, 0, NULL, 0, NULL);
18856 return list_ret;
18859 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
18860 expressions. */
18862 static dw_loc_list_ref
18863 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18864 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18866 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
18868 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
18869 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
18870 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
18871 return result;
18874 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
18875 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18876 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
18877 struct loc_descr_context *context)
18879 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
18880 if (!ret)
18881 return NULL;
18882 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
18884 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
18885 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
18886 return NULL;
18888 return ret->expr;
18891 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
18892 which is not less than the value itself. */
18894 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
18895 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
18897 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
18900 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
18901 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
18902 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
18903 ERROR_MARK node. */
18905 static inline tree
18906 field_type (const_tree decl)
18908 tree type;
18910 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
18911 return integer_type_node;
18913 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18914 if (type == NULL_TREE)
18915 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18917 return type;
18920 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
18921 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
18922 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
18924 static inline unsigned
18925 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
18927 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18930 static inline unsigned
18931 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
18933 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
18936 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
18938 static inline offset_int
18939 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
18941 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
18944 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
18945 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
18946 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
18947 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
18949 static dw_loc_descr_ref
18950 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
18952 tree tree_size;
18953 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
18955 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
18956 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
18957 if (*cst_size != -1)
18958 return NULL;
18960 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
18961 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
18962 ctx.dpi = NULL;
18963 ctx.placeholder_arg = false;
18964 ctx.placeholder_seen = false;
18966 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
18967 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
18968 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
18969 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
18970 : NULL);
18973 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
18974 struct vlr_context
18976 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
18977 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
18978 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
18979 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
18980 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
18981 tree struct_type;
18982 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
18983 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
18984 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
18985 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
18986 tree variant_part_offset;
18989 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
18990 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
18991 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
18992 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
18994 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
18995 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
18996 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
18998 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
19000 static dw_loc_descr_ref
19001 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
19002 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
19004 tree tree_result;
19005 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
19007 *cst_offset = 0;
19009 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
19010 return NULL;
19011 else
19012 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
19014 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
19015 case. */
19016 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
19017 return NULL;
19019 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
19020 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
19021 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
19022 matter. */
19023 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
19024 && TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) == INTEGER_CST)
19026 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
19027 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
19028 offset_int bitpos_int;
19029 tree type;
19030 tree field_size_tree;
19031 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
19032 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
19033 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
19034 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
19035 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
19037 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
19038 type = field_type (decl);
19039 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
19040 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
19042 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
19044 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
19045 a flexible array member. */
19046 if (!field_size_tree)
19047 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
19049 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
19050 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
19051 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
19052 else
19053 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
19055 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
19057 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
19058 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
19059 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
19060 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
19061 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
19062 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
19063 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
19064 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
19065 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
19067 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
19069 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
19070 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
19071 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
19072 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
19073 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
19074 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
19075 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
19076 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
19077 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
19078 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
19079 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
19081 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
19082 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
19083 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
19084 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
19085 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
19086 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
19087 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
19088 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
19089 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
19090 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
19091 structure type.)
19093 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
19094 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
19095 must have believed that the containing object started (within
19096 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
19097 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
19098 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
19099 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
19101 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
19102 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
19103 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
19105 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
19106 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
19107 be. */
19108 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
19110 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
19111 bitfields. */
19112 object_offset_in_bits
19113 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
19115 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
19117 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
19119 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
19120 object_offset_in_bits
19121 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
19124 object_offset_in_bytes
19125 = wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
19126 if (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE)
19128 *cst_offset = object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
19129 return NULL;
19131 tree_result = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, object_offset_in_bytes);
19133 else
19134 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
19135 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
19137 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
19138 tree_result = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
19139 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result);
19141 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
19142 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
19143 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
19145 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
19146 return NULL;
19148 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
19149 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
19150 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
19151 NULL, /* dpi */
19152 false, /* placeholder_arg */
19153 false /* placeholder_seen */
19155 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
19157 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
19158 multiple elements. */
19159 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
19160 return NULL;
19161 else
19162 return loc_result->expr;
19165 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
19166 associated with them. */
19168 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
19170 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
19171 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
19172 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
19174 static inline void
19175 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
19176 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
19178 bool check_no_locviews = true;
19179 if (descr == 0)
19180 return;
19181 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
19182 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
19183 else
19185 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
19186 gcc_assert (descr->ll_symbol);
19187 if (attr_kind == DW_AT_location && descr->vl_symbol
19188 && dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ())
19190 add_AT_view_list (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
19191 check_no_locviews = false;
19195 if (check_no_locviews)
19196 gcc_assert (!get_AT (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews));
19199 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
19201 static void
19202 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
19204 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
19205 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
19206 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
19207 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
19208 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
19209 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
19211 if (dwarf_version == 2
19212 || die->die_parent == NULL
19213 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
19214 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
19216 else if (dwarf_version > 2
19217 && die->die_parent
19218 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
19219 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
19222 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
19223 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
19224 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
19225 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
19226 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
19227 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
19228 function above).
19230 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
19231 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
19232 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
19233 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
19234 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
19235 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
19236 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
19237 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
19238 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
19239 function below.)
19241 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
19243 static void
19244 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
19245 tree decl,
19246 struct vlr_context *ctx)
19248 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
19249 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
19251 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
19253 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
19254 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
19256 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
19257 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
19258 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
19259 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
19261 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
19263 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
19265 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
19267 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
19268 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
19269 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19271 /* Extract the vtable address. */
19272 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
19273 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19275 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
19276 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
19277 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
19279 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
19280 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19281 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
19282 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19284 /* Extract the offset. */
19285 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
19286 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19288 /* Add it to the object address. */
19289 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
19290 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
19292 else
19293 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
19295 else
19297 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
19299 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
19300 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
19301 moment. */
19302 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
19304 loc_descr = NULL;
19305 offset = 0;
19308 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
19309 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
19310 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
19311 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
19314 if (! loc_descr)
19316 /* While DW_AT_data_bit_offset has been added already in DWARF4,
19317 e.g. GDB only added support to it in November 2016. For DWARF5
19318 we need newer debug info consumers anyway. We might change this
19319 to dwarf_version >= 4 once most consumers catched up. */
19320 if (dwarf_version >= 5
19321 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
19322 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
19324 tree off = bit_position (decl);
19325 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (off) && get_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_size))
19327 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_byte_size);
19328 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_bit_offset);
19329 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_bit_offset, tree_to_uhwi (off));
19330 return;
19333 if (dwarf_version > 2)
19335 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
19336 if (offset < 0)
19337 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
19338 else
19339 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
19340 return;
19342 else
19344 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
19346 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
19347 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
19348 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
19349 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
19350 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
19354 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
19357 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
19359 static void
19360 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
19362 while (size != 0)
19364 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
19365 val >>= 8;
19366 --size;
19370 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
19372 static HOST_WIDE_INT
19373 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
19375 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
19377 src += size;
19378 while (size != 0)
19380 val <<= 8;
19381 val |= *--src & 0xff;
19382 --size;
19384 return val;
19387 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
19389 static void
19390 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
19392 int i;
19394 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
19396 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
19397 return;
19400 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
19401 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
19403 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
19405 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
19406 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
19408 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
19409 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
19411 else
19412 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
19414 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
19415 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
19419 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
19421 static void
19422 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
19424 long val[4];
19425 int i;
19426 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
19428 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), mode);
19430 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
19431 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4; i++)
19433 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
19434 array += 4;
19438 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
19439 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
19440 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
19441 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
19442 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
19444 static bool
19445 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
19447 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
19449 case CONST_INT:
19451 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
19453 if (val < 0)
19454 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
19455 else
19456 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
19458 return true;
19460 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
19462 wide_int w1 = rtx_mode_t (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
19463 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
19464 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
19465 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
19466 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
19468 return true;
19470 case CONST_DOUBLE:
19471 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
19472 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
19473 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
19474 represented. */
19475 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
19476 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (rtl)))
19477 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
19478 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
19479 else
19481 scalar_float_mode mode = as_a <scalar_float_mode> (GET_MODE (rtl));
19482 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
19483 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
19485 insert_float (rtl, array);
19486 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
19488 return true;
19490 case CONST_VECTOR:
19492 unsigned int length;
19493 if (!CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl).is_constant (&length))
19494 return false;
19496 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
19497 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
19498 unsigned char *array
19499 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
19500 unsigned int i;
19501 unsigned char *p;
19502 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
19504 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
19506 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
19507 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
19509 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
19510 insert_wide_int (rtx_mode_t (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
19512 break;
19514 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
19515 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
19517 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
19518 insert_float (elt, p);
19520 break;
19522 default:
19523 gcc_unreachable ();
19526 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
19528 return true;
19530 case CONST_STRING:
19531 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19533 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
19534 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
19535 rtl_addr:
19536 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
19537 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
19538 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
19539 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
19540 return true;
19542 return false;
19544 case CONST:
19545 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19546 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
19547 /* FALLTHROUGH */
19548 case SYMBOL_REF:
19549 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
19550 return false;
19551 /* FALLTHROUGH */
19552 case LABEL_REF:
19553 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19554 goto rtl_addr;
19555 return false;
19557 case PLUS:
19558 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
19559 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
19560 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
19561 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
19562 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
19563 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
19564 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
19565 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
19566 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
19567 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
19568 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
19569 return false;
19571 case HIGH:
19572 case CONST_FIXED:
19573 return false;
19575 case MEM:
19576 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
19577 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
19578 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
19580 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
19581 return true;
19583 return false;
19585 default:
19586 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
19587 gcc_unreachable ();
19589 return false;
19592 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
19593 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
19594 output). */
19595 static tree
19596 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
19597 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
19599 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
19600 *walk_subtrees = 0;
19602 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
19603 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
19604 return *tp;
19605 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
19606 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
19607 be conservative. */
19608 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (*tp))
19609 return *tp;
19610 else if (VAR_P (*tp))
19612 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
19613 if (!node || !node->definition)
19614 return *tp;
19616 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
19617 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
19619 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
19620 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
19621 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
19622 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
19623 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
19624 return *tp;
19626 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
19627 return *tp;
19629 return NULL_TREE;
19632 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
19633 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
19635 static rtx
19636 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
19638 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
19640 STRIP_NOPS (init);
19642 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
19643 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
19644 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19646 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
19647 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
19648 scalar_int_mode mode;
19650 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
19651 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
19652 && domain
19653 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
19654 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)) == INTEGER_CST
19655 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
19656 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
19657 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
19658 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
19659 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
19661 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
19662 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
19663 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
19664 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
19667 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
19668 CONCAT: FIXME! */
19669 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
19670 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
19671 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
19672 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
19674 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
19675 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
19676 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
19677 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
19679 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
19680 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
19681 reference variables which won't be output. */
19682 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
19683 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
19685 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
19686 possible. */
19687 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19688 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
19690 case VECTOR_CST:
19691 break;
19692 case CONSTRUCTOR:
19693 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
19695 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
19696 bool constant_p = true;
19697 tree value;
19698 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
19700 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
19701 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
19702 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
19703 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
19704 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
19706 constant_p = false;
19707 break;
19710 if (constant_p)
19712 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
19713 break;
19716 /* FALLTHRU */
19718 default:
19719 return NULL;
19722 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
19724 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
19725 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
19728 return rtl;
19731 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
19733 static rtx
19734 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
19736 rtx rtl;
19738 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
19739 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
19740 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
19742 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
19743 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
19744 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
19745 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
19746 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
19747 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
19748 referenced within the function.
19750 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
19751 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
19752 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
19753 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
19755 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
19756 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
19757 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
19758 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
19759 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
19760 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
19762 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
19763 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
19764 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
19765 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
19766 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
19767 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
19768 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
19769 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
19770 output at debug-time.
19772 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
19773 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
19774 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
19775 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19776 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
19777 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
19778 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
19779 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
19780 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
19781 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
19782 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
19783 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
19784 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
19786 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
19787 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
19788 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
19789 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
19790 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
19791 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
19792 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
19793 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
19794 I'd like to fix it.
19796 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
19797 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
19798 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
19799 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
19800 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
19801 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
19802 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
19803 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
19804 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
19805 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
19806 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
19808 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
19809 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19811 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
19812 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
19813 fixed registers. */
19814 if (! reload_completed)
19816 if (rtl
19817 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
19818 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19819 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
19820 || (REG_P (rtl)
19821 && VAR_P (decl)
19822 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
19824 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19825 return rtl;
19827 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19829 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
19831 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19832 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
19833 || (MEM_P (rtl)
19834 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19835 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
19836 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19837 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
19839 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19840 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
19841 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
19842 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
19844 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
19845 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
19846 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
19847 if (dmode == pmode)
19848 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19849 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
19850 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
19851 && known_le (GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode), GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode))
19852 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19854 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
19855 if (REG_P (inc))
19856 rtl = inc;
19857 else if (MEM_P (inc))
19859 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
19860 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
19861 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
19862 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
19863 else
19864 rtl = inc;
19869 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
19870 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
19871 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
19872 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
19873 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
19874 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
19875 thing to do. */
19876 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
19877 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
19878 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19879 /* Not passed in memory. */
19880 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
19881 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
19882 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
19883 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
19884 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
19885 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
19886 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
19887 #endif
19889 /* Big endian correction check. */
19890 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
19891 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
19892 && known_lt (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))),
19893 UNITS_PER_WORD))
19895 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19896 poly_int64 offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
19897 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
19899 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19900 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19903 else if (VAR_P (decl)
19904 && rtl
19905 && MEM_P (rtl)
19906 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19908 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
19909 poly_int64 offset = byte_lowpart_offset (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19910 GET_MODE (rtl));
19912 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
19913 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
19914 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
19915 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
19916 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
19917 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
19918 if (maybe_ne (offset, 0))
19919 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19920 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
19923 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
19924 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
19925 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
19926 if (!rtl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19927 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
19929 if (rtl)
19930 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
19932 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
19933 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
19934 code, and thus is not emitted. */
19935 if (rtl)
19936 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
19938 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
19939 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
19940 it. */
19941 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
19942 && !(early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
19943 && VAR_P (decl)
19944 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
19945 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
19946 && DECL_NAME (decl)
19947 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
19948 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
19950 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
19951 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
19952 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
19953 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
19954 rtl = NULL_RTX;
19957 return rtl;
19960 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
19961 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
19962 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
19964 static tree
19965 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
19967 tree val_expr, cvar;
19968 machine_mode mode;
19969 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
19970 tree offset;
19971 HOST_WIDE_INT cbitpos;
19972 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
19974 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
19975 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
19976 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
19977 be handled as such. */
19978 if (!VAR_P (decl)
19979 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
19980 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
19981 || !is_fortran ())
19982 return NULL_TREE;
19984 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
19985 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
19986 return NULL_TREE;
19988 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
19989 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
19991 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
19992 || !VAR_P (cvar)
19993 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
19994 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar)
19995 /* We don't expect to have to cope with variable offsets,
19996 since at present all static data must have a constant size. */
19997 || !bitpos.is_constant (&cbitpos))
19998 return NULL_TREE;
20000 *value = 0;
20001 if (offset != NULL)
20003 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
20004 return NULL_TREE;
20005 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
20007 if (cbitpos != 0)
20008 *value += cbitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
20010 return cvar;
20013 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
20014 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
20015 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
20016 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
20017 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
20018 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
20019 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
20020 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
20021 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
20022 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
20024 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
20025 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
20026 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
20027 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
20029 static bool
20030 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
20032 rtx rtl;
20033 dw_loc_list_ref list;
20034 var_loc_list *loc_list;
20035 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
20037 if (early_dwarf)
20038 return false;
20040 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
20041 return false;
20043 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
20044 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
20045 return true;
20047 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
20048 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
20050 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
20051 the location. */
20053 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
20054 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20055 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
20056 return true;
20058 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
20059 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
20060 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
20061 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
20062 if (loc_list
20063 && loc_list->first
20064 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
20065 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
20066 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
20067 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
20069 struct var_loc_node *node;
20071 node = loc_list->first;
20072 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
20073 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
20074 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
20075 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20076 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
20077 return true;
20079 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
20080 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
20081 list = NULL;
20082 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
20083 cache_p = false;
20084 if (cache_p)
20086 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
20087 if (cache)
20088 list = cache->loc_list;
20090 if (list == NULL)
20092 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
20093 NULL);
20094 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
20095 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
20096 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
20098 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
20099 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
20100 DECL_UID (decl),
20101 INSERT);
20102 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
20103 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
20104 cache->loc_list = list;
20105 *slot = cache;
20108 if (list)
20110 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
20111 return true;
20113 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
20114 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
20115 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
20118 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
20119 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
20121 static bool
20122 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
20124 tree type;
20126 if (init == NULL_TREE)
20127 return false;
20129 STRIP_NOPS (init);
20130 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
20132 case STRING_CST:
20133 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
20134 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20136 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
20137 scalar_int_mode mode;
20139 if (!is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (enttype), &mode)
20140 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
20141 return false;
20142 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20143 return false;
20144 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
20146 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
20147 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
20148 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
20149 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
20151 else
20152 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
20153 return true;
20155 return false;
20156 case CONSTRUCTOR:
20157 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
20158 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20159 return false;
20160 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
20162 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
20163 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
20164 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
20165 constructor_elt *ce;
20167 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
20168 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
20169 return false;
20171 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
20172 if (fieldsize <= 0)
20173 return false;
20175 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
20176 memset (array, '\0', size);
20177 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
20179 tree val = ce->value;
20180 tree index = ce->index;
20181 int pos = curpos;
20182 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
20183 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
20184 * fieldsize;
20185 else if (index)
20186 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
20188 if (val)
20190 STRIP_NOPS (val);
20191 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
20192 return false;
20194 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
20195 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
20197 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
20198 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
20199 while (count-- > 0)
20201 if (val)
20202 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
20203 curpos += fieldsize;
20206 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
20208 return true;
20210 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
20211 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
20213 tree field = NULL_TREE;
20214 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
20215 constructor_elt *ce;
20217 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
20218 return false;
20220 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
20221 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
20223 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
20225 tree val = ce->value;
20226 int pos, fieldsize;
20228 if (ce->index != 0)
20229 field = ce->index;
20231 if (val)
20232 STRIP_NOPS (val);
20234 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
20235 return false;
20237 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
20238 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
20239 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
20240 return false;
20241 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
20242 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
20243 return false;
20244 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
20245 pos = int_byte_position (field);
20246 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
20247 if (val && fieldsize != 0
20248 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
20249 return false;
20251 return true;
20253 return false;
20254 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20255 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
20256 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
20257 default:
20258 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
20262 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
20263 attribute is the const value T. */
20265 static bool
20266 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
20268 tree init;
20269 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
20270 rtx rtl;
20272 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
20273 return false;
20275 init = t;
20276 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
20278 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST)
20280 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (init))
20282 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_uhwi (init));
20283 return true;
20285 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (init))
20287 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, tree_to_shwi (init));
20288 return true;
20291 if (! early_dwarf)
20293 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
20294 if (rtl)
20295 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
20297 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
20298 if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
20299 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
20301 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
20302 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
20304 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
20306 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
20308 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
20309 return true;
20311 ggc_free (array);
20314 return false;
20317 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
20318 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
20319 variable with static storage duration
20320 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
20322 static bool
20323 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
20326 if (!decl
20327 || (!VAR_P (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
20328 || (VAR_P (decl) && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
20329 return false;
20331 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
20332 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
20333 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
20334 /* OK */;
20335 else
20336 return false;
20338 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
20339 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
20340 return false;
20342 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
20345 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
20346 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
20347 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
20348 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
20349 expressions. */
20351 static dw_loc_list_ref
20352 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
20354 int ix;
20355 dw_fde_ref fde;
20356 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
20357 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
20358 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
20359 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
20360 dw_cfa_location remember;
20362 fde = cfun->fde;
20363 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
20365 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
20366 list_tail = &list;
20367 list = NULL;
20369 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
20370 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
20371 remember = next_cfa;
20373 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
20375 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
20376 advance opcodes. */
20377 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
20378 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
20380 last_cfa = next_cfa;
20381 last_label = start_label;
20383 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
20385 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
20386 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
20387 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20388 fde->dw_fde_begin, 0, fde->dw_fde_end, 0, section);
20389 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20390 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
20393 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
20395 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
20397 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
20398 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
20399 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
20400 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
20401 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20403 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20404 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20406 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20407 last_cfa = next_cfa;
20408 start_label = last_label;
20410 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
20411 break;
20413 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
20414 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
20415 gcc_unreachable ();
20417 default:
20418 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
20419 break;
20421 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
20423 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20425 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20426 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20428 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20429 last_cfa = next_cfa;
20430 start_label = last_label;
20432 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20433 start_label, 0, fde->dw_fde_end, 0, section);
20434 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20435 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
20439 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
20441 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
20442 start_label, 0, last_label, 0, section);
20443 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
20444 start_label = last_label;
20447 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
20448 start_label, 0,
20449 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
20450 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end, 0,
20451 section);
20453 maybe_gen_llsym (list);
20455 return list;
20458 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
20459 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
20460 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
20461 before the latter is negated. */
20463 static void
20464 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (poly_int64 offset)
20466 rtx reg, elim;
20468 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
20469 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
20470 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
20471 #else
20472 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
20473 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
20474 #endif
20476 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
20477 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
20478 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
20479 elim = strip_offset_and_add (elim, &offset);
20481 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
20483 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
20484 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
20485 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
20486 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
20487 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
20488 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
20489 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
20490 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
20491 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
20492 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
20493 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
20494 : stack_pointer_rtx));
20497 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
20498 the value of the attribute. */
20500 static void
20501 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
20503 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
20505 if (demangle_name_func)
20506 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
20508 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
20512 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
20513 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
20514 of TYPE accordingly.
20516 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
20517 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
20519 static void
20520 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
20521 dw_die_ref context_die)
20523 tree dtype;
20524 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
20526 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
20527 return;
20529 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
20530 if (!dtype)
20531 return;
20533 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
20534 if (!dtype_die)
20536 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
20537 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
20538 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
20541 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
20544 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
20546 static const char *
20547 comp_dir_string (void)
20549 const char *wd;
20550 char *wd1;
20551 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
20553 if (cached_wd != NULL)
20554 return cached_wd;
20556 wd = get_src_pwd ();
20557 if (wd == NULL)
20558 return NULL;
20560 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
20562 int wdlen;
20564 wdlen = strlen (wd);
20565 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
20566 strcpy (wd1, wd);
20567 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
20568 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
20569 wd = wd1;
20572 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
20573 return cached_wd;
20576 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
20578 static void
20579 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
20581 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
20582 if (wd != NULL)
20583 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
20586 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
20587 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
20588 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
20589 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
20591 static void
20592 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
20593 int forms, struct loc_descr_context *context)
20595 dw_die_ref context_die, decl_die;
20596 dw_loc_list_ref list;
20597 bool strip_conversions = true;
20598 bool placeholder_seen = false;
20600 while (strip_conversions)
20601 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
20603 case ERROR_MARK:
20604 case SAVE_EXPR:
20605 return;
20607 CASE_CONVERT:
20608 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20609 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
20610 break;
20612 default:
20613 strip_conversions = false;
20614 break;
20617 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
20618 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
20619 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
20621 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
20623 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
20624 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
20625 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
20626 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
20627 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
20628 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
20629 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
20630 for signed types. This is needed only for
20631 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
20632 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
20633 regardless of the underlying type. */
20634 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
20635 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
20637 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
20638 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
20639 else
20640 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
20642 else
20643 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
20644 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
20645 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
20646 unambiguously. */
20647 add_AT_wide (die, attr, wi::to_wide (value));
20648 return;
20651 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
20652 another DIE. */
20653 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
20655 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
20657 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
20658 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
20659 Ada). */
20660 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
20661 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
20662 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
20663 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
20665 else if (VAR_P (value)
20666 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
20667 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
20668 decl = value;
20670 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
20672 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20674 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
20675 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
20676 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
20677 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
20678 later parameter. */
20679 if (decl_die != NULL)
20681 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20682 return;
20687 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
20688 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
20689 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
20690 return;
20692 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
20693 if (context && context->placeholder_arg)
20695 placeholder_seen = context->placeholder_seen;
20696 context->placeholder_seen = false;
20698 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
20700 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
20701 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
20702 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
20703 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
20704 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
20706 if (placeholder_seen)
20708 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
20709 dpi.fndecl = NULL_TREE;
20710 dpi.args_count = 1;
20711 if (!resolve_args_picking (list2->expr, 1, &dpi))
20712 return;
20714 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
20715 return;
20719 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
20720 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
20721 if (list == NULL
20722 || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0
20723 || placeholder_seen)
20724 return;
20726 if (current_function_decl == 0)
20727 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
20728 else
20729 context_die = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
20731 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, value);
20732 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20733 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false,
20734 context_die);
20735 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
20736 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
20739 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
20740 default. */
20742 static int
20743 lower_bound_default (void)
20745 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
20747 case DW_LANG_C:
20748 case DW_LANG_C89:
20749 case DW_LANG_C99:
20750 case DW_LANG_C11:
20751 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
20752 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
20753 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
20754 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
20755 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
20756 return 0;
20757 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
20758 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
20759 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
20760 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
20761 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
20762 return 1;
20763 case DW_LANG_UPC:
20764 case DW_LANG_D:
20765 case DW_LANG_Python:
20766 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
20767 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
20768 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
20769 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
20770 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
20771 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
20772 case DW_LANG_PLI:
20773 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
20774 default:
20775 return -1;
20779 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
20780 a representation for that bound. */
20782 static void
20783 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
20784 tree bound, struct loc_descr_context *context)
20786 int dflt;
20788 while (1)
20789 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
20791 /* Strip all conversions. */
20792 CASE_CONVERT:
20793 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
20794 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
20795 break;
20797 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
20798 are even omitted when they are the default. */
20799 case INTEGER_CST:
20800 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
20801 attribute. */
20802 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
20803 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
20804 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
20805 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
20806 return;
20808 /* FALLTHRU */
20810 default:
20811 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
20812 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
20813 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
20814 magic in such a case. */
20815 if (is_ada ()
20816 && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20817 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
20818 return;
20820 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
20821 dw_scalar_form_constant
20822 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
20823 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
20824 context);
20825 return;
20829 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
20830 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
20831 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
20832 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
20834 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
20835 available. */
20837 static void
20838 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
20840 unsigned dimension_number;
20841 tree lower, upper;
20842 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
20844 for (dimension_number = 0;
20845 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
20846 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
20848 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
20850 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
20851 break;
20853 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
20854 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
20855 here. */
20857 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
20858 available.
20860 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
20861 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
20862 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
20863 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
20864 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
20865 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
20866 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
20867 array. */
20868 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
20869 if (child)
20870 while (1)
20872 child = child->die_sib;
20873 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20874 subrange_die = child;
20875 if (child == type_die->die_child)
20877 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
20878 child = NULL;
20879 break;
20881 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
20882 break;
20884 if (!subrange_die)
20885 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
20887 if (domain)
20889 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
20890 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
20891 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
20893 /* Define the index type. */
20894 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
20895 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
20897 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
20898 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
20899 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
20900 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
20901 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
20902 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
20903 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
20905 else
20906 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
20907 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, type_die);
20910 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
20911 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
20912 dimension arr(N:*)
20913 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
20914 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
20915 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
20917 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
20918 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
20919 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
20920 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
20923 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
20924 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
20925 bounds. */
20929 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
20931 static void
20932 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20934 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20935 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
20936 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
20938 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
20940 case ERROR_MARK:
20941 size = 0;
20942 break;
20943 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20944 case RECORD_TYPE:
20945 case UNION_TYPE:
20946 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20947 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
20948 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
20950 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
20951 return;
20953 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
20954 break;
20955 case FIELD_DECL:
20956 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
20957 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
20958 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
20959 even for bit-fields. */
20960 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
20961 break;
20962 default:
20963 gcc_unreachable ();
20966 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
20967 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
20968 though. */
20969 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20970 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
20971 && size_expr != NULL)
20972 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
20974 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
20975 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
20976 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
20977 if (size >= 0)
20978 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
20981 /* Add a DW_AT_alignment attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's non-default
20982 alignment. */
20984 static void
20985 add_alignment_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
20987 if (dwarf_version < 5 && dwarf_strict)
20988 return;
20990 unsigned align;
20992 if (DECL_P (tree_node))
20994 if (!DECL_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
20995 return;
20997 align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
20999 else if (TYPE_P (tree_node))
21001 if (!TYPE_USER_ALIGN (tree_node))
21002 return;
21004 align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (tree_node);
21006 else
21007 gcc_unreachable ();
21009 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_alignment, align);
21012 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
21013 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
21014 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
21015 bit-field itself.
21017 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
21018 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
21019 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
21020 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
21021 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
21022 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
21024 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
21026 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
21027 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
21028 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
21030 static inline void
21031 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
21033 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
21034 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
21035 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
21036 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
21037 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
21038 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
21040 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
21042 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
21043 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
21045 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
21046 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
21047 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
21048 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
21049 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
21050 return;
21052 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
21054 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
21055 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
21056 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
21057 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
21058 below must take account of these differences. */
21059 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
21060 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
21062 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
21064 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
21065 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
21066 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
21069 bit_offset
21070 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
21071 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
21072 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
21074 if (bit_offset < 0)
21075 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
21076 else
21077 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
21080 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
21081 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
21083 static inline void
21084 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21086 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
21087 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
21088 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
21090 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
21091 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
21094 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
21095 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
21097 static inline void
21098 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
21100 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
21102 case DW_LANG_C:
21103 case DW_LANG_C89:
21104 case DW_LANG_C99:
21105 case DW_LANG_C11:
21106 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
21107 if (prototype_p (func_type))
21108 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
21109 break;
21110 default:
21111 break;
21115 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
21116 by looking in the type declaration, the object declaration equate table or
21117 the block mapping. */
21119 static inline dw_die_ref
21120 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
21122 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
21124 if (DECL_P (origin))
21126 dw_die_ref c;
21127 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
21128 /* "Unwrap" the decls DIE which we put in the imported unit context.
21129 We are looking for the abstract copy here. */
21130 if (in_lto_p
21131 && origin_die
21132 && (c = get_AT_ref (origin_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
21133 /* ??? Identify this better. */
21134 && c->with_offset)
21135 origin_die = c;
21137 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
21138 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
21139 else if (TREE_CODE (origin) == BLOCK)
21140 origin_die = BLOCK_DIE (origin);
21142 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
21143 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
21144 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
21145 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
21146 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
21147 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
21148 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
21149 here. */
21151 if (origin_die)
21152 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
21153 return origin_die;
21156 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
21158 static inline void
21159 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
21161 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
21163 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
21165 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
21166 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
21167 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
21168 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
21169 0));
21171 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
21172 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
21173 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
21174 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21175 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
21179 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
21180 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
21181 standardized it. */
21183 static void
21184 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21186 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
21188 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
21189 if (name[0] == '*')
21190 name = &name[1];
21192 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
21193 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
21194 else
21195 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
21198 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
21200 static void
21201 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21203 expanded_location s;
21205 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
21206 return;
21207 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21208 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
21209 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
21210 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
21211 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
21214 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
21216 static void
21217 add_linkage_name_raw (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21219 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
21220 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
21222 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
21224 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
21225 asm_name->die = die;
21226 asm_name->created_for = decl;
21227 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
21228 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
21230 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
21231 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
21234 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl if desired. */
21236 static void
21237 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
21239 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
21240 && VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
21241 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
21242 && !(VAR_P (decl) && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
21243 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
21244 add_linkage_name_raw (die, decl);
21247 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
21248 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
21250 static void
21251 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
21252 bool no_linkage_name)
21254 tree decl_name;
21256 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
21257 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
21259 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
21260 if (name)
21261 add_name_attribute (die, name);
21262 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21263 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
21265 if (!no_linkage_name)
21266 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
21269 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
21270 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
21271 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
21272 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
21274 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
21275 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
21276 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
21278 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21281 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
21283 static void
21284 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
21286 dw_attr_node attr;
21288 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
21289 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
21290 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
21291 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
21292 if (value->pos)
21293 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
21294 else
21295 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
21296 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
21299 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
21301 static void
21302 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
21304 dw_attr_node attr;
21306 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
21307 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
21308 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
21309 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
21310 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
21313 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
21314 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
21316 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
21319 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
21320 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
21322 void
21323 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
21325 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21326 dw_die_ref die;
21328 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
21329 die = new_die_raw (DW_TAG_subprogram);
21330 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
21331 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
21332 current_function_funcdef_no);
21333 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
21335 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
21336 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
21337 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
21339 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
21340 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
21342 else
21344 die->die_sib = die;
21345 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
21348 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21350 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
21352 static void
21353 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
21355 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
21358 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
21360 static inline void
21361 pop_decl_scope (void)
21363 decl_scope_table->pop ();
21366 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
21368 static tree
21369 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
21371 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
21372 *walk_subtrees = 0;
21373 else
21375 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
21376 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
21377 return *tp;
21379 return NULL_TREE;
21382 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
21383 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
21385 static tree
21386 uses_local_type (tree type)
21388 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
21389 return used;
21392 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
21393 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
21394 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
21395 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
21396 the current active scope. */
21398 static dw_die_ref
21399 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
21401 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
21402 tree containing_scope;
21404 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
21405 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
21407 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
21408 it refers to. */
21409 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
21410 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
21411 else
21412 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
21414 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
21415 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
21417 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
21418 /* OK */;
21419 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21420 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
21421 else
21422 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
21425 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
21426 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
21427 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
21428 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
21429 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
21431 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
21433 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
21434 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
21435 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
21436 scope_die = context_die;
21437 else
21438 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
21440 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
21442 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
21443 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21444 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
21445 else
21447 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
21448 if (scope_die == NULL)
21449 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
21452 else
21453 scope_die = context_die;
21455 return scope_die;
21458 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
21460 static inline int
21461 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21463 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
21464 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
21465 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21466 return 1;
21468 return 0;
21471 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
21473 static inline int
21474 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21476 return (context_die
21477 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
21478 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
21479 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
21480 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
21483 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
21484 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
21486 static inline int
21487 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
21489 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
21490 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
21493 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
21494 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
21495 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
21496 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
21498 static void
21499 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
21500 bool reverse, dw_die_ref context_die)
21502 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
21503 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
21505 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
21506 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
21507 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
21508 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
21509 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
21510 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
21511 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
21513 if (code == ERROR_MARK
21514 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
21515 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
21516 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
21517 || code == VOID_TYPE)
21518 return;
21520 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
21521 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS (type),
21522 reverse,
21523 context_die);
21525 if (type_die != NULL)
21526 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
21529 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
21530 function call type. */
21531 static void
21532 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
21534 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
21536 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
21537 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
21539 if (is_fortran ()
21540 && id_equal (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl), "MAIN__"))
21542 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
21543 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
21544 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
21545 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
21546 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
21547 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
21548 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
21549 value = DW_CC_program;
21551 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21552 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
21555 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
21556 is not DW_CC_normal. */
21557 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
21558 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
21561 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
21562 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
21563 was declared without a tag. */
21565 static const char *
21566 type_tag (const_tree type)
21568 const char *name = 0;
21570 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
21572 tree t = 0;
21574 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
21575 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
21576 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
21577 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
21579 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
21580 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
21581 involved. */
21582 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
21583 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21585 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
21586 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
21587 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
21588 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
21589 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
21590 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21591 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
21594 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
21595 if (!name && t != 0)
21596 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
21599 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
21602 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
21603 for bit field types. */
21605 static inline tree
21606 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
21608 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
21609 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
21612 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
21613 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
21615 #if 0
21616 static const char *
21617 decl_start_label (tree decl)
21619 rtx x;
21620 const char *fnname;
21622 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
21623 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
21625 x = XEXP (x, 0);
21626 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
21628 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
21629 return fnname;
21631 #endif
21633 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
21634 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
21635 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
21636 static bool
21637 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
21639 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
21640 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21641 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
21643 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21644 if (!array_die)
21645 return false;
21646 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
21647 return true;
21649 return false;
21652 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
21653 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
21654 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
21656 static void
21657 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21659 dw_die_ref array_die;
21661 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
21662 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
21663 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
21664 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
21665 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
21666 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
21667 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
21668 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
21669 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
21671 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
21673 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
21674 return;
21676 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21677 tree element_type;
21679 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
21680 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
21681 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
21682 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21683 && is_fortran ()
21684 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
21686 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
21688 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
21689 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21690 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21691 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
21692 if (size >= 0)
21693 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21694 /* ??? We can't annotate types late, but for LTO we may not
21695 generate a location early either (gfortran.dg/save_6.f90). */
21696 else if (! (early_dwarf && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
21697 && TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
21698 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE)
21700 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
21701 tree rszdecl = szdecl;
21703 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
21704 if (!DECL_P (szdecl))
21706 if (TREE_CODE (szdecl) == INDIRECT_REF
21707 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0)))
21709 rszdecl = TREE_OPERAND (szdecl, 0);
21710 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (rszdecl))
21711 != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21712 size = 0;
21714 else
21715 size = 0;
21717 if (size > 0)
21719 dw_loc_list_ref loc
21720 = loc_list_from_tree (rszdecl, szdecl == rszdecl ? 2 : 0,
21721 NULL);
21722 if (loc)
21724 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length,
21725 loc);
21726 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
21727 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, dwarf_version >= 5
21728 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
21729 : DW_AT_byte_size, size);
21733 return;
21736 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21737 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21738 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21740 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21741 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
21743 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
21744 if (is_fortran ()
21745 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21746 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
21747 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
21748 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21750 #if 0
21751 /* We default the array ordering. Debuggers will probably do the right
21752 things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even an issue
21753 until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If a debugger
21754 is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
21755 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
21756 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
21757 for multidimensional arrays. */
21758 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21759 #endif
21761 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
21763 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
21764 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
21765 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
21766 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21767 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
21769 else
21770 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
21772 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
21773 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
21774 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
21775 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
21776 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
21778 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
21779 break;
21780 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
21783 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21784 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21785 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21786 context_die);
21788 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21789 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
21790 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21792 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21793 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21795 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21798 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
21799 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
21801 static void
21802 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
21803 dw_die_ref context_die)
21805 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21806 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
21807 struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL,
21808 false, false };
21809 enum dwarf_tag subrange_tag = DW_TAG_subrange_type;
21810 int dim;
21812 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
21813 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
21815 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
21816 switch (info->ordering)
21818 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
21819 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
21820 break;
21821 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
21822 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
21823 break;
21824 default:
21825 break;
21828 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21830 if (info->data_location)
21831 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
21832 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21833 if (info->associated)
21834 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
21835 dw_scalar_form_constant
21836 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21837 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21838 if (info->allocated)
21839 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
21840 dw_scalar_form_constant
21841 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21842 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
21843 if (info->stride)
21845 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
21846 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
21847 const int forms
21848 = (info->stride_in_bits)
21849 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
21850 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
21851 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21852 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
21854 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
21857 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
21859 if (info->rank)
21861 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_rank, info->rank,
21862 dw_scalar_form_constant
21863 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
21864 subrange_tag = DW_TAG_generic_subrange;
21865 context.placeholder_arg = true;
21869 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
21871 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
21873 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (subrange_tag, array_die, NULL);
21875 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
21876 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
21877 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21878 false, context_die);
21879 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
21880 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
21881 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
21882 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
21883 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
21884 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
21885 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
21886 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
21887 info->dimen[dim].stride,
21888 dw_scalar_form_constant
21889 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
21890 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
21891 &context);
21894 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
21895 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21896 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
21897 && TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type),
21898 context_die);
21900 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
21901 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
21903 add_alignment_attribute (array_die, type);
21906 #if 0
21907 static void
21908 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21910 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21911 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
21913 if (origin != NULL)
21914 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
21915 else
21917 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21918 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
21919 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
21922 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21923 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21924 else
21925 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
21927 #endif
21929 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21930 emit full debugging info for them. */
21932 static void
21933 retry_incomplete_types (void)
21935 set_early_dwarf s;
21936 int i;
21938 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
21939 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21940 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
21941 vec_safe_truncate (incomplete_types, 0);
21944 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
21946 static enum dwarf_tag
21947 record_type_tag (tree type)
21949 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
21950 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21952 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
21954 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
21955 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21957 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
21958 return DW_TAG_class_type;
21960 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
21961 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21962 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
21963 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
21965 default:
21966 gcc_unreachable ();
21970 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
21971 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
21972 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
21973 DIE. */
21975 static dw_die_ref
21976 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21978 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21979 dw_die_ref orig_type_die = type_die;
21981 if (type_die == NULL)
21983 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
21984 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21985 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21986 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
21987 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
21988 && ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
21989 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
21990 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type) && TYPE_SIZE (type))
21991 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21992 if (!dwarf_strict)
21993 add_AT_unsigned (type_die, DW_AT_encoding,
21994 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
21995 ? DW_ATE_unsigned
21996 : DW_ATE_signed);
21998 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type) || ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
21999 return type_die;
22000 else
22001 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22003 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
22004 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
22005 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
22006 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
22008 tree link;
22010 if (!ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
22011 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22012 if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_byte_size))
22013 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
22014 if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_alignment))
22015 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
22016 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22017 && (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_type)))
22019 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
22020 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22021 context_die);
22023 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
22025 if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_decl_file))
22026 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22027 if (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_accessibility))
22028 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22031 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
22032 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
22033 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
22034 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
22036 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
22037 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
22039 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
22040 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
22042 gcc_assert (!ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type));
22043 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
22044 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
22046 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
22047 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
22049 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
22050 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
22052 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
22053 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
22054 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
22055 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
22056 form that can represent negative values. */
22057 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
22058 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
22059 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
22060 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
22061 else
22062 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
22064 else
22065 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
22066 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
22067 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
22068 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, wi::to_wide (value));
22071 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
22072 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type)
22073 && (!orig_type_die || !get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_artificial)))
22074 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22076 else
22077 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22079 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
22081 return type_die;
22084 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
22085 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
22086 type.
22088 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
22089 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
22090 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
22091 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
22092 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
22093 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
22094 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
22095 argument type of some subprogram type.
22096 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
22097 are emitted. */
22099 static dw_die_ref
22100 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
22101 dw_die_ref context_die)
22103 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
22104 tree ultimate_origin;
22105 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
22107 if (DECL_P (node_or_origin))
22109 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
22111 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
22112 thing.
22113 ??? When in LTO the DIE parent is the "abstract" copy and the
22114 context_die is the specification "copy". But this whole block
22115 should eventually be no longer needed. */
22116 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die && !in_lto_p)
22118 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
22120 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
22121 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
22122 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
22123 parm_die = NULL;
22125 else
22126 gcc_unreachable ();
22129 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
22131 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
22132 we would have added below. If any attributes are
22133 missing, fall through to add them. */
22134 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
22135 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
22136 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
22137 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
22139 else
22141 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
22142 return parm_die;
22147 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
22148 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
22149 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
22150 bool reusing_die;
22151 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
22152 reusing_die = true;
22153 else
22155 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
22156 reusing_die = false;
22159 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
22161 case tcc_declaration:
22162 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
22163 if (node || ultimate_origin)
22164 origin = ultimate_origin;
22166 if (reusing_die)
22167 goto add_location;
22169 if (origin != NULL)
22170 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
22171 else if (emit_name_p)
22172 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
22173 if (origin == NULL
22174 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
22175 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
22176 decl_function_context
22177 (node_or_origin))))
22179 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
22180 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
22181 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
22182 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
22183 false, context_die);
22184 else
22185 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
22186 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
22187 false, context_die);
22189 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
22190 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22191 add_location:
22192 if (node && node != origin)
22193 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
22194 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
22195 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
22196 node == NULL);
22198 break;
22200 case tcc_type:
22201 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
22202 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
22203 context_die);
22204 break;
22206 default:
22207 gcc_unreachable ();
22210 return parm_die;
22213 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
22214 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
22215 parameter pack.
22217 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
22218 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
22219 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
22220 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
22221 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
22222 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
22224 static dw_die_ref
22225 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
22226 tree pack_arg,
22227 dw_die_ref subr_die,
22228 tree *next_arg)
22230 tree arg;
22231 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
22233 gcc_assert (parm_pack
22234 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
22235 && subr_die);
22237 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
22238 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
22240 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
22242 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
22243 parm_pack))
22244 break;
22245 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
22246 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
22247 parm_pack_die);
22249 if (next_arg)
22250 *next_arg = arg;
22251 return parm_pack_die;
22254 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
22255 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
22257 static void
22258 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22260 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
22263 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
22264 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
22265 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
22266 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
22268 static void
22269 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22271 tree link;
22272 tree formal_type = NULL;
22273 tree first_parm_type;
22274 tree arg;
22276 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22278 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
22279 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
22281 else
22282 arg = NULL_TREE;
22284 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
22286 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
22287 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
22288 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
22290 dw_die_ref parm_die;
22292 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
22293 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
22294 break;
22296 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
22297 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
22298 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
22299 context_die);
22300 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
22301 && link == first_parm_type)
22303 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22304 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22305 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
22307 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
22308 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22310 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
22311 if (arg)
22312 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
22315 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
22316 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
22317 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
22318 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
22320 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
22321 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
22322 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
22323 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
22324 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
22325 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
22328 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
22329 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
22330 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
22331 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
22332 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
22334 static void
22335 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
22337 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
22339 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
22340 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
22341 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22342 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
22343 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
22345 dw_die_ref type_die;
22346 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
22348 push_decl_scope (type);
22349 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
22350 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22351 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
22352 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
22354 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
22355 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
22356 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
22357 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
22358 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
22360 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
22361 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
22362 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
22364 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
22365 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
22368 else
22369 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
22371 pop_decl_scope ();
22375 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
22376 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
22377 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
22379 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
22380 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
22381 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
22382 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
22383 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
22384 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
22385 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
22386 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
22387 values to point to themselves. */
22389 static void
22390 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
22392 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
22394 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
22397 tree local_decl;
22399 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
22400 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
22401 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
22402 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
22403 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
22404 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
22405 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
22406 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
22410 tree subblock;
22412 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
22413 subblock != NULL_TREE;
22414 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
22415 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
22420 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
22421 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
22422 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
22423 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
22424 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
22425 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
22426 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
22427 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
22428 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
22429 point to themselves. */
22431 static void
22432 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
22434 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22436 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
22437 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22439 tree arg;
22441 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
22442 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
22443 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
22444 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
22445 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
22450 /* Mark the early DIE for DECL as the abstract instance. */
22452 static void
22453 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
22455 dw_die_ref old_die;
22457 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
22458 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
22460 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
22461 return;
22463 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22464 /* With early debug we always have an old DIE unless we are in LTO
22465 and the user did not compile but only link with debug. */
22466 if (in_lto_p && ! old_die)
22467 return;
22468 gcc_assert (old_die != NULL);
22469 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline)
22470 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
22471 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
22472 return;
22474 /* Go ahead and put DW_AT_inline on the DIE. */
22475 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
22477 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
22478 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
22479 else
22480 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
22482 else
22484 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
22485 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
22486 else
22487 add_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
22490 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
22491 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
22492 add_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22494 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
22497 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
22498 htab_traverse.
22500 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
22501 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
22503 bool
22504 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
22506 dw_die_ref die;
22508 die = lookup_type_die (type);
22509 if (die != NULL)
22510 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22511 return true;
22514 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
22515 through htab_traverse.
22517 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
22518 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
22519 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
22522 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
22523 void *)
22525 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
22526 dw_die_ref die;
22528 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
22529 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
22530 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
22531 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
22532 if (die)
22534 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
22535 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
22536 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
22537 if (node && node->definition)
22539 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22540 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
22541 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
22542 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
22545 return 1;
22548 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
22550 static void
22551 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
22553 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
22554 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
22557 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
22559 static void
22560 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
22562 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
22563 types_used_by_vars_hash
22564 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
22567 /* Generate a DW_TAG_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
22568 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
22570 static dw_die_ref
22571 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
22572 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
22574 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
22575 tree block = ca_loc->block;
22577 while (block
22578 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
22579 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
22581 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
22582 if (stmt_die)
22583 break;
22584 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
22586 if (stmt_die == NULL)
22587 stmt_die = subr_die;
22588 die = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site), stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
22589 add_AT_lbl_id (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_return_pc), ca_loc->label);
22590 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
22591 add_AT_flag (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_tail_call), 1);
22592 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
22594 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
22595 if (tdie)
22596 add_AT_die_ref (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), tdie);
22597 else
22598 add_AT_addr (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_origin), ca_loc->symbol_ref,
22599 false);
22601 return die;
22604 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
22605 block-local). */
22607 static void
22608 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22610 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22611 dw_die_ref subr_die;
22612 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22614 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
22615 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
22617 namespace S
22619 void func() { ... }
22622 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
22623 late debug:
22625 Early debug
22626 -----------
22628 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
22629 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
22630 context is the namespace.
22632 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
22634 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
22635 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
22637 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
22638 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
22640 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
22641 -------------------------------------
22643 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
22644 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
22645 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
22646 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
22647 info is enough.
22649 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
22650 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
22651 it with the location information that should now be available.
22653 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
22654 are also called a multiple times:
22656 class Base
22658 public:
22659 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
22662 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
22664 Early debug
22665 -----------
22667 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
22668 member of the Base class. This is done via
22669 rest_of_type_compilation.
22671 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
22672 DW_AT_declaration.
22674 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
22675 while generating the abstract instance of the base
22676 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
22677 debug of reachable functions.
22679 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
22680 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
22681 in (1).
22683 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
22684 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
22685 (2).
22687 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
22688 -----------------------------------
22690 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
22691 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
22692 we will just annotate the location information now
22693 available.
22695 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
22696 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
22698 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
22699 additional information. */
22700 if (old_die && declaration)
22701 return;
22703 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
22704 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
22705 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
22706 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22707 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
22708 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22709 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
22711 /* A concrete instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
22712 if (origin != NULL)
22714 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
22716 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
22717 inline function. */
22718 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
22719 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
22721 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
22723 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
22724 cached version. */
22725 subr_die = old_die;
22727 else
22729 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22730 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
22731 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
22732 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
22733 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
22734 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
22735 K::K". */
22736 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
22739 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
22740 much as possible. */
22741 else if (old_die)
22743 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
22744 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
22745 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
22746 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
22747 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22749 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
22750 something we have already output. */
22751 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
22752 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
22753 return;
22755 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
22756 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
22757 Fall through and generate it. */
22760 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
22761 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
22762 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
22763 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
22764 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
22765 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
22766 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
22767 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22768 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
22769 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
22770 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
22771 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
22772 building libgfortran:
22774 module some_m
22775 contains
22776 logical function funky (FLAG)
22777 funky = .true.
22778 end function
22779 end module
22781 || (old_die->die_parent
22782 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
22783 || context_die == NULL)
22784 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
22785 /* The location attributes may be in the abstract origin
22786 which in the case of LTO might be not available to
22787 look at. */
22788 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
22789 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
22790 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
22791 == (unsigned) s.line)
22792 && (!debug_column_info
22793 || s.column == 0
22794 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22795 == (unsigned) s.column)))))
22797 subr_die = old_die;
22799 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
22800 parameters so they can be augmented with location
22801 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
22802 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
22803 them further down. */
22804 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
22807 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
22808 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
22811 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
22812 declaration. */
22813 else
22815 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22816 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
22817 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22818 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
22819 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
22820 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
22821 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
22822 if (debug_column_info
22823 && s.column
22824 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
22825 != (unsigned) s.column))
22826 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
22828 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
22829 emit the real type on the definition die. */
22830 if (is_cxx () && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22832 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
22833 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
22834 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22835 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22838 /* When we process the method declaration, we haven't seen
22839 the out-of-class defaulted definition yet, so we have to
22840 recheck now. */
22841 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || ! dwarf_strict)
22842 && !get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted))
22844 int defaulted
22845 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22846 DW_AT_defaulted);
22847 if (defaulted != -1)
22849 /* Other values must have been handled before. */
22850 gcc_assert (defaulted == DW_DEFAULTED_out_of_class);
22851 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22856 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
22857 else
22859 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
22861 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
22862 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
22864 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
22865 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
22866 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22868 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
22869 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
22870 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
22873 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22874 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
22875 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22877 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
22878 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
22880 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22882 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
22885 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
22886 DIE. */
22887 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
22888 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
22890 if (declaration)
22892 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
22894 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22896 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
22897 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
22898 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22899 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22900 DW_AT_explicit) == 1)
22901 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
22903 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
22904 a DW_AT_deleted attribute. */
22905 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22906 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22907 DW_AT_deleted) == 1)
22908 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_deleted, 1);
22910 /* If this is a C++11 defaulted special function member then
22911 generate a DW_AT_defaulted attribute. */
22912 if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22914 int defaulted
22915 = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22916 DW_AT_defaulted);
22917 if (defaulted != -1)
22918 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_defaulted, defaulted);
22921 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with & ref-qualifier
22922 then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22923 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22924 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22925 DW_AT_reference) == 1)
22926 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
22928 /* If this is a C++11 non-static member function with &&
22929 ref-qualifier then generate a DW_AT_reference attribute. */
22930 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
22931 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
22932 DW_AT_rvalue_reference)
22933 == 1)
22934 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
22937 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
22938 the DIE with it. */
22939 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
22941 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
22943 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
22945 if (!crtl->has_bb_partition)
22947 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22948 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
22950 /* We have already generated the labels. */
22951 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
22952 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
22954 else
22956 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
22957 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22958 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22959 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
22960 current_function_funcdef_no);
22961 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
22962 current_function_funcdef_no);
22963 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
22964 false);
22967 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
22968 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
22969 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
22970 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
22971 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
22972 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
22973 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
22974 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
22975 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
22976 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
22977 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
22978 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
22981 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
22982 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
22983 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
22985 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
22986 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
22987 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
22989 #endif
22992 else
22994 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
22995 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
22997 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
22999 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23001 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
23002 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
23003 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
23004 alignment offset. */
23005 bool range_list_added = false;
23006 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
23007 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
23008 false);
23009 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
23010 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
23011 &range_list_added, false);
23012 if (range_list_added)
23013 add_ranges (NULL);
23015 else
23017 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
23018 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
23019 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
23020 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
23021 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
23022 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
23023 sections when given "b foo". */
23024 const char *name = NULL;
23025 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
23026 dw_die_ref seg_die;
23028 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
23029 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
23030 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
23032 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
23033 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
23034 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
23036 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23037 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23039 if (decl_name != NULL
23040 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
23042 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
23043 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23044 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
23046 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
23048 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
23049 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
23050 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23051 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23053 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
23054 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
23055 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
23056 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
23057 if (want_pubnames ())
23058 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
23061 else
23062 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
23063 false);
23066 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
23068 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
23069 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
23070 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
23071 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
23072 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
23073 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
23074 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
23075 function. */
23076 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
23078 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
23079 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
23081 else
23083 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
23084 if (list->dw_loc_next)
23085 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
23086 else
23087 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
23090 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
23091 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
23092 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
23093 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
23094 by this displacement. */
23095 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
23097 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
23099 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
23100 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
23101 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
23102 last field of the FRAME record. */
23103 const tree frame_type
23104 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
23105 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
23107 tree fb_expr
23108 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
23109 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
23110 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
23112 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
23113 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
23116 resolve_variable_values ();
23119 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
23120 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23121 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
23123 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
23124 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
23125 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
23126 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
23127 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
23128 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
23129 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
23130 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
23131 an ellipsis at the end. */
23133 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
23134 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
23135 its formal parameters. */
23136 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23138 else if (declaration)
23139 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
23140 else
23142 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
23143 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
23144 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
23145 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
23146 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
23147 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
23148 : NULL;
23150 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
23151 emit their relevant DIEs.
23153 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
23154 as well as it being a normal function.
23156 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
23157 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
23158 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
23159 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
23160 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
23161 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
23162 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
23163 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
23164 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
23165 children DIE.
23167 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
23168 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
23170 if (generic_decl_parm
23171 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
23172 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
23173 parm, subr_die,
23174 &parm);
23175 else if (parm)
23177 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
23179 if (early_dwarf
23180 && parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
23181 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
23182 && parm_die
23183 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23184 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
23186 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
23188 else if (parm)
23189 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
23191 if (generic_decl_parm)
23192 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
23195 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
23196 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
23197 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
23198 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
23199 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
23200 parameters at all. */
23201 if (early_dwarf)
23203 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
23205 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
23206 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
23207 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
23209 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
23210 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
23214 if (subr_die != old_die)
23215 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
23216 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
23218 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
23219 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
23221 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
23222 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
23223 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
23224 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
23225 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
23226 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
23227 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
23229 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
23230 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
23231 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
23232 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
23233 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
23234 constructor function. */
23235 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
23236 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
23238 int call_site_note_count = 0;
23239 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
23241 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
23242 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
23243 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
23245 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
23246 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
23247 location info. */
23248 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
23250 if (call_arg_locations && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
23252 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
23253 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
23255 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
23256 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
23257 rtx arg, next_arg;
23259 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
23260 ? XEXP (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note, 0)
23261 : NULL_RTX);
23262 arg; arg = next_arg)
23264 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
23265 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
23266 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
23268 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
23269 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23270 && next_arg
23271 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
23272 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
23273 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23274 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
23275 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
23276 if (mode == VOIDmode)
23278 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
23279 if (mode == VOIDmode)
23280 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
23282 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
23283 continue;
23284 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
23285 have no static information: we cannot generate both
23286 DW_AT_call_origin and DW_AT_call_target
23287 attributes. */
23288 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
23290 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
23292 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
23293 continue;
23295 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
23296 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
23298 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
23299 continue;
23302 reg = NULL;
23303 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
23304 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
23305 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23306 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
23308 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
23309 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
23310 get_address_mode (mem),
23311 GET_MODE (mem),
23312 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23314 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23315 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
23317 tree tdecl
23318 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
23319 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
23320 if (tdie == NULL)
23321 continue;
23323 else
23324 continue;
23325 if (reg == NULL
23326 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
23327 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
23328 continue;
23329 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
23330 VOIDmode,
23331 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23332 if (val == NULL)
23333 continue;
23334 if (die == NULL)
23335 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
23336 cdie = new_die (dwarf_TAG (DW_TAG_call_site_parameter), die,
23337 NULL_TREE);
23338 if (reg != NULL)
23339 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
23340 else if (tdie != NULL)
23341 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_parameter),
23342 tdie);
23343 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_value), val);
23344 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
23346 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
23347 if (mode == VOIDmode)
23348 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
23349 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
23350 0), 1),
23351 mode, VOIDmode,
23352 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23353 if (val != NULL)
23354 add_AT_loc (cdie, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_data_value),
23355 val);
23358 if (die == NULL
23359 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
23360 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
23361 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
23363 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
23365 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
23366 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
23367 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
23368 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
23369 VOIDmode,
23370 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23371 if (tval)
23372 add_AT_loc (die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target), tval);
23373 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
23375 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
23376 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
23377 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
23378 VOIDmode,
23379 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
23380 if (tval)
23381 add_AT_loc (die,
23382 dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_target_clobbered),
23383 tval);
23386 if (die != NULL)
23388 call_site_note_count++;
23389 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
23390 tail_call_site_note_count++;
23394 call_arg_locations = NULL;
23395 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
23396 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
23397 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
23398 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5))
23400 if (call_site_count >= 0
23401 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
23402 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_calls), 1);
23403 else
23404 add_AT_flag (subr_die, dwarf_AT (DW_AT_call_all_tail_calls), 1);
23406 call_site_count = -1;
23407 tail_call_site_count = -1;
23410 /* Mark used types after we have created DIEs for the functions scopes. */
23411 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
23414 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
23416 hashval_t
23417 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
23419 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
23422 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
23423 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
23425 bool
23426 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
23428 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
23431 /* Hold information about markers for inlined entry points. */
23432 struct GTY ((for_user)) inline_entry_data
23434 /* The block that's the inlined_function_outer_scope for an inlined
23435 function. */
23436 tree block;
23438 /* The label at the inlined entry point. */
23439 const char *label_pfx;
23440 unsigned int label_num;
23442 /* The view number to be used as the inlined entry point. */
23443 var_loc_view view;
23446 struct inline_entry_data_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash <inline_entry_data>
23448 typedef tree compare_type;
23449 static inline hashval_t hash (const inline_entry_data *);
23450 static inline bool equal (const inline_entry_data *, const_tree);
23453 /* Hash table routines for inline_entry_data. */
23455 inline hashval_t
23456 inline_entry_data_hasher::hash (const inline_entry_data *data)
23458 return htab_hash_pointer (data->block);
23461 inline bool
23462 inline_entry_data_hasher::equal (const inline_entry_data *data,
23463 const_tree block)
23465 return data->block == block;
23468 /* Inlined entry points pending DIE creation in this compilation unit. */
23470 static GTY(()) hash_table<inline_entry_data_hasher> *inline_entry_data_table;
23473 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
23474 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
23475 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
23476 class/namespace scoped declaration.
23478 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
23479 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
23480 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
23481 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
23482 static inline bool
23483 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
23485 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
23486 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
23489 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
23491 static inline bool
23492 local_function_static (tree decl)
23494 gcc_assert (VAR_P (decl));
23495 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
23496 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
23497 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
23500 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
23501 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
23503 static void
23504 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
23506 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
23507 tree com_decl;
23508 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
23509 tree ultimate_origin;
23510 dw_die_ref var_die;
23511 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
23512 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
23513 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
23514 bool specialization_p = false;
23515 bool no_linkage_name = false;
23517 /* While C++ inline static data members have definitions inside of the
23518 class, force the first DIE to be a declaration, then let gen_member_die
23519 reparent it to the class context and call gen_variable_die again
23520 to create the outside of the class DIE for the definition. */
23521 if (!declaration
23522 && old_die == NULL
23523 && decl
23524 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
23525 && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
23526 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl, DW_AT_inline) != -1)
23528 declaration = true;
23529 if (dwarf_version < 5)
23530 no_linkage_name = true;
23533 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
23534 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
23535 origin = ultimate_origin;
23536 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
23538 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
23539 of a data member. */
23540 if (com_decl)
23542 dw_die_ref com_die;
23543 dw_loc_list_ref loc = NULL;
23544 die_node com_die_arg;
23546 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
23547 if (var_die)
23549 if (! early_dwarf && get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
23551 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
23552 if (loc)
23554 if (off)
23556 /* Optimize the common case. */
23557 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
23558 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
23559 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
23560 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
23561 == SYMBOL_REF)
23563 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
23564 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
23565 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
23567 else
23568 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
23570 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23571 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
23574 return;
23577 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
23578 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
23580 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
23581 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
23582 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
23583 if (! early_dwarf)
23584 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23585 if (com_die == NULL)
23587 const char *cnam
23588 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
23589 die_node **slot;
23591 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
23592 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
23593 if (loc)
23595 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23596 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
23597 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
23598 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23600 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
23601 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23602 if (want_pubnames ())
23603 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
23604 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
23605 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
23606 *slot = com_die;
23608 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
23610 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23611 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
23612 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
23614 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
23615 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl_or_origin);
23616 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
23617 decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
23618 context_die);
23619 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
23620 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23621 if (loc)
23623 if (off)
23625 /* Optimize the common case. */
23626 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
23627 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
23628 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
23629 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
23631 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
23632 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
23633 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
23635 else
23636 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
23638 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
23640 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin))
23641 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23642 if (decl)
23643 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
23644 return;
23647 if (old_die)
23649 if (declaration)
23651 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
23652 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
23653 the second pass. */
23654 return;
23656 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
23657 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
23659 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
23660 DW_AT_specification. */
23662 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
23664 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
23665 new DIE that will get annotated with
23666 DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
23667 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
23669 else
23671 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
23672 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
23673 var_die = old_die;
23675 /* ??? In LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
23676 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
23677 references to them. Thus we dumped them again. Also add a
23678 reference to them but beware of -g0 compile and -g link
23679 in which case the reference will be already present. */
23680 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
23681 if (in_lto_p
23682 && ! get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_type)
23683 && variably_modified_type_p
23684 (type, decl_function_context (decl_or_origin)))
23686 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23687 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
23688 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false, context_die);
23689 else
23690 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
23691 false, context_die);
23694 goto gen_variable_die_location;
23698 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
23699 to have DW_TAG_member tag in DWARF{3,4} and we emit it for compatibility
23700 also in DWARF2; the specification should still be DW_TAG_variable
23701 referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
23702 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die) && dwarf_version < 5)
23703 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
23704 else
23705 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
23707 if (origin != NULL)
23708 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
23710 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
23711 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
23713 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
23714 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
23715 sharing them.
23717 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
23718 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
23720 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
23721 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
23722 specialization_p = true;
23723 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
23725 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
23726 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
23728 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
23729 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
23731 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
23732 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
23734 if (debug_column_info
23735 && s.column
23736 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_column)
23737 != (unsigned) s.column))
23738 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_column, s.column);
23740 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
23741 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
23744 else
23745 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl, no_linkage_name);
23747 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23748 || (origin != NULL
23749 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23750 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
23751 decl_function_context
23752 (decl_or_origin))))
23754 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
23756 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23757 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
23758 context_die);
23759 else
23760 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin), false,
23761 context_die);
23764 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
23766 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23767 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23769 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23770 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23772 add_alignment_attribute (var_die, decl);
23774 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
23777 if (declaration)
23778 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23780 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23781 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
23782 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
23784 gen_variable_die_location:
23785 if (! declaration
23786 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
23787 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
23788 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
23789 already set. */
23790 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin)
23791 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
23792 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin))))
23794 if (early_dwarf)
23795 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
23796 else
23797 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
23798 decl == NULL);
23800 else
23801 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
23803 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
23804 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23805 DW_AT_const_expr) == 1
23806 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr)
23807 && !specialization_p)
23808 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_const_expr, 1);
23810 if (!dwarf_strict)
23812 int inl = lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl_or_origin,
23813 DW_AT_inline);
23814 if (inl != -1
23815 && !get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_inline)
23816 && !specialization_p)
23817 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_inline, inl);
23821 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
23823 static void
23824 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23826 dw_die_ref const_die;
23827 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
23829 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23830 if (const_die)
23831 return;
23833 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
23834 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
23835 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
23836 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, false, context_die);
23837 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
23838 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
23839 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
23840 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
23841 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
23844 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
23846 static void
23847 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23849 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
23850 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23851 rtx insn;
23852 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23854 if (!lbl_die)
23856 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
23857 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23859 if (origin != NULL)
23860 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
23861 else
23862 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
23865 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23866 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
23867 else if (! early_dwarf)
23869 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
23871 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
23872 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
23873 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
23874 if (insn
23875 && (LABEL_P (insn)
23876 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
23877 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
23879 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
23880 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
23881 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
23882 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
23883 it if it ever does happen. */
23884 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
23886 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23887 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23889 else if (insn
23890 && NOTE_P (insn)
23891 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
23892 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
23894 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
23895 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
23900 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
23901 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
23902 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
23904 static inline void
23905 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23907 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
23909 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23911 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
23912 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
23913 if (debug_column_info && s.column)
23914 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_column, s.column);
23919 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
23920 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
23922 static inline void
23923 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
23925 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23927 if (inline_entry_data **iedp
23928 = !inline_entry_data_table ? NULL
23929 : inline_entry_data_table->find_slot_with_hash (stmt,
23930 htab_hash_pointer (stmt),
23931 NO_INSERT))
23933 inline_entry_data *ied = *iedp;
23934 gcc_assert (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_MARKER_INSNS);
23935 gcc_assert (debug_inline_points);
23936 gcc_assert (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt));
23938 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, ied->label_pfx, ied->label_num);
23939 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
23941 if (debug_variable_location_views && !ZERO_VIEW_P (ied->view)
23942 && !dwarf_strict)
23944 if (!output_asm_line_debug_info ())
23945 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_GNU_entry_view, ied->view);
23946 else
23948 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", ied->view);
23949 /* FIXME: this will resolve to a small number. Could we
23950 possibly emit smaller data? Ideally we'd emit a
23951 uleb128, but that would make the size of DIEs
23952 impossible for the compiler to compute, since it's
23953 the assembler that computes the value of the view
23954 label in this case. Ideally, we'd have a single form
23955 encompassing both the address and the view, and
23956 indirecting them through a table might make things
23957 easier, but even that would be more wasteful,
23958 space-wise, than what we have now. */
23959 add_AT_symview (die, DW_AT_GNU_entry_view, label);
23963 inline_entry_data_table->clear_slot (iedp);
23966 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
23967 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23969 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
23970 dw_die_ref pdie;
23971 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
23973 if (!debug_inline_points && inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
23975 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
23976 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
23977 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
23980 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
23981 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
23982 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
23983 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
23984 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
23985 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
23986 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
23987 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
23989 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
23991 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
23992 if (pdie == NULL)
23993 break;
23994 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
23995 break;
23996 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
23997 if (new_attr == NULL
23998 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
23999 break;
24000 attr = new_attr;
24001 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
24003 if (attr != NULL
24004 && ((*ranges_table)[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset].num
24005 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
24006 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
24008 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset;
24009 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
24010 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
24011 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
24013 ++supercnt;
24014 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt].num
24015 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
24017 gcc_checking_assert ((*ranges_table)[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
24018 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
24019 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
24020 ++thiscnt;
24021 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
24022 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, off + supercnt - thiscnt,
24023 false);
24024 note_rnglist_head (off + supercnt - thiscnt);
24025 return;
24028 unsigned int offset = add_ranges (stmt, true);
24029 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, false);
24030 note_rnglist_head (offset);
24032 bool prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (stmt);
24033 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
24036 add_ranges (chain, prev_in_cold != BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain));
24037 prev_in_cold = BLOCK_IN_COLD_SECTION_P (chain);
24038 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
24040 while (chain);
24041 add_ranges (NULL);
24043 else
24045 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24046 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
24047 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
24048 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
24049 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
24050 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
24054 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
24056 static void
24057 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24059 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
24060 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
24061 if (!old_die)
24063 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
24064 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
24067 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24069 if (old_die)
24071 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
24072 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
24073 function. */
24074 if (flag_checking)
24075 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
24076 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
24077 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
24079 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
24080 break;
24082 return;
24085 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
24087 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
24088 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
24089 if (old_die)
24091 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
24092 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
24093 old_die = NULL;
24096 tree origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
24097 if (origin != NULL_TREE && origin != stmt)
24098 add_abstract_origin_attribute (stmt_die, origin);
24101 if (old_die)
24102 stmt_die = old_die;
24104 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
24105 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
24106 high/low attributes. */
24107 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
24109 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
24110 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
24113 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
24116 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
24118 static void
24119 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
24121 tree decl;
24123 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
24124 be abstract. */
24125 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
24127 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
24129 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
24130 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
24131 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
24133 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
24135 dw_die_ref subr_die
24136 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
24138 if (call_arg_locations || debug_inline_points)
24139 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
24140 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
24141 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
24142 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
24143 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
24145 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
24149 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
24150 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
24152 static void
24153 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
24155 dw_die_ref decl_die;
24157 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
24158 return;
24160 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
24161 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
24162 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl), decl_quals (decl),
24163 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)),
24164 context_die);
24166 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
24168 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24169 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24170 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
24173 add_alignment_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24175 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
24176 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
24177 trees. */
24178 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
24179 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
24180 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
24181 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
24183 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
24184 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
24186 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
24188 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
24189 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
24192 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. TYPE can be an
24193 OFFSET_TYPE, for a pointer to data member, or a RECORD_TYPE, for a
24194 pointer to member function. */
24196 static void
24197 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24199 if (lookup_type_die (type))
24200 return;
24202 dw_die_ref ptr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
24203 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
24205 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
24206 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
24207 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
24208 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24209 context_die);
24210 add_alignment_attribute (ptr_die, type);
24212 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
24213 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) != METHOD_TYPE)
24215 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
24216 add_AT_loc (ptr_die, DW_AT_use_location, op);
24220 static char *producer_string;
24222 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
24223 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
24225 static char *
24226 gen_producer_string (void)
24228 size_t j;
24229 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
24230 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
24231 char *producer, *tail;
24232 const char *p;
24233 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
24234 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
24236 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
24237 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
24239 case OPT_o:
24240 case OPT_d:
24241 case OPT_dumpbase:
24242 case OPT_dumpdir:
24243 case OPT_auxbase:
24244 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
24245 case OPT_quiet:
24246 case OPT_version:
24247 case OPT_v:
24248 case OPT_w:
24249 case OPT_L:
24250 case OPT_D:
24251 case OPT_I:
24252 case OPT_U:
24253 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
24254 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
24255 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
24256 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
24257 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
24258 case OPT__output_pch_:
24259 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
24260 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
24261 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
24262 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
24263 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
24264 case OPT____:
24265 case OPT__sysroot_:
24266 case OPT_nostdinc:
24267 case OPT_nostdinc__:
24268 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
24269 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
24270 case OPT_fresolution_:
24271 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
24272 case OPT_fmacro_prefix_map_:
24273 case OPT_ffile_prefix_map_:
24274 case OPT_fcompare_debug:
24275 case OPT_fchecking:
24276 case OPT_fchecking_:
24277 /* Ignore these. */
24278 continue;
24279 default:
24280 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
24281 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
24282 continue;
24283 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
24284 == '-');
24285 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
24287 case 'M':
24288 case 'i':
24289 case 'W':
24290 continue;
24291 case 'f':
24292 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
24293 "dump", 4) == 0)
24294 continue;
24295 break;
24296 default:
24297 break;
24299 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
24300 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
24301 break;
24304 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
24305 tail = producer;
24306 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
24307 tail += plen;
24309 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
24311 len = strlen (p);
24312 *tail = ' ';
24313 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
24314 tail += len + 1;
24317 *tail = '\0';
24318 return producer;
24321 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
24322 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
24323 LTO translation unit languages. */
24324 static const char *
24325 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
24327 if (strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++17", lang2) == 0)
24328 return "GNU C++17";
24329 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
24330 return "GNU C++14";
24331 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
24332 return "GNU C++11";
24333 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
24334 return "GNU C++98";
24336 if (strcmp ("GNU C17", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C17", lang2) == 0)
24337 return "GNU C17";
24338 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
24339 return "GNU C11";
24340 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
24341 return "GNU C99";
24342 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
24343 return "GNU C89";
24345 gcc_unreachable ();
24349 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
24351 static dw_die_ref
24352 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
24354 dw_die_ref die;
24355 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
24356 int language;
24358 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
24360 if (filename)
24362 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
24363 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
24364 if (filename[0] != '<')
24365 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
24368 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
24370 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
24371 from the global list of translation units. */
24372 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
24374 unsigned i;
24375 tree t;
24376 const char *common_lang = NULL;
24378 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
24380 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
24381 continue;
24382 if (!common_lang)
24383 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
24384 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
24386 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
24387 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
24388 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
24389 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
24390 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
24391 else
24393 /* Fall back to C. */
24394 common_lang = NULL;
24395 break;
24399 if (common_lang)
24400 language_string = common_lang;
24403 language = DW_LANG_C;
24404 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
24405 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
24407 language = DW_LANG_C89;
24408 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
24410 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
24411 language = DW_LANG_C99;
24413 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24414 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0
24415 || strcmp (language_string, "GNU C17") == 0)
24416 language = DW_LANG_C11;
24419 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
24421 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
24422 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24424 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
24425 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
24426 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
24427 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
24428 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++17") == 0)
24429 /* For now. */
24430 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
24433 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
24434 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
24435 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
24437 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
24438 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
24439 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
24441 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
24442 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
24444 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
24445 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
24446 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
24447 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
24450 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
24451 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
24452 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
24453 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
24454 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
24456 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
24457 language = DW_LANG_Go;
24460 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
24461 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
24462 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
24463 /* Likewise for Ada. */
24464 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
24465 language = DW_LANG_Ada83;
24467 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
24469 switch (language)
24471 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
24472 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
24473 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
24474 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
24475 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
24476 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
24477 lowercases everything. */
24478 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
24479 break;
24480 default:
24481 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
24482 break;
24484 return die;
24487 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
24489 static void
24490 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
24491 dw_die_ref context_die)
24493 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
24494 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
24496 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
24497 context_die);
24498 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
24500 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
24501 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
24503 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
24504 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
24505 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
24506 if (access == access_public_node)
24508 if (dwarf_version == 2
24509 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
24510 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
24512 else if (access == access_protected_node)
24513 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
24514 else if (dwarf_version > 2
24515 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
24516 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
24519 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
24520 structure. */
24521 static bool
24522 is_variant_part (tree decl)
24524 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
24525 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
24528 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
24529 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
24531 static tree
24532 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
24534 bool continue_stripping = true;
24535 while (continue_stripping)
24536 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
24538 CASE_CONVERT:
24539 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
24540 break;
24541 default:
24542 continue_stripping = false;
24543 break;
24546 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
24547 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
24548 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
24549 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
24550 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
24551 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
24552 else
24553 return NULL_TREE;
24556 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
24557 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
24558 return true. Return false otherwise. */
24560 static bool
24561 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
24563 tree discr_type = TREE_TYPE (src);
24565 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
24567 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (discr_type);
24568 if (debug_type != NULL)
24569 discr_type = debug_type;
24572 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST || !INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (discr_type))
24573 return false;
24575 /* Signedness can vary between the original type and the debug type. This
24576 can happen for character types in Ada for instance: the character type
24577 used for code generation can be signed, to be compatible with the C one,
24578 but from a debugger point of view, it must be unsigned. */
24579 bool is_orig_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
24580 bool is_debug_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (discr_type);
24582 if (is_orig_unsigned != is_debug_unsigned)
24583 src = fold_convert (discr_type, src);
24585 if (!(is_debug_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
24586 return false;
24588 dest->pos = is_debug_unsigned;
24589 if (is_debug_unsigned)
24590 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
24591 else
24592 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
24594 return true;
24597 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
24598 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
24599 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
24601 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
24602 part to *DISCR_DECL
24604 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
24605 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
24607 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
24608 the above array.
24610 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
24611 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
24613 static void
24614 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
24615 tree struct_type,
24616 tree *discr_decl,
24617 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
24618 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
24620 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
24621 tree variant;
24622 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
24623 unsigned i;
24625 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
24626 *discr_lists_length = 0;
24627 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
24628 variant != NULL_TREE;
24629 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
24630 ++*discr_lists_length;
24632 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24633 *discr_lists_p
24634 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
24635 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
24636 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
24638 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
24639 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
24640 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
24641 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
24642 variant != NULL_TREE;
24643 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
24645 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
24647 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
24648 it. */
24649 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
24650 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
24651 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
24652 this one. */
24653 continue;
24655 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
24656 possibility: single values or ranges. */
24657 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
24659 tree next_round_match_expr;
24660 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
24661 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
24663 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
24664 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
24665 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
24666 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
24668 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
24669 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24671 else
24672 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
24674 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
24675 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
24676 one. */
24679 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
24681 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
24682 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
24683 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24685 candidate_discr
24686 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
24687 struct_type);
24689 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
24690 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
24691 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
24692 goto abort;
24693 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
24696 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
24698 /* We are matching:
24699 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
24700 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
24701 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
24702 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
24703 inclusive or exclusive. */
24704 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
24705 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
24706 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
24707 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
24708 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
24710 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
24711 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
24712 to increment or decrement it. */
24713 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
24714 lower_cst_included = true;
24715 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
24716 lower_cst_included = false;
24717 else
24718 goto abort;
24720 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
24721 upper_cst_included = true;
24722 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
24723 upper_cst_included = false;
24724 else
24725 goto abort;
24727 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
24728 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
24729 operand. */
24730 candidate_discr_1
24731 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
24732 struct_type);
24733 candidate_discr_2
24734 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
24735 struct_type);
24736 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
24737 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
24738 else
24739 goto abort;
24741 /* Extract bounds from both. */
24742 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
24743 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
24744 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
24746 if (!lower_cst_included)
24747 lower_cst
24748 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), lower_cst,
24749 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1));
24750 if (!upper_cst_included)
24751 upper_cst
24752 = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), upper_cst,
24753 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1));
24755 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
24756 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
24757 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
24758 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
24759 goto abort;
24761 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
24764 else
24765 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
24766 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
24767 goto abort;
24769 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
24770 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
24771 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
24772 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
24773 goto abort;
24774 else
24775 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
24777 if (new_node != NULL)
24779 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
24780 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
24782 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
24786 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
24787 in. */
24788 return;
24790 abort:
24791 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
24792 free (*discr_lists_p);
24793 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
24794 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24797 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
24798 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
24799 under CONTEXT_DIE.
24801 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
24802 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
24803 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
24804 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
24805 values are inferred from these attributes.
24807 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
24808 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
24809 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
24810 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
24811 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
24812 describe in DWARF. */
24814 static void
24815 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
24816 dw_die_ref context_die)
24818 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
24819 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
24820 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
24821 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
24822 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
24823 NULL, /* dpi */
24824 false, /* placeholder_arg */
24825 false /* placeholder_seen */
24828 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
24829 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
24830 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24831 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
24832 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
24833 unsigned i;
24835 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
24836 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
24837 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
24839 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
24841 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
24842 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
24844 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
24846 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
24848 if (discr_die)
24849 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
24850 else
24851 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
24852 discrimimant information in the output. */
24853 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
24856 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
24857 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
24858 expressions for it for each member. */
24859 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
24860 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
24862 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
24863 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
24864 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24865 NULL_TREE));
24866 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
24867 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
24868 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
24870 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
24871 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
24872 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
24873 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
24876 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
24877 i = 0;
24878 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
24879 variant != NULL_TREE;
24880 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
24882 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
24883 dw_die_ref variant_die;
24885 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
24886 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
24887 under these records. */
24888 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
24890 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
24891 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
24893 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
24894 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
24895 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
24896 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
24897 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
24899 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
24900 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
24901 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
24902 list. */
24903 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
24904 else
24905 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
24907 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
24908 member != NULL_TREE;
24909 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24911 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
24912 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
24913 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
24915 if (is_variant_part (member))
24917 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
24918 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
24919 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
24920 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
24921 we recurse. */
24923 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
24924 = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
24925 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member));
24926 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24928 else
24930 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
24931 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
24936 free (discr_lists);
24939 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
24941 static void
24942 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
24944 tree member;
24945 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
24947 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
24949 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
24950 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
24951 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
24952 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
24953 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
24954 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
24955 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
24956 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
24957 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
24958 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
24959 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
24961 /* First output info about the base classes. */
24962 if (binfo)
24964 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
24965 int i;
24966 tree base;
24968 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
24969 gen_inheritance_die (base,
24970 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
24971 type,
24972 context_die);
24975 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
24976 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
24978 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
24979 bool static_inline_p
24980 = (TREE_STATIC (member)
24981 && (lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (member, DW_AT_inline)
24982 != -1));
24984 /* Ignore clones. */
24985 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
24986 continue;
24988 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
24989 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
24990 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
24991 do put them in the right order. */
24993 if (dw_die_ref child = lookup_decl_die (member))
24995 /* Handle inline static data members, which only have in-class
24996 declarations. */
24997 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
24998 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
24999 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ())
25001 ref = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
25002 /* For C++17 inline static data members followed by redundant
25003 out of class redeclaration, we might get here with
25004 child being the DIE created for the out of class
25005 redeclaration and with its DW_AT_specification being
25006 the DIE created for in-class definition. We want to
25007 reparent the latter, and don't want to create another
25008 DIE with DW_AT_specification in that case, because
25009 we already have one. */
25010 if (ref
25011 && static_inline_p
25012 && ref->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
25013 && ref->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
25014 && get_AT (ref, DW_AT_specification) == NULL)
25016 child = ref;
25017 ref = NULL;
25018 static_inline_p = false;
25022 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_variable
25023 && child->die_parent == comp_unit_die ()
25024 && ref == NULL)
25026 reparent_child (child, context_die);
25027 if (dwarf_version < 5)
25028 child->die_tag = DW_TAG_member;
25030 else
25031 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
25034 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
25035 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
25036 conflict in our mappings. */
25037 else if (is_variant_part (member)
25038 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
25040 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
25041 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
25043 else
25045 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
25046 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
25049 /* For C++ inline static data members emit immediately a DW_TAG_variable
25050 DIE that will refer to that DW_TAG_member/DW_TAG_variable through
25051 DW_AT_specification. */
25052 if (static_inline_p)
25054 int old_extern = DECL_EXTERNAL (member);
25055 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = 0;
25056 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, comp_unit_die ());
25057 DECL_EXTERNAL (member) = old_extern;
25062 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
25063 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
25064 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
25066 static void
25067 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
25068 enum debug_info_usage usage)
25070 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25072 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
25073 still incomplete. */
25074 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
25075 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
25076 member;
25077 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
25078 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
25079 return;
25082 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25083 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
25084 int nested = 0;
25085 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
25086 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
25087 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
25088 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
25089 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
25091 if (type_die && ! complete)
25092 return;
25094 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
25095 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25096 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
25097 nested = 1;
25099 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
25101 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
25102 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25103 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
25105 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
25106 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
25108 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
25110 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
25111 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
25112 scope_die, type);
25113 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25114 if (old_die)
25115 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
25116 else
25117 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
25119 else
25120 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
25122 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
25123 then give a list of members. */
25124 if (complete && !ns_decl)
25126 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
25127 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
25128 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25129 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
25130 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, type);
25131 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
25133 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
25134 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
25137 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
25138 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
25139 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
25140 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
25142 push_decl_scope (type);
25143 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
25144 pop_decl_scope ();
25146 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
25147 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
25148 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
25150 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
25151 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
25153 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
25155 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
25156 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
25157 lookup_type_die (vtype));
25160 else
25162 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
25164 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
25165 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
25166 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
25167 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
25170 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
25171 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
25174 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
25176 static void
25177 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
25179 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
25180 dw_die_ref subr_die
25181 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
25182 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
25184 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
25185 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
25186 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, false,
25187 context_die);
25188 add_alignment_attribute (subr_die, type);
25189 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
25191 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
25192 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
25193 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25194 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type, DW_AT_reference) != -1)
25195 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_reference, 1);
25196 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
25197 && lang_hooks.types.type_dwarf_attribute (type,
25198 DW_AT_rvalue_reference) != -1)
25199 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_rvalue_reference, 1);
25202 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
25204 static void
25205 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
25207 dw_die_ref type_die;
25208 tree type;
25210 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
25212 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
25213 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
25214 return;
25217 /* As we avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs (see decl_ultimate_origin
25218 checks in process_scope_var and modified_type_die), this should be called
25219 only for original types. */
25220 gcc_assert (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == NULL
25221 || decl_ultimate_origin (decl) == decl);
25223 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
25224 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
25226 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
25227 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
25229 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
25230 if (type == error_mark_node)
25231 return;
25233 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
25234 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
25236 else
25238 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
25239 if (type == error_mark_node)
25240 return;
25242 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25244 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
25245 an anonymous type, e.g:
25246 typedef struct {...} foo;
25247 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
25248 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
25249 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
25250 the C++ FE.
25252 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
25253 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
25254 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
25255 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
25256 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
25257 anonymous struct DIE. */
25258 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25259 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25261 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
25262 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
25263 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
25264 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
25265 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
25266 this debug info. */
25267 add_linkage_name_raw (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
25271 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), false,
25272 context_die);
25274 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
25275 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
25276 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
25277 created. */
25278 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25280 add_alignment_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
25282 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
25284 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
25285 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
25287 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
25288 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
25291 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
25293 static void
25294 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
25295 dw_die_ref context_die,
25296 enum debug_info_usage usage)
25298 int need_pop;
25300 if (type == NULL_TREE
25301 || !is_tagged_type (type))
25302 return;
25304 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25305 need_pop = 0;
25306 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
25307 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
25308 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
25309 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
25310 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
25311 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
25312 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
25313 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
25314 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
25316 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
25318 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25319 return;
25321 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
25322 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25323 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25324 need_pop = 1;
25326 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
25327 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
25329 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
25330 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
25331 decls_for_scope. */
25332 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25333 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
25334 specification. */
25335 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
25336 context_die = NULL;
25337 need_pop = 0;
25339 else
25341 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
25342 need_pop = 0;
25345 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
25347 /* This might have been written out by the call to
25348 declare_in_namespace. */
25349 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25350 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
25352 else
25353 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
25355 if (need_pop)
25356 pop_decl_scope ();
25358 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
25359 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
25360 when appropriate. */
25363 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
25365 static void
25366 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
25367 enum debug_info_usage usage)
25369 struct array_descr_info info;
25371 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
25372 return;
25374 if (flag_checking && type)
25375 verify_type (type);
25377 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
25378 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
25379 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
25380 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25381 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
25382 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
25383 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
25384 type. */
25385 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
25387 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
25388 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
25389 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
25391 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25392 return;
25394 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
25395 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (name);
25396 if (origin != NULL && origin != name)
25398 gen_decl_die (origin, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25399 return;
25402 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
25403 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type);
25405 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
25406 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
25408 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25410 gen_decl_die (name, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25411 return;
25414 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
25415 generate debug info for the typedef. */
25416 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
25418 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
25419 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
25420 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
25421 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
25422 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
25424 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
25425 return;
25428 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
25430 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
25432 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
25434 gen_type_die_with_usage (debug_type, context_die, usage);
25435 return;
25439 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
25440 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
25441 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
25442 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
25443 cloned type itself. Similarly function/method types can contain extra
25444 ref-qualification). */
25445 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE
25446 || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
25448 /* For function/method types, can't use type_main_variant here,
25449 because that can have different ref-qualifiers for C++,
25450 but try to canonicalize. */
25451 tree main = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
25452 for (tree t = main; t; t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
25453 if (TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (t) == 0
25454 && check_base_type (t, main)
25455 && check_lang_type (t, type))
25457 type = t;
25458 break;
25461 else if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
25462 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
25463 type = type_main_variant (type);
25465 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
25466 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
25467 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
25469 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
25470 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
25472 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
25473 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
25474 && (info.ndimensions
25475 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
25476 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
25477 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25478 return;
25482 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
25484 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
25485 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
25486 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
25487 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
25488 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
25489 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
25490 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
25491 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
25492 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
25493 return;
25496 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
25498 case ERROR_MARK:
25499 break;
25501 case POINTER_TYPE:
25502 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
25503 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
25504 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
25505 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
25506 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
25507 statement. */
25508 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25510 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
25511 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
25512 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25513 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25514 break;
25516 case OFFSET_TYPE:
25517 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
25518 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
25519 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
25520 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25522 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
25523 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25524 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
25526 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
25527 itself. */
25528 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
25529 break;
25531 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
25532 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
25533 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25534 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25535 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
25536 break;
25538 case METHOD_TYPE:
25539 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
25540 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
25541 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25542 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
25543 break;
25545 case ARRAY_TYPE:
25546 case VECTOR_TYPE:
25547 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
25548 break;
25550 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
25551 case RECORD_TYPE:
25552 case UNION_TYPE:
25553 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
25554 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
25555 return;
25557 case VOID_TYPE:
25558 case INTEGER_TYPE:
25559 case REAL_TYPE:
25560 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
25561 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
25562 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
25563 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
25564 break;
25566 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
25567 case LANG_TYPE:
25568 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
25570 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25571 if (type_die == NULL)
25573 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
25574 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
25575 type);
25576 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25577 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
25580 break;
25582 default:
25583 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
25585 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
25586 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
25587 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
25588 if (!*die)
25590 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
25591 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
25592 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
25594 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
25595 break;
25597 gcc_unreachable ();
25600 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
25603 static void
25604 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
25606 if (type != error_mark_node)
25608 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
25609 if (flag_checking)
25611 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
25612 if (die)
25613 check_die (die);
25618 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
25619 things which are local to the given block. */
25621 static void
25622 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
25624 int must_output_die = 0;
25625 bool inlined_func;
25627 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
25628 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
25629 return;
25631 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
25633 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
25634 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
25635 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
25636 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
25638 tree sub;
25640 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
25641 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
25643 return;
25646 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
25647 block. */
25648 if (inlined_func)
25649 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
25650 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
25651 must_output_die = 1;
25652 else
25654 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
25655 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
25656 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25657 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
25658 as being a "significant" one. */
25659 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
25660 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
25661 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
25662 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
25663 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
25664 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
25665 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
25666 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
25667 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
25668 must_output_die = 1;
25671 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
25672 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
25673 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
25674 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
25675 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
25676 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
25677 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
25678 if (must_output_die)
25680 if (inlined_func)
25682 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
25683 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
25684 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
25685 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
25686 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
25687 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
25688 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
25689 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
25691 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
25692 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
25693 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
25694 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
25695 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
25696 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
25698 else
25699 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
25701 else
25702 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
25705 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
25706 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
25707 static void
25708 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
25710 dw_die_ref die;
25711 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
25713 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25714 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
25715 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL)
25717 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
25718 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
25719 else
25720 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
25721 /* Avoid re-creating the DIE late if it was optimized as unused early. */
25722 if (! die && ! early_dwarf)
25723 return;
25725 else
25726 die = NULL;
25728 /* Avoid creating DIEs for local typedefs and concrete static variables that
25729 will only be pruned later. */
25730 if ((origin || decl_ultimate_origin (decl))
25731 && (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
25732 || (VAR_P (decl_or_origin) && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin))))
25734 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
25735 if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && die != NULL)
25737 die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
25738 if (die != NULL)
25739 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, die);
25741 return;
25744 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
25745 add_child_die (context_die, die);
25746 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
25748 if (early_dwarf)
25749 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
25750 stmt, context_die);
25752 else
25754 if (decl && DECL_P (decl))
25756 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25758 /* Early created DIEs do not have a parent as the decls refer
25759 to the function as DECL_CONTEXT rather than the BLOCK. */
25760 if (die && die->die_parent == NULL)
25762 gcc_assert (in_lto_p);
25763 add_child_die (context_die, die);
25767 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
25771 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
25772 all of its sub-blocks. */
25774 static void
25775 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
25777 tree decl;
25778 unsigned int i;
25779 tree subblocks;
25781 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
25782 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
25783 return;
25785 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
25786 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
25787 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
25788 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
25789 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
25790 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
25792 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
25793 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25794 /* BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARs simply generate DIE stubs with abstract
25795 origin - avoid doing this twice as we have no good way to see
25796 if we've done it once already. */
25797 if (! early_dwarf)
25798 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
25800 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
25801 if (decl == current_function_decl)
25802 /* Ignore declarations of the current function, while they
25803 are declarations, gen_subprogram_die would treat them
25804 as definitions again, because they are equal to
25805 current_function_decl and endlessly recurse. */;
25806 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
25807 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
25808 else
25809 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL_TREE, decl, context_die);
25813 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
25814 inlined call information. */
25816 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
25817 therein) of this block. */
25818 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
25819 subblocks != NULL;
25820 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
25821 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
25824 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
25826 bool
25827 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
25829 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
25830 return true;
25832 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
25833 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
25834 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
25835 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
25836 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
25837 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
25838 return true;
25840 return false;
25843 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
25844 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
25845 constructs like:
25847 typedef struct {...} foo;
25849 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
25850 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
25851 struct type. */
25853 static bool
25854 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
25856 if (decl == NULL_TREE
25857 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
25858 || DECL_NAMELESS (decl)
25859 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25860 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
25861 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
25862 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
25863 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
25864 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
25865 || !is_cxx (decl))
25866 return FALSE;
25868 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
25869 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
25870 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
25871 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
25874 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
25876 static inline dw_die_ref
25877 lookup_context_die (tree context)
25879 if (context)
25881 /* Find die that represents this context. */
25882 if (TYPE_P (context))
25884 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25885 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
25886 if (!ctx)
25887 return NULL;
25888 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
25890 else
25891 return lookup_decl_die (context);
25893 return comp_unit_die ();
25896 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
25898 static inline dw_die_ref
25899 get_context_die (tree context)
25901 if (context)
25903 /* Find die that represents this context. */
25904 if (TYPE_P (context))
25906 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
25907 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
25909 else
25910 return force_decl_die (context);
25912 return comp_unit_die ();
25915 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
25917 static dw_die_ref
25918 force_decl_die (tree decl)
25920 dw_die_ref decl_die;
25921 unsigned saved_external_flag;
25922 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
25923 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25924 if (!decl_die)
25926 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
25928 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25929 if (decl_die)
25930 return decl_die;
25932 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
25934 case FUNCTION_DECL:
25935 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
25936 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
25937 declaration die. */
25938 save_fn = current_function_decl;
25939 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
25940 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
25941 current_function_decl = save_fn;
25942 break;
25944 case VAR_DECL:
25945 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
25946 gen_decl_die() call. */
25947 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
25948 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
25949 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
25950 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
25951 break;
25953 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
25954 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
25955 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
25956 else
25957 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
25958 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25959 break;
25961 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
25962 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
25963 break;
25965 default:
25966 gcc_unreachable ();
25969 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
25970 if (!decl_die)
25971 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
25972 gcc_assert (decl_die);
25975 return decl_die;
25978 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
25979 always returned. */
25981 static dw_die_ref
25982 force_type_die (tree type)
25984 dw_die_ref type_die;
25986 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
25987 if (!type_die)
25989 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
25991 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
25992 false, context_die);
25993 gcc_assert (type_die);
25995 return type_die;
25998 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
25999 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
26001 static dw_die_ref
26002 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
26004 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
26005 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
26006 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26007 /* Force out the namespace. */
26008 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
26010 return context_die;
26013 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
26014 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
26016 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
26017 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
26018 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
26019 members). */
26021 static dw_die_ref
26022 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
26024 dw_die_ref ns_context;
26026 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26027 return context_die;
26029 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
26030 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
26032 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
26033 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
26035 namespace S
26037 int i=5;
26038 int foo()
26040 int i=8;
26041 extern int i;
26042 return i;
26046 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
26047 return context_die;
26049 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
26050 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
26051 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
26052 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
26053 return context_die;
26055 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
26057 if (ns_context != context_die)
26059 if (is_fortran ())
26060 return ns_context;
26061 if (DECL_P (thing))
26062 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
26063 else
26064 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
26066 return context_die;
26069 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
26071 static void
26072 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
26074 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
26076 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
26077 they are an alias of. */
26078 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
26080 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
26081 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
26082 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
26083 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
26084 context_die, decl);
26085 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
26086 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26088 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
26089 if (name)
26090 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
26092 else
26093 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
26094 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26095 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26096 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
26098 else
26100 /* Output a namespace alias. */
26102 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
26103 dw_die_ref origin_die
26104 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
26106 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
26107 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26108 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
26109 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
26110 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
26111 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
26112 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
26113 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
26115 if ((dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
26116 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
26117 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
26118 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_export_symbols, 1);
26120 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
26121 if (want_pubnames ())
26122 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
26125 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
26126 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
26127 for all other decls it returns NULL.
26129 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
26130 It can be NULL otherwise. */
26132 static dw_die_ref
26133 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
26134 dw_die_ref context_die)
26136 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
26137 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
26139 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
26140 return NULL;
26142 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
26144 case ERROR_MARK:
26145 break;
26147 case CONST_DECL:
26148 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
26150 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
26151 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
26152 break;
26155 /* Emit its type. */
26156 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
26158 /* And its containing namespace. */
26159 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
26161 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
26162 break;
26164 case FUNCTION_DECL:
26165 #if 0
26166 /* FIXME */
26167 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
26168 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
26169 if (current_function_decl != decl)
26170 /* This is only a declaration. */;
26171 #endif
26173 /* We should have abstract copies already and should not generate
26174 stray type DIEs in late LTO dumping. */
26175 if (! early_dwarf)
26178 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
26179 else if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
26180 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
26181 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
26182 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
26184 /* If we're emitting a possibly inlined function emit it as
26185 abstract instance. */
26186 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
26187 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
26188 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
26189 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
26190 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
26191 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
26192 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26193 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
26195 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
26196 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26198 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
26199 have its containing type. */
26200 if (!origin)
26201 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
26202 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
26203 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
26205 /* And its return type. */
26206 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
26208 /* And its virtual context. */
26209 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26210 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
26212 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
26213 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
26214 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
26216 /* And its containing namespace. */
26217 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
26220 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
26221 if (decl)
26222 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
26223 break;
26225 case TYPE_DECL:
26226 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26227 actual typedefs. */
26228 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26229 break;
26231 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
26232 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
26233 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
26234 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
26235 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
26236 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
26237 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
26238 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
26239 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
26240 case. */
26241 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
26242 break;
26244 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
26245 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
26246 else
26247 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
26248 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
26249 break;
26251 case LABEL_DECL:
26252 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
26253 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
26254 break;
26256 case VAR_DECL:
26257 case RESULT_DECL:
26258 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26259 variable declarations or definitions. */
26260 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26261 break;
26263 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
26264 All types have been dumped early. */
26265 if (early_dwarf
26266 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
26267 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
26268 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
26269 which copies both the decl and the types. */
26270 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
26271 in VLA bound information for example. */
26272 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
26273 current_function_decl)))
26275 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
26276 object. */
26277 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
26278 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
26279 else
26280 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
26283 if (early_dwarf)
26285 /* And its containing type. */
26286 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
26287 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
26288 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
26290 /* And its containing namespace. */
26291 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
26294 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
26295 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
26296 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
26297 function. */
26298 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
26299 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
26300 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
26301 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
26302 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
26303 context_die);
26304 else
26305 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
26306 break;
26308 case FIELD_DECL:
26309 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
26310 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
26311 anonymous unions and structs. */
26312 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
26313 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
26314 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
26316 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
26317 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
26319 break;
26321 case PARM_DECL:
26322 /* Avoid generating stray type DIEs during late dwarf dumping.
26323 All types have been dumped early. */
26324 if (early_dwarf
26325 /* ??? But in LTRANS we cannot annotate early created variably
26326 modified type DIEs without copying them and adjusting all
26327 references to them. Dump them again as happens for inlining
26328 which copies both the decl and the types. */
26329 /* ??? And even non-LTO needs to re-visit type DIEs to fill
26330 in VLA bound information for example. */
26331 || (decl && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl),
26332 current_function_decl)))
26334 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
26335 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
26336 else
26337 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
26339 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
26340 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
26341 context_die);
26343 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
26344 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
26345 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
26346 break;
26348 case IMPORTED_DECL:
26349 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
26350 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
26351 break;
26353 case NAMELIST_DECL:
26354 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
26355 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
26356 break;
26358 default:
26359 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
26360 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
26361 break;
26364 return NULL;
26367 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
26368 end of the parsing process.
26370 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
26371 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
26372 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
26373 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
26375 static void
26376 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
26378 set_early_dwarf s;
26380 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
26381 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
26382 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
26384 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
26385 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
26386 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
26387 while we generate dwarf early. */
26388 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
26389 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
26391 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
26392 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
26393 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
26394 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
26395 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
26397 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
26399 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
26401 /* For nested functions, make sure we have DIEs for the parents first
26402 so that all nested DIEs are generated at the proper scope in the
26403 first shot. */
26404 tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
26405 if (context != NULL)
26407 dw_die_ref context_die = lookup_decl_die (context);
26408 current_function_decl = context;
26410 /* Avoid emitting DIEs multiple times, but still process CONTEXT
26411 enough so that it lands in its own context. This avoids type
26412 pruning issues later on. */
26413 if (context_die == NULL || is_declaration_die (context_die))
26414 dwarf2out_decl (context);
26417 /* Emit an abstract origin of a function first. This happens
26418 with C++ constructor clones for example and makes
26419 dwarf2out_abstract_function happy which requires the early
26420 DIE of the abstract instance to be present. */
26421 tree origin = DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
26422 dw_die_ref origin_die;
26423 if (origin != NULL
26424 /* Do not emit the DIE multiple times but make sure to
26425 process it fully here in case we just saw a declaration. */
26426 && ((origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin)) == NULL
26427 || is_declaration_die (origin_die)))
26429 current_function_decl = origin;
26430 dwarf2out_decl (origin);
26433 /* Emit the DIE for decl but avoid doing that multiple times. */
26434 dw_die_ref old_die;
26435 if ((old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl)) == NULL
26436 || is_declaration_die (old_die))
26438 current_function_decl = decl;
26439 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26442 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
26444 else
26445 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26447 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
26450 /* Return whether EXPR is an expression with the following pattern:
26451 INDIRECT_REF (NOP_EXPR (INTEGER_CST)). */
26453 static bool
26454 is_trivial_indirect_ref (tree expr)
26456 if (expr == NULL_TREE || TREE_CODE (expr) != INDIRECT_REF)
26457 return false;
26459 tree nop = TREE_OPERAND (expr, 0);
26460 if (nop == NULL_TREE || TREE_CODE (nop) != NOP_EXPR)
26461 return false;
26463 tree int_cst = TREE_OPERAND (nop, 0);
26464 return int_cst != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (int_cst) == INTEGER_CST;
26467 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
26468 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
26470 static void
26471 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
26473 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
26474 on the first pass. */
26475 if (VAR_P (decl))
26477 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26479 /* We may have to generate early debug late for LTO in case debug
26480 was not enabled at compile-time or the target doesn't support
26481 the LTO early debug scheme. */
26482 if (! die && in_lto_p)
26484 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26485 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26488 if (die)
26490 /* We get called via the symtab code invoking late_global_decl
26491 for symbols that are optimized out.
26493 Do not add locations for those, except if they have a
26494 DECL_VALUE_EXPR, in which case they are relevant for debuggers.
26495 Still don't add a location if the DECL_VALUE_EXPR is not a trivial
26496 INDIRECT_REF expression, as this could generate relocations to
26497 text symbols in LTO object files, which is invalid. */
26498 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (decl);
26499 if ((! node || ! node->definition)
26500 && ! (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
26501 && is_trivial_indirect_ref (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl))))
26502 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
26503 else
26504 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
26509 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
26510 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
26511 static void
26512 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
26514 if (!local)
26516 set_early_dwarf s;
26517 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26521 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
26522 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
26523 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
26524 that DECL belongs to.
26525 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
26526 static void
26527 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
26528 tree name,
26529 tree lexical_block,
26530 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
26532 expanded_location xloc;
26533 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
26534 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
26536 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
26538 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
26539 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
26540 gcc_assert (decl);
26542 else
26543 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
26545 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
26547 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
26548 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
26549 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
26550 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
26551 if (!at_import_die)
26553 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
26554 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
26555 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
26556 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
26559 else
26561 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26562 if (!at_import_die)
26564 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
26565 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
26566 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
26568 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
26570 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
26571 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
26572 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
26573 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
26574 return;
26575 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
26576 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
26578 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
26579 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
26580 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
26581 NULL_TREE);
26582 else
26583 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
26587 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
26589 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
26590 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
26591 lexical_block_die,
26592 lexical_block);
26593 else
26594 return;
26596 else
26597 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
26598 lexical_block_die,
26599 lexical_block);
26601 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
26602 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
26603 if (debug_column_info && xloc.column)
26604 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_column, xloc.column);
26605 if (name)
26606 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
26607 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
26608 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
26611 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
26612 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
26613 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
26614 importing whole module.
26615 IMPLICIT is set if this hook is called for an implicit import
26616 such as inline namespace. */
26618 static void
26619 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
26620 bool child, bool implicit)
26622 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
26623 dw_die_ref scope_die;
26625 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26626 return;
26628 gcc_assert (decl);
26630 /* For DWARF5, just DW_AT_export_symbols on the DW_TAG_namespace
26631 should be enough, for DWARF4 and older even if we emit as extension
26632 DW_AT_export_symbols add the implicit DW_TAG_imported_module anyway
26633 for the benefit of consumers unaware of DW_AT_export_symbols. */
26634 if (implicit
26635 && dwarf_version >= 5
26636 && lang_hooks.decls.decl_dwarf_attribute (decl,
26637 DW_AT_export_symbols) == 1)
26638 return;
26640 set_early_dwarf s;
26642 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
26643 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
26644 itself. */
26646 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
26647 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
26648 if (context
26649 && TYPE_P (context)
26650 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
26651 return;
26653 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
26655 if (child)
26657 /* DW_TAG_imported_module was introduced in the DWARFv3 specification, so
26658 there is nothing we can do, here. */
26659 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
26660 return;
26662 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
26663 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
26664 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
26665 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
26668 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
26669 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
26672 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
26674 static dw_die_ref
26675 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
26677 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
26678 tree value;
26679 unsigned i;
26681 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26682 return NULL;
26684 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
26685 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
26686 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
26688 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
26689 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
26690 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
26692 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26693 return nml_die;
26696 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
26698 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
26699 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
26700 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
26702 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
26703 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
26705 return nml_die;
26709 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
26711 static void
26712 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
26714 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
26716 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
26718 case ERROR_MARK:
26719 return;
26721 case FUNCTION_DECL:
26722 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
26723 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
26724 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
26725 if (decl_function_context (decl)
26726 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
26727 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26728 context_die = NULL;
26729 break;
26731 case VAR_DECL:
26732 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
26733 if (local_function_static (decl))
26734 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
26736 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
26737 variable declarations or definitions. */
26738 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26739 return;
26740 break;
26742 case CONST_DECL:
26743 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26744 return;
26745 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
26746 return;
26747 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
26748 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
26749 break;
26751 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
26752 case IMPORTED_DECL:
26753 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26754 return;
26755 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
26756 return;
26757 break;
26759 case TYPE_DECL:
26760 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
26761 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
26762 return;
26764 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
26765 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
26766 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
26767 return;
26769 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
26770 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
26771 return;
26773 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
26774 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
26775 if (decl_function_context (decl))
26776 context_die = NULL;
26778 break;
26780 case NAMELIST_DECL:
26781 break;
26783 default:
26784 return;
26787 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
26789 if (flag_checking)
26791 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26792 if (die)
26793 check_die (die);
26797 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
26799 static void
26800 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
26802 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
26803 call_arg_locations = NULL;
26804 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
26805 call_site_count = -1;
26806 tail_call_site_count = -1;
26807 decl_loc_table->empty ();
26808 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
26811 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
26812 a lexical block. */
26814 static void
26815 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
26816 unsigned int blocknum)
26818 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26819 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
26822 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
26823 lexical block. */
26825 static void
26826 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
26828 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
26829 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
26832 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
26833 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
26835 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
26836 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
26837 we may end up calling them anyway. */
26839 static bool
26840 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
26842 tree decl;
26843 unsigned int i;
26845 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
26846 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26847 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26848 return 0;
26849 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
26851 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
26852 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
26853 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
26854 return 0;
26857 return 1;
26860 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
26862 bool
26863 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
26865 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
26868 hashval_t
26869 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
26871 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
26874 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
26875 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
26876 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
26877 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
26878 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
26879 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
26880 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
26881 available unique index number. */
26883 static struct dwarf_file_data *
26884 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
26886 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
26888 if (!file_name)
26889 return NULL;
26891 dwarf_file_data **slot
26892 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
26893 INSERT);
26894 if (*slot)
26895 return *slot;
26897 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
26898 created->filename = file_name;
26899 created->emitted_number = 0;
26900 *slot = created;
26901 return created;
26904 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
26905 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
26906 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
26907 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
26908 types, which may include filenames. */
26910 static int
26911 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
26913 if (! fd->emitted_number)
26915 if (last_emitted_file)
26916 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
26917 else
26918 fd->emitted_number = 1;
26919 last_emitted_file = fd;
26921 if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
26923 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
26924 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
26925 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
26926 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
26930 return fd->emitted_number;
26933 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
26934 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
26935 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
26937 static void
26938 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
26940 die_arg_entry entry;
26942 if (!die || !arg)
26943 return;
26945 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26947 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26948 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
26950 entry.die = die;
26951 entry.arg = arg;
26952 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
26955 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
26956 otherwise. */
26958 static bool
26959 generic_type_p (tree t)
26961 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
26962 return false;
26963 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
26966 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
26967 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
26968 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
26970 static void
26971 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
26973 if (!generic_type_p (t))
26974 return;
26976 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
26978 if (!generic_type_instances)
26979 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
26981 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
26984 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
26985 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
26986 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
26988 static void
26989 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
26991 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
26993 unsigned i, j;
26994 die_arg_entry *e;
26996 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
26997 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
26998 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
26999 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
27000 For those we try again at late-finish. */
27001 j = 0;
27002 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
27004 if (!e->die->removed
27005 && !tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
27007 dw_loc_descr_ref loc = NULL;
27008 if (! early_dwarf
27009 && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
27010 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (e->arg, 2, NULL);
27011 if (loc)
27012 add_AT_loc (e->die, DW_AT_location, loc);
27013 else
27014 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
27017 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
27021 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
27022 that have been previously scheduled by
27023 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
27024 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
27026 static void
27027 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
27029 unsigned i;
27030 tree t;
27032 if (!generic_type_instances)
27033 return;
27035 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
27036 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
27037 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
27039 generic_type_instances = NULL;
27043 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
27045 static void
27046 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
27048 dw_die_ref die;
27049 dw_attr_node *attr;
27050 const char *dname;
27052 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
27053 if (!die)
27054 return;
27056 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
27057 if (!dname)
27058 return;
27060 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
27061 if (attr)
27063 struct indirect_string_node *node;
27065 node = find_AT_string (dname);
27066 /* replace the string. */
27067 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
27070 else
27071 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
27074 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
27075 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
27076 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
27077 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
27078 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
27079 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
27080 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
27082 /* Look ahead for a real insn, or for a begin stmt marker. */
27084 static rtx_insn *
27085 dwarf2out_next_real_insn (rtx_insn *loc_note)
27087 rtx_insn *next_real = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
27089 while (next_real)
27090 if (INSN_P (next_real))
27091 break;
27092 else
27093 next_real = NEXT_INSN (next_real);
27095 return next_real;
27098 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
27099 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
27100 our lookup table. */
27102 static void
27103 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
27105 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
27106 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
27107 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
27108 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
27109 static const char *last_label;
27110 static const char *last_postcall_label;
27111 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
27112 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
27113 tree decl;
27114 bool var_loc_p;
27115 var_loc_view view = 0;
27117 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
27119 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
27121 maybe_reset_location_view (loc_note, cur_line_info_table);
27122 call_site_count++;
27123 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27124 tail_call_site_count++;
27125 if (find_reg_note (loc_note, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, NULL_RTX))
27127 call_insn = loc_note;
27128 loc_note = NULL;
27129 var_loc_p = false;
27131 next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (call_insn);
27132 next_note = NULL;
27133 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27134 goto create_label;
27136 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
27138 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
27139 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
27140 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
27141 sites for them anyway. */
27142 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
27143 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
27144 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
27145 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
27146 x = SET_SRC (x);
27147 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
27148 x = XEXP (x, 0);
27149 if (!MEM_P (x)
27150 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
27151 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
27152 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
27153 != FUNCTION_DECL))
27155 call_insn = loc_note;
27156 loc_note = NULL;
27157 var_loc_p = false;
27159 next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (call_insn);
27160 next_note = NULL;
27161 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27162 goto create_label;
27166 else if (!debug_variable_location_views)
27167 gcc_unreachable ();
27168 else
27169 maybe_reset_location_view (loc_note, cur_line_info_table);
27171 return;
27174 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
27175 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
27176 return;
27178 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
27179 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
27180 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
27181 calculation for next time. */
27182 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
27183 if (next_real)
27185 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
27186 next_real = NULL;
27189 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
27190 if (! next_note
27191 || next_note->deleted ()
27192 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
27193 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
27194 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_BEGIN_STMT
27195 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_INLINE_ENTRY))
27196 next_note = NULL;
27198 if (! next_real)
27199 next_real = dwarf2out_next_real_insn (loc_note);
27201 if (next_note)
27203 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
27204 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
27206 else
27207 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27209 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
27210 don't do anything. */
27211 if (var_loc_p
27212 && next_real == NULL_RTX
27213 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27214 return;
27216 create_label:
27218 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
27219 next_real = get_last_insn ();
27221 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
27222 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
27223 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
27224 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
27225 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
27226 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
27228 last_label = NULL;
27229 last_postcall_label = NULL;
27232 if (var_loc_p)
27234 const char *label
27235 = NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note) ? last_postcall_label : last_label;
27236 view = cur_line_info_table->view;
27237 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
27238 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note, label, view);
27239 if (newloc == NULL)
27240 return;
27242 else
27244 decl = NULL_TREE;
27245 newloc = NULL;
27248 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
27249 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
27250 create a new label and emit it. */
27251 if (last_label == NULL)
27253 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
27254 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
27255 loclabel_num++;
27256 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
27257 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
27258 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
27259 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
27260 && in_first_function_p
27261 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
27263 static rtx_insn *last_start;
27264 rtx_insn *insn;
27265 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
27266 if (insn == last_start)
27267 break;
27268 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
27269 continue;
27270 else
27272 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
27273 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
27274 continue;
27275 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
27276 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
27277 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
27278 continue;
27279 #ifdef HAVE_ATTR_length /* ??? We don't include insn-attr.h. */
27280 else if (HAVE_ATTR_length && get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
27281 continue;
27282 #endif
27283 else
27285 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
27286 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
27287 break;
27290 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
27292 last_start = loc_note;
27293 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
27298 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
27299 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
27301 if (!var_loc_p)
27303 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
27304 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
27305 rtx_insn *prev = call_insn;
27307 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note
27308 = find_reg_note (call_insn, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, NULL_RTX);
27309 ca_loc->next = NULL;
27310 ca_loc->label = last_label;
27311 gcc_assert (prev
27312 && (CALL_P (prev)
27313 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
27314 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
27315 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
27316 if (!CALL_P (prev))
27317 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
27318 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
27320 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
27321 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
27322 if (x)
27324 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
27325 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
27326 x = XEXP (x, 0);
27327 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
27328 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
27329 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
27330 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
27331 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
27332 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
27333 declaration. */
27334 else if (MEM_P (x)
27335 && MEM_EXPR (x)
27336 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
27337 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
27340 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
27341 if (call_arg_locations)
27342 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
27343 else
27344 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
27345 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
27347 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
27349 newloc->label = last_label;
27350 newloc->view = view;
27352 else
27354 if (!last_postcall_label)
27356 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
27357 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
27359 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
27360 /* ??? This view is at last_label, not last_label-1, but we
27361 could only assume view at last_label-1 is zero if we could
27362 assume calls always have length greater than one. This is
27363 probably true in general, though there might be a rare
27364 exception to this rule, e.g. if a call insn is optimized out
27365 by target magic. Then, even the -1 in the label will be
27366 wrong, which might invalidate the range. Anyway, using view,
27367 though technically possibly incorrect, will work as far as
27368 ranges go: since L-1 is in the middle of the call insn,
27369 (L-1).0 and (L-1).V shouldn't make any difference, and having
27370 the loclist entry refer to the .loc entry might be useful, so
27371 leave it like this. */
27372 newloc->view = view;
27375 if (var_loc_p && flag_debug_asm)
27377 const char *name, *sep, *patstr;
27378 if (decl && DECL_NAME (decl))
27379 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl));
27380 else
27381 name = "";
27382 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
27384 sep = " => ";
27385 patstr = str_pattern_slim (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note));
27387 else
27389 sep = " ";
27390 patstr = "RESET";
27392 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s DEBUG %s%s%s\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27393 name, sep, patstr);
27396 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
27397 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
27400 /* Check whether BLOCK, a lexical block, is nested within OUTER, or is
27401 OUTER itself. If BOTHWAYS, check not only that BLOCK can reach
27402 OUTER through BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT links, but also that there is a
27403 path from OUTER to BLOCK through BLOCK_SUBBLOCKs and
27404 BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN links. */
27405 static bool
27406 block_within_block_p (tree block, tree outer, bool bothways)
27408 if (block == outer)
27409 return true;
27411 /* Quickly check that OUTER is up BLOCK's supercontext chain. */
27412 for (tree context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
27413 context != outer;
27414 context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (context))
27415 if (!context || TREE_CODE (context) != BLOCK)
27416 return false;
27418 if (!bothways)
27419 return true;
27421 /* Now check that each block is actually referenced by its
27422 parent. */
27423 for (tree context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block); ;
27424 context = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (context))
27426 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (context))
27428 gcc_assert (!BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (context));
27429 context = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (context);
27431 for (tree sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (context);
27432 sub != block;
27433 sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
27434 if (!sub)
27435 return false;
27436 if (context == outer)
27437 return true;
27438 else
27439 block = context;
27443 /* Called during final while assembling the marker of the entry point
27444 for an inlined function. */
27446 static void
27447 dwarf2out_inline_entry (tree block)
27449 gcc_assert (debug_inline_points);
27451 /* If we can't represent it, don't bother. */
27452 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
27453 return;
27455 gcc_assert (DECL_P (block_ultimate_origin (block)));
27457 /* Sanity check the block tree. This would catch a case in which
27458 BLOCK got removed from the tree reachable from the outermost
27459 lexical block, but got retained in markers. It would still link
27460 back to its parents, but some ancestor would be missing a link
27461 down the path to the sub BLOCK. If the block got removed, its
27462 BLOCK_NUMBER will not be a usable value. */
27463 if (flag_checking)
27464 gcc_assert (block_within_block_p (block,
27465 DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl),
27466 true));
27468 gcc_assert (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (block));
27469 gcc_assert (!BLOCK_DIE (block));
27471 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block))
27472 block = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block);
27473 /* Can the entry point ever not be at the beginning of an
27474 unfragmented lexical block? */
27475 else if (!(BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (block)
27476 || (cur_line_info_table
27477 && !ZERO_VIEW_P (cur_line_info_table->view))))
27478 return;
27480 if (!inline_entry_data_table)
27481 inline_entry_data_table
27482 = hash_table<inline_entry_data_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
27485 inline_entry_data **iedp
27486 = inline_entry_data_table->find_slot_with_hash (block,
27487 htab_hash_pointer (block),
27488 INSERT);
27489 if (*iedp)
27490 /* ??? Ideally, we'd record all entry points for the same inlined
27491 function (some may have been duplicated by e.g. unrolling), but
27492 we have no way to represent that ATM. */
27493 return;
27495 inline_entry_data *ied = *iedp = ggc_cleared_alloc<inline_entry_data> ();
27496 ied->block = block;
27497 ied->label_pfx = BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL;
27498 ied->label_num = BLOCK_NUMBER (block);
27499 if (cur_line_info_table)
27500 ied->view = cur_line_info_table->view;
27502 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27504 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_INLINE_ENTRY_LABEL,
27505 BLOCK_NUMBER (block));
27506 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
27509 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
27510 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
27511 structures. */
27513 static void
27514 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
27516 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
27519 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
27522 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
27524 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
27525 if (list->first)
27526 list->last_before_switch
27527 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
27528 return 1;
27531 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
27533 static void
27534 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
27536 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
27537 return;
27539 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
27542 /* Create a new line number table. */
27544 static dw_line_info_table *
27545 new_line_info_table (void)
27547 dw_line_info_table *table;
27549 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
27550 table->file_num = 1;
27551 table->line_num = 1;
27552 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
27553 FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW (table->view);
27554 table->symviews_since_reset = 0;
27556 return table;
27559 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
27560 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
27562 static void
27563 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
27565 dw_line_info_table *table;
27567 if (sec == text_section)
27568 table = text_section_line_info;
27569 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
27571 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
27572 if (!table)
27574 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
27575 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
27578 else
27580 const char *end_label;
27582 if (crtl->has_bb_partition)
27584 if (in_cold_section_p)
27585 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
27586 else
27587 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
27589 else
27591 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27592 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
27593 current_function_funcdef_no);
27594 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
27597 table = new_line_info_table ();
27598 table->end_label = end_label;
27600 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
27603 if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
27604 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
27605 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
27606 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
27607 cur_line_info_table = table;
27611 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
27612 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
27613 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
27614 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
27616 static void
27617 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
27619 section *sec = function_section (fun);
27621 if (sec != text_section)
27622 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
27624 if (crtl->has_bb_partition && !cold_text_section)
27626 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
27627 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
27628 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
27629 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
27630 switch_to_section (sec);
27633 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
27634 call_site_count = 0;
27635 tail_call_site_count = 0;
27637 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
27638 FORCE_RESET_NEXT_VIEW (cur_line_info_table->view);
27641 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
27642 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
27643 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
27644 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
27645 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
27646 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
27647 list terminator.
27648 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
27649 terminate htab traversal. */
27652 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
27654 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
27655 struct var_loc_node *node;
27657 node = entry->first;
27658 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
27660 unsigned int i;
27661 const char *label = node->next->label;
27662 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27664 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
27666 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
27667 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
27669 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
27670 return 0;
27674 return 1;
27677 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
27678 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
27680 static void
27681 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
27683 if (in_first_function_p
27684 && !have_multiple_function_sections
27685 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
27686 && decl_loc_table)
27687 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
27688 in_first_function_p = false;
27689 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
27692 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
27693 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
27694 called. */
27695 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
27697 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
27698 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
27700 static void
27701 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
27703 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
27704 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
27705 main_translation_unit = unit;
27706 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
27707 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
27708 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
27709 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
27712 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
27714 static void
27715 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
27716 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
27718 dw_line_info_entry e;
27719 e.opcode = opcode;
27720 e.val = val;
27721 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
27724 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
27725 and record information relating to this source line, in
27726 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
27727 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
27729 static void
27730 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, unsigned int column,
27731 const char *filename,
27732 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
27734 unsigned int file_num;
27735 dw_line_info_table *table;
27736 static var_loc_view lvugid;
27738 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27739 return;
27741 table = cur_line_info_table;
27743 if (line == 0)
27745 if (debug_variable_location_views
27746 && output_asm_line_debug_info ()
27747 && table && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27749 /* If we're using the assembler to compute view numbers, we
27750 can't issue a .loc directive for line zero, so we can't
27751 get a view number at this point. We might attempt to
27752 compute it from the previous view, or equate it to a
27753 subsequent view (though it might not be there!), but
27754 since we're omitting the line number entry, we might as
27755 well omit the view number as well. That means pretending
27756 it's a view number zero, which might very well turn out
27757 to be correct. ??? Extend the assembler so that the
27758 compiler could emit e.g. ".locview .LVU#", to output a
27759 view without changing line number information. We'd then
27760 have to count it in symviews_since_reset; when it's omitted,
27761 it doesn't count. */
27762 if (!zero_view_p)
27763 zero_view_p = BITMAP_GGC_ALLOC ();
27764 bitmap_set_bit (zero_view_p, table->view);
27765 if (flag_debug_asm)
27767 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27768 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", table->view);
27769 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s line 0, omitted view ",
27770 ASM_COMMENT_START);
27771 assemble_name (asm_out_file, label);
27772 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27774 table->view = ++lvugid;
27776 return;
27779 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
27780 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
27781 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
27782 discriminator = 0;
27784 if (!debug_column_info)
27785 column = 0;
27787 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
27789 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
27790 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
27791 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
27792 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
27793 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
27794 that second line number entry. */
27795 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
27796 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
27797 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
27798 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
27799 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
27800 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
27801 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
27803 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
27804 && line == table->line_num
27805 && column == table->column_num
27806 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
27807 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
27808 return;
27810 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
27812 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
27813 if (flag_debug_asm)
27815 if (debug_column_info)
27816 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27817 filename, line, column);
27818 else
27819 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
27820 filename, line);
27823 if (output_asm_line_debug_info ())
27825 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
27826 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
27827 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
27828 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
27829 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
27830 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
27831 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
27832 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
27833 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, column);
27835 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
27837 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
27838 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
27840 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
27842 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
27843 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
27844 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
27846 if (debug_variable_location_views)
27848 if (!RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27850 table->symviews_since_reset++;
27851 if (table->symviews_since_reset > symview_upper_bound)
27852 symview_upper_bound = table->symviews_since_reset;
27853 /* When we're using the assembler to compute view
27854 numbers, we output symbolic labels after "view" in
27855 .loc directives, and the assembler will set them for
27856 us, so that we can refer to the view numbers in
27857 location lists. The only exceptions are when we know
27858 a view will be zero: "-0" is a forced reset, used
27859 e.g. in the beginning of functions, whereas "0" tells
27860 the assembler to check that there was a PC change
27861 since the previous view, in a way that implicitly
27862 resets the next view. */
27863 fputs (" view ", asm_out_file);
27864 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
27865 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LVU", table->view);
27866 assemble_name (asm_out_file, label);
27867 table->view = ++lvugid;
27869 else
27871 table->symviews_since_reset = 0;
27872 if (FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27873 fputs (" view -0", asm_out_file);
27874 else
27875 fputs (" view 0", asm_out_file);
27876 /* Mark the present view as a zero view. Earlier debug
27877 binds may have already added its id to loclists to be
27878 emitted later, so we can't reuse the id for something
27879 else. However, it's good to know whether a view is
27880 known to be zero, because then we may be able to
27881 optimize out locviews that are all zeros, so take
27882 note of it in zero_view_p. */
27883 if (!zero_view_p)
27884 zero_view_p = BITMAP_GGC_ALLOC ();
27885 bitmap_set_bit (zero_view_p, lvugid);
27886 table->view = ++lvugid;
27889 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
27891 else
27893 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
27895 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
27897 if (debug_variable_location_views && !RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view))
27898 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_adv_address, label_num);
27899 else
27900 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
27901 if (debug_variable_location_views)
27903 bool resetting = FORCE_RESETTING_VIEW_P (table->view);
27904 if (resetting)
27905 table->view = 0;
27907 if (flag_debug_asm)
27908 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s view %s%d\n",
27909 ASM_COMMENT_START,
27910 resetting ? "-" : "",
27911 table->view);
27913 table->view++;
27915 if (file_num != table->file_num)
27916 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
27917 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
27918 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
27919 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
27920 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
27921 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
27922 if (debug_column_info)
27923 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_column, column);
27926 table->file_num = file_num;
27927 table->line_num = line;
27928 table->column_num = column;
27929 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
27930 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
27931 table->in_use = true;
27934 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
27936 static void
27937 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
27939 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27941 macinfo_entry e;
27942 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
27943 e.lineno = lineno;
27944 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
27945 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
27949 /* Record the end of a source file. */
27951 static void
27952 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27954 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27956 macinfo_entry e;
27957 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
27958 e.lineno = lineno;
27959 e.info = NULL;
27960 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
27964 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
27965 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
27966 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
27968 static void
27969 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
27970 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27972 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
27974 macinfo_entry e;
27975 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
27976 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
27977 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
27979 e.code = 0;
27980 e.lineno = 0;
27981 e.info = NULL;
27982 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
27984 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
27985 e.lineno = lineno;
27986 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
27987 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
27991 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
27992 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
27993 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
27995 static void
27996 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
27997 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
27999 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28001 macinfo_entry e;
28002 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
28003 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_import. */
28004 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
28006 e.code = 0;
28007 e.lineno = 0;
28008 e.info = NULL;
28009 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28011 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
28012 e.lineno = lineno;
28013 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
28014 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
28018 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
28020 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
28022 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
28023 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
28026 inline hashval_t
28027 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
28029 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
28032 inline bool
28033 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
28034 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
28036 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
28039 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
28041 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
28043 static void
28044 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
28046 int file_num;
28047 size_t len;
28048 struct indirect_string_node *node;
28049 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28050 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
28052 switch (ref->code)
28054 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
28055 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
28056 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
28057 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
28058 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
28059 "Included from line number %lu",
28060 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28061 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
28062 break;
28063 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
28064 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
28065 break;
28066 case DW_MACINFO_define:
28067 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28068 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
28069 if (!dwarf_strict
28070 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
28071 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
28072 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
28074 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
28075 ? DW_MACRO_define_strp : DW_MACRO_undef_strp;
28076 output_macinfo_op (ref);
28077 return;
28079 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
28080 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
28081 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
28082 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
28083 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28084 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
28085 break;
28086 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
28087 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
28088 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
28089 gcc_assert (node
28090 && (node->form == DW_FORM_strp
28091 || node->form == dwarf_form (DW_FORM_strx)));
28092 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
28093 ref->code == DW_MACRO_define_strp
28094 ? "Define macro strp"
28095 : "Undefine macro strp");
28096 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
28097 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
28098 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
28099 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
28100 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
28101 ref->info);
28102 else
28103 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
28104 ref->info);
28105 break;
28106 case DW_MACRO_import:
28107 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Import");
28108 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
28109 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
28110 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
28111 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
28112 break;
28113 default:
28114 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
28115 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
28116 break;
28120 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
28121 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
28122 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
28123 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
28124 a DW_MACRO_import entry referencing it.
28125 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
28127 static unsigned
28128 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
28129 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
28131 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
28132 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
28133 unsigned char checksum[16];
28134 struct md5_ctx ctx;
28135 char *grp_name, *tail;
28136 const char *base;
28137 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
28138 macinfo_entry **slot;
28140 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
28141 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
28143 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
28144 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
28145 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
28146 in some included header file. */
28147 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
28148 return 0;
28149 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28151 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
28152 return 0;
28154 else if (first->lineno == 0)
28155 return 0;
28157 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
28158 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
28159 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
28160 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
28161 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
28162 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
28163 break;
28164 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
28165 break;
28166 else
28168 unsigned char code = cur->code;
28169 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
28170 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
28171 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
28173 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
28174 count = i - idx;
28176 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
28177 usable characters from its basename. */
28178 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28179 base = "";
28180 else
28181 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
28182 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
28183 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
28184 encoded_filename_len++;
28185 /* Count . at the end. */
28186 if (encoded_filename_len)
28187 encoded_filename_len++;
28189 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
28190 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
28192 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
28193 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
28194 + 16 * 2 + 1);
28195 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
28196 tail = grp_name + 4;
28197 if (encoded_filename_len)
28199 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
28200 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
28201 *tail++ = base[i];
28202 *tail++ = '.';
28204 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
28205 tail += linebuf_len;
28206 *tail++ = '.';
28207 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
28208 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
28210 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_import
28211 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
28212 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
28213 inc->code = DW_MACRO_import;
28214 inc->lineno = 0;
28215 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
28216 if (!*macinfo_htab)
28217 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
28218 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
28219 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
28220 if (*slot != NULL)
28222 inc->code = 0;
28223 inc->info = NULL;
28224 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
28225 a DW_MACRO_import op. */
28226 inc = *slot;
28227 output_macinfo_op (inc);
28228 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
28229 in the second pass. */
28230 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
28232 cur->code = 0;
28233 cur->info = NULL;
28236 else
28238 *slot = inc;
28239 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
28240 output_macinfo_op (inc);
28242 return count;
28245 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
28246 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
28247 index_string is called. */
28249 static void
28250 save_macinfo_strings (void)
28252 unsigned len;
28253 unsigned i;
28254 macinfo_entry *ref;
28256 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28258 switch (ref->code)
28260 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
28261 indirect strings. */
28262 case DW_MACINFO_define:
28263 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28264 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
28265 if (!dwarf_strict
28266 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
28267 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
28268 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
28269 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
28270 break;
28271 case DW_MACRO_define_strp:
28272 case DW_MACRO_undef_strp:
28273 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
28274 break;
28275 default:
28276 break;
28281 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
28283 static void
28284 output_macinfo (const char *debug_line_label, bool early_lto_debug)
28286 unsigned i;
28287 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
28288 macinfo_entry *ref;
28289 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
28290 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
28291 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28293 if (! length)
28294 return;
28296 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
28297 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_define
28298 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_undef
28299 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_start_file
28300 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_end_file);
28302 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
28303 offset expected by debuggers. */
28304 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_label);
28305 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
28306 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
28308 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
28309 if (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28311 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
28312 "DWARF macro version number");
28313 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
28314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
28315 else
28316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
28317 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_line_label,
28318 debug_line_section, NULL);
28321 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
28322 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
28323 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
28324 DW_MACRO_import, the DW_MACRO_import op is emitted and kept in
28325 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
28326 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
28327 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28329 switch (ref->code)
28331 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
28332 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
28333 break;
28334 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
28335 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
28336 files->pop ();
28337 break;
28338 case DW_MACINFO_define:
28339 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28340 if ((!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
28341 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
28342 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
28343 && i > 0
28344 && i + 1 < length
28345 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
28347 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
28348 if (count)
28350 i += count - 1;
28351 continue;
28354 break;
28355 case 0:
28356 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
28357 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
28358 if (i == 0)
28359 continue;
28360 default:
28361 break;
28363 output_macinfo_op (ref);
28364 ref->info = NULL;
28365 ref->code = 0;
28368 if (!macinfo_htab)
28369 return;
28371 /* Save the number of transparent includes so we can adjust the
28372 label number for the fat LTO object DWARF. */
28373 unsigned macinfo_label_base_adj = macinfo_htab->elements ();
28375 delete macinfo_htab;
28376 macinfo_htab = NULL;
28378 /* If any DW_MACRO_import were used, on those DW_MACRO_import entries
28379 terminate the current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
28380 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
28381 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
28382 switch (ref->code)
28384 case 0:
28385 continue;
28386 case DW_MACRO_import:
28388 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
28389 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
28390 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
28391 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
28392 targetm.asm_out.named_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28393 SECTION_DEBUG
28394 | SECTION_LINKONCE
28395 | (early_lto_debug
28396 ? SECTION_EXCLUDE : 0),
28397 comdat_key);
28398 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
28399 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
28400 ref->lineno + macinfo_label_base);
28401 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
28402 ref->code = 0;
28403 ref->info = NULL;
28404 dw2_asm_output_data (2, dwarf_version >= 5 ? 5 : 4,
28405 "DWARF macro version number");
28406 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
28407 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
28408 else
28409 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
28411 break;
28412 case DW_MACINFO_define:
28413 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
28414 output_macinfo_op (ref);
28415 ref->code = 0;
28416 ref->info = NULL;
28417 break;
28418 default:
28419 gcc_unreachable ();
28422 macinfo_label_base += macinfo_label_base_adj;
28425 /* Initialize the various sections and labels for dwarf output and prefix
28426 them with PREFIX if non-NULL. Returns the generation (zero based
28427 number of times function was called). */
28429 static unsigned
28430 init_sections_and_labels (bool early_lto_debug)
28432 /* As we may get called multiple times have a generation count for
28433 labels. */
28434 static unsigned generation = 0;
28436 if (early_lto_debug)
28438 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28440 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
28441 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28442 NULL);
28443 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28444 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28445 NULL);
28446 debug_macinfo_section_name
28447 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28448 ? DEBUG_LTO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_MACRO_SECTION);
28449 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28450 SECTION_DEBUG
28451 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28453 else
28455 /* ??? Which of the following do we need early? */
28456 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
28457 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28458 NULL);
28459 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28460 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28461 NULL);
28462 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_INFO_SECTION,
28463 SECTION_DEBUG
28464 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28465 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section
28466 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28467 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28468 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
28469 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
28470 generation);
28472 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
28473 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split
28474 off dwo. */
28475 debug_skeleton_line_section
28476 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
28477 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28478 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
28479 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
28480 generation);
28481 debug_str_offsets_section
28482 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
28483 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28484 NULL);
28485 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
28486 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
28487 generation);
28488 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_DWO_SECTION,
28489 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
28490 NULL);
28491 debug_macinfo_section_name
28492 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28493 ? DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_LTO_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
28494 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28495 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28496 NULL);
28498 /* For macro info and the file table we have to refer to a
28499 debug_line section. */
28500 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_SECTION,
28501 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28502 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
28503 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28505 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_STR_SECTION,
28506 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
28507 | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28508 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !dwarf2out_as_loc_support)
28509 debug_line_str_section
28510 = get_section (DEBUG_LTO_LINE_STR_SECTION,
28511 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28513 else
28515 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28517 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
28518 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28519 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
28520 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28521 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28522 ? DEBUG_LOCLISTS_SECTION
28523 : DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
28524 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28525 debug_macinfo_section_name
28526 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28527 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION);
28528 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28529 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28531 else
28533 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
28534 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28535 NULL);
28536 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
28537 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28538 NULL);
28539 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
28540 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28541 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
28542 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28543 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
28544 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28545 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
28546 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL,
28547 generation);
28549 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections
28550 stay in the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the
28551 split off dwo. */
28552 debug_skeleton_line_section
28553 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
28554 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28555 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
28556 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL,
28557 generation);
28558 debug_str_offsets_section
28559 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
28560 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
28561 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
28562 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL,
28563 generation);
28564 debug_loc_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28565 ? DEBUG_DWO_LOCLISTS_SECTION
28566 : DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
28567 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28568 NULL);
28569 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
28570 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS,
28571 NULL);
28572 debug_macinfo_section_name
28573 = ((dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28574 ? DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION : DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION);
28575 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (debug_macinfo_section_name,
28576 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
28577 NULL);
28579 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
28580 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28581 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
28582 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28583 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
28584 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28585 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
28586 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28587 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
28588 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
28589 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info && !output_asm_line_debug_info ())
28590 debug_line_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_STR_SECTION,
28591 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
28593 debug_ranges_section = get_section (dwarf_version >= 5
28594 ? DEBUG_RNGLISTS_SECTION
28595 : DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
28596 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28597 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
28598 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
28601 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
28602 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28603 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
28604 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28605 info_section_emitted = false;
28606 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
28607 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28608 /* There are up to 4 unique ranges labels per generation.
28609 See also output_rnglists. */
28610 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
28611 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, generation * 4);
28612 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
28613 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_base_label,
28614 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL,
28615 1 + generation * 4);
28616 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
28617 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28618 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
28619 (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
28620 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
28621 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, generation);
28622 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL,
28623 generation);
28625 ++generation;
28626 return generation - 1;
28629 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
28631 static void
28632 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
28634 /* Allocate the file_table. */
28635 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
28637 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28638 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
28639 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28641 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
28642 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28644 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
28645 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
28647 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
28648 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
28650 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
28651 vec_alloc (abbrev_die_table, 256);
28652 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
28653 abbrev_die_table->quick_push (NULL);
28655 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
28656 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
28658 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
28659 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
28660 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
28662 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
28664 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
28666 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
28667 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
28668 #endif
28670 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
28671 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
28672 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
28673 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
28676 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
28677 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
28679 static void
28680 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
28682 if (text_section_line_info)
28683 return;
28685 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28686 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
28687 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
28688 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
28689 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
28690 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
28692 switch_to_section (text_section);
28693 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
28694 #endif
28696 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
28697 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
28698 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
28700 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
28701 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
28702 #endif
28704 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
28705 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
28706 && !dwarf2out_do_eh_frame ())
28707 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
28710 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28711 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
28712 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
28713 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
28714 in the same order for each run. */
28717 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
28719 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28721 find_string_form (node);
28722 if (node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx) && node->refcount > 0)
28724 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
28725 node->index = *index;
28726 *index += 1;
28728 return 1;
28731 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
28732 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
28733 current offset. */
28736 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
28738 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28740 if (node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx) && node->refcount > 0)
28742 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
28743 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
28744 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
28745 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
28746 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
28747 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
28749 return 1;
28752 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28753 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
28756 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
28758 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28760 if (node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx) && node->refcount > 0)
28762 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
28763 indexes were assigned. */
28764 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
28765 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
28766 *cur_idx += 1;
28768 return 1;
28771 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings. Counts the number
28772 of index strings offsets. Must match the logic of the functions
28773 output_index_string[_offsets] above. */
28775 count_index_strings (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *last_idx)
28777 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28779 if (node->form == dwarf_FORM (DW_FORM_strx) && node->refcount > 0)
28780 *last_idx += 1;
28781 return 1;
28784 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
28785 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
28788 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, enum dwarf_form form)
28790 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
28792 node->form = find_string_form (node);
28793 if (node->form == form && node->refcount > 0)
28795 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
28796 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
28799 return 1;
28802 /* Output the indexed string table. */
28804 static void
28805 output_indirect_strings (void)
28807 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
28808 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
28809 debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
28810 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
28811 else
28813 unsigned int offset = 0;
28814 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
28816 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
28817 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
28818 output_indirect_string> (DW_FORM_strp);
28820 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
28821 /* For DWARF5 the .debug_str_offsets[.dwo] section needs a unit
28822 header. Note that we don't need to generate a label to the
28823 actual index table following the header here, because this is
28824 for the split dwarf case only. In an .dwo file there is only
28825 one string offsets table (and one debug info section). But
28826 if we would start using string offset tables for the main (or
28827 skeleton) unit, then we have to add a DW_AT_str_offsets_base
28828 pointing to the actual index after the header. Split dwarf
28829 units will never have a string offsets base attribute. When
28830 a split unit is moved into a .dwp file the string offsets can
28831 be found through the .debug_cu_index section table. */
28832 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
28834 unsigned int last_idx = 0;
28835 unsigned long str_offsets_length;
28837 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
28838 <unsigned int *, count_index_strings> (&last_idx);
28839 str_offsets_length = last_idx * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4;
28840 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
28841 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
28842 "Escape value for 64-bit DWARF extension");
28843 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, str_offsets_length,
28844 "Length of string offsets unit");
28845 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 5, "DWARF string offsets version");
28846 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Header zero padding");
28848 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
28849 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
28850 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
28851 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
28852 (&cur_idx);
28856 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
28857 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
28860 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
28862 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
28864 if (entry->refcount == 0)
28866 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
28867 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
28868 return 1;
28871 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
28872 (*cur_index)++;
28874 switch (entry->kind)
28876 case ate_kind_rtx:
28877 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
28878 "0x%x", entry->index);
28879 break;
28880 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
28881 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
28882 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
28883 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
28884 entry->addr.rtl);
28885 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
28886 break;
28887 case ate_kind_label:
28888 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
28889 "0x%x", entry->index);
28890 break;
28891 default:
28892 gcc_unreachable ();
28894 return 1;
28897 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish. Counts the number
28898 of indexed addresses. Must match the logic of the functions
28899 output_addr_table_entry above. */
28901 count_index_addrs (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *last_idx)
28903 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
28905 if (entry->refcount > 0)
28906 *last_idx += 1;
28907 return 1;
28910 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
28912 static void
28913 output_addr_table (void)
28915 unsigned int index = 0;
28916 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
28917 return;
28919 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
28920 addr_index_table
28921 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
28924 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
28925 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
28927 static void
28928 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
28930 dw_die_ref c;
28932 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
28933 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
28935 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
28937 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
28938 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
28940 static void
28941 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
28943 dw_die_ref c;
28945 if (die->die_mark)
28946 die->die_mark = 0;
28947 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
28950 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
28951 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
28953 static void
28954 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
28956 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
28957 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
28959 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
28960 case DW_OP_convert:
28961 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
28962 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
28963 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
28964 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
28965 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
28966 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
28967 break;
28968 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
28969 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
28971 dw_die_ref ref
28972 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
28973 if (ref == NULL)
28974 break;
28975 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
28976 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
28977 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
28979 /* FALLTHRU */
28980 case DW_OP_call2:
28981 case DW_OP_call4:
28982 case DW_OP_call_ref:
28983 case DW_OP_const_type:
28984 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
28985 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
28986 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
28987 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
28988 break;
28989 case DW_OP_regval_type:
28990 case DW_OP_deref_type:
28991 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
28992 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
28993 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
28994 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
28995 break;
28996 case DW_OP_entry_value:
28997 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
28998 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
28999 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
29000 break;
29001 default:
29002 break;
29006 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
29007 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
29009 static void
29010 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
29012 dw_attr_node *a;
29013 unsigned ix;
29015 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29017 switch (AT_class (a))
29019 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
29020 get emitted. */
29021 case dw_val_class_loc:
29022 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
29023 break;
29024 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
29025 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
29026 list != NULL;
29027 list = list->dw_loc_next)
29028 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
29029 break;
29031 case dw_val_class_view_list:
29032 /* This points to a loc_list in another attribute, so it's
29033 already covered. */
29034 break;
29036 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
29037 /* A reference to another DIE.
29038 Make sure that it will get emitted.
29039 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
29040 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
29041 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
29042 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
29043 break;
29045 case dw_val_class_str:
29046 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
29047 accounts properly for it. */
29048 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
29049 break;
29051 default:
29052 break;
29057 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
29059 static void
29060 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
29062 dw_die_ref c;
29064 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
29065 return;
29066 c = die->die_child;
29069 if (is_template_parameter (c))
29070 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
29071 c = c->die_sib;
29072 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
29075 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
29076 to DIE's children. */
29078 static void
29079 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
29081 dw_die_ref c;
29083 if (die->die_mark == 0)
29085 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
29086 die->die_mark = 1;
29087 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
29088 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
29089 args. */
29090 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
29092 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
29093 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
29094 unless it is a class.) */
29095 if (die->die_parent)
29096 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
29097 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
29099 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
29100 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
29102 /* If this node is a specification,
29103 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
29104 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
29105 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
29108 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
29110 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
29111 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
29112 die->die_mark = 2;
29114 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
29115 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
29116 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
29117 for all type definitions. */
29118 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
29119 || (use_debug_types
29120 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
29121 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
29122 else
29123 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
29127 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
29128 and if so, mark them. */
29130 static void
29131 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
29133 dw_die_ref c;
29135 if (die->die_mark == 2)
29136 return;
29138 switch (die->die_tag)
29140 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
29141 case DW_TAG_union_type:
29142 case DW_TAG_class_type:
29143 break;
29145 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
29146 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
29147 || die->die_definition != NULL)
29148 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
29149 return;
29151 default:
29152 return;
29155 /* Mark children. */
29156 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
29159 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
29161 static void
29162 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
29164 dw_die_ref c;
29166 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
29167 children have been marked as well. */
29168 if (die->die_mark == 2)
29169 return;
29171 switch (die->die_tag)
29173 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
29174 case DW_TAG_union_type:
29175 case DW_TAG_class_type:
29176 if (die->die_perennial_p)
29177 break;
29179 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
29180 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
29181 break;
29183 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
29184 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
29185 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
29186 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
29187 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
29188 if (c)
29189 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
29191 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
29192 return;
29194 case DW_TAG_const_type:
29195 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
29196 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
29197 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
29198 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
29199 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
29200 case DW_TAG_typedef:
29201 case DW_TAG_array_type:
29202 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
29203 case DW_TAG_friend:
29204 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
29205 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
29206 case DW_TAG_string_type:
29207 case DW_TAG_set_type:
29208 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
29209 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
29210 case DW_TAG_file_type:
29211 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
29212 mark them. */
29213 /* FALLTHROUGH */
29215 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
29216 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
29218 if (die->die_perennial_p)
29219 break;
29221 return;
29223 default:
29224 /* Mark everything else. */
29225 break;
29228 if (die->die_mark == 0)
29230 die->die_mark = 1;
29232 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
29233 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
29236 die->die_mark = 2;
29238 /* Mark children. */
29239 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
29242 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
29243 attributes. */
29245 static void
29246 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
29248 dw_attr_node *a;
29249 unsigned ix;
29251 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
29252 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
29254 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
29255 s->refcount++;
29256 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
29257 twice in the hash table. */
29258 if (s->refcount
29259 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
29261 indirect_string_node **slot
29262 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
29263 htab_hash_string (s->str),
29264 INSERT);
29265 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
29266 *slot = s;
29271 /* Mark DIE and its children as removed. */
29273 static void
29274 mark_removed (dw_die_ref die)
29276 dw_die_ref c;
29277 die->removed = true;
29278 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_removed (c));
29281 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
29283 static void
29284 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
29286 dw_die_ref c;
29288 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
29289 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
29291 if (! die->die_child)
29292 return;
29294 c = die->die_child;
29295 do {
29296 dw_die_ref prev = c, next;
29297 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = next)
29298 if (c == die->die_child)
29300 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
29301 if (prev == c)
29302 /* No marked children at all. */
29303 die->die_child = NULL;
29304 else
29306 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
29307 die->die_child = prev;
29309 c->die_sib = NULL;
29310 mark_removed (c);
29311 return;
29313 else
29315 next = c->die_sib;
29316 c->die_sib = NULL;
29317 mark_removed (c);
29320 if (c != prev->die_sib)
29321 prev->die_sib = c;
29322 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
29323 } while (c != die->die_child);
29326 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
29328 static void
29329 prune_unused_types (void)
29331 unsigned int i;
29332 limbo_die_node *node;
29333 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
29334 pubname_entry *pub;
29335 dw_die_ref base_type;
29337 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
29338 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
29339 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
29340 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29341 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
29342 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29343 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
29344 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
29346 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
29347 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
29349 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
29350 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
29351 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29352 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
29353 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29355 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
29356 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
29359 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
29360 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
29361 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
29362 not as roots in themselves. */
29363 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
29364 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
29365 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
29366 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
29367 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
29369 /* For -fvar-tracking-assignments, also set the mark on nodes that could be
29370 referenced by DW_TAG_call_site DW_AT_call_origin (i.e. direct call
29371 callees). */
29372 cgraph_node *cnode;
29373 FOR_EACH_FUNCTION (cnode)
29374 if (cnode->referred_to_p (false))
29376 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (cnode->decl);
29377 if (die == NULL || die->die_mark)
29378 continue;
29379 for (cgraph_edge *e = cnode->callers; e; e = e->next_caller)
29380 if (e->caller != cnode
29381 && opt_for_fn (e->caller->decl, flag_var_tracking_assignments))
29383 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
29384 break;
29388 if (debug_str_hash)
29389 debug_str_hash->empty ();
29390 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
29391 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
29392 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
29393 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
29395 node = *pnode;
29396 if (!node->die->die_mark)
29397 *pnode = node->next;
29398 else
29400 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
29401 pnode = &node->next;
29404 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29405 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
29407 /* Leave the marks clear. */
29408 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
29409 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
29410 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
29411 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
29412 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
29415 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
29417 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
29419 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
29420 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
29423 inline hashval_t
29424 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
29426 hashval_t h;
29427 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
29428 return h;
29431 inline bool
29432 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
29433 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
29435 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
29436 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
29439 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
29440 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
29441 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
29442 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
29443 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
29444 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
29446 static inline void
29447 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
29449 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
29450 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
29452 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
29453 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
29455 while (--ix > 0)
29457 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
29459 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line
29460 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_column
29461 || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
29462 break;
29465 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
29467 die->die_attr->pop ();
29468 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
29472 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
29473 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
29475 static void
29476 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29478 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
29480 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
29482 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29484 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29485 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29486 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29487 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29488 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
29489 break;
29490 case DW_OP_convert:
29491 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29492 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29493 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29494 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29495 continue;
29496 /* FALLTHRU */
29497 case DW_OP_const_type:
29498 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29499 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29500 break;
29501 case DW_OP_entry_value:
29502 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
29503 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
29504 continue;
29505 default:
29506 continue;
29508 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
29509 if (base_type->die_mark)
29510 base_type->die_mark++;
29511 else
29513 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
29514 base_type->die_mark = 1;
29519 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
29521 static int
29522 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
29524 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
29525 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
29526 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
29527 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
29528 unsigned int align1, align2;
29529 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
29530 return -1;
29531 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
29532 return 1;
29533 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
29534 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
29535 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
29536 return 1;
29537 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
29538 return -1;
29539 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
29540 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
29541 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
29542 return 1;
29543 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
29544 return -1;
29545 align1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_alignment);
29546 align2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_alignment);
29547 if (align1 < align2)
29548 return 1;
29549 if (align1 > align2)
29550 return -1;
29551 return 0;
29554 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
29555 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
29556 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
29557 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
29558 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
29560 static void
29561 move_marked_base_types (void)
29563 unsigned int i;
29564 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
29566 if (base_types.is_empty ())
29567 return;
29569 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
29570 order later on. */
29571 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
29572 die = comp_unit_die ();
29573 c = die->die_child;
29576 dw_die_ref prev = c;
29577 c = c->die_sib;
29578 while (c->die_mark)
29580 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
29581 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
29582 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
29583 gcc_assert (die->die_child != NULL);
29584 c = prev->die_sib;
29587 while (c != die->die_child);
29588 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
29589 c = die->die_child;
29590 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
29592 base_type->die_mark = 0;
29593 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
29594 c->die_sib = base_type;
29595 c = base_type;
29599 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
29600 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
29601 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
29603 static bool
29604 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
29606 rtx rtl = *addr;
29608 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
29610 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
29611 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
29612 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
29613 TREE_TYPE (t)
29614 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
29615 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
29616 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
29617 return false;
29618 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
29619 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
29620 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
29621 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
29622 return false;
29623 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
29624 *addr = rtl;
29625 return true;
29628 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
29629 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
29631 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
29633 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
29634 return false;
29636 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
29637 return false;
29640 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
29642 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
29643 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
29644 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
29645 return false;
29648 return true;
29651 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
29652 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
29653 from DW_OP_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
29655 static rtx
29656 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
29658 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
29659 unsigned char *array;
29660 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29661 tree decl;
29662 size_t len;
29663 dw_die_ref ref;
29665 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
29666 return NULL_RTX;
29667 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
29668 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
29669 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
29670 return NULL_RTX;
29672 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
29673 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
29675 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
29676 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
29677 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
29678 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
29679 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
29680 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
29681 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
29682 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
29683 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
29684 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
29685 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
29686 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
29688 return rtl;
29691 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
29692 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
29693 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
29694 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
29695 with DW_OP_implicit_pointer if possible
29696 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
29698 static bool
29699 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29701 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
29702 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
29703 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
29704 tree decl;
29706 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
29707 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
29708 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
29710 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
29711 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
29713 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
29715 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
29716 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
29717 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
29719 TREE_TYPE (t)
29720 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
29721 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
29722 if (!rtl)
29723 return false;
29725 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
29727 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
29728 if (VAR_P (decl) && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
29730 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
29731 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
29732 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
29734 loc->dw_loc_opc = dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer);
29735 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29736 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
29737 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29738 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29739 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
29740 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
29741 return true;
29745 return false;
29748 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
29749 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
29750 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
29752 static bool
29753 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
29755 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
29756 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
29757 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
29759 case DW_OP_addr:
29760 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
29762 if ((prev == NULL
29763 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
29764 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
29765 && loc->dw_loc_next
29766 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
29767 && (!dwarf_strict || dwarf_version >= 5)
29768 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
29769 break;
29770 return false;
29772 break;
29773 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
29774 case DW_OP_addrx:
29775 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
29776 case DW_OP_constx:
29777 if ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
29778 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addrx)
29779 || ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index
29780 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_constx)
29781 && loc->dtprel))
29783 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
29784 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
29785 return false;
29786 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
29787 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
29788 = add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
29790 break;
29791 case DW_OP_const4u:
29792 case DW_OP_const8u:
29793 if (loc->dtprel
29794 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
29795 return false;
29796 break;
29797 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
29798 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
29799 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
29801 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
29803 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
29804 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
29805 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
29806 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
29807 *loc = *repl;
29809 break;
29810 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
29811 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
29812 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
29813 return false;
29814 break;
29815 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
29816 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
29817 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
29818 case DW_OP_GNU_variable_value:
29819 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
29821 dw_die_ref ref
29822 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
29823 if (ref == NULL)
29824 return false;
29825 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29826 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29827 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29829 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value)
29831 if (prev == NULL
29832 && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL
29833 && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
29834 switch (a->dw_attr)
29836 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
29837 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
29838 alone we could transform it into reference. */
29839 case DW_AT_byte_size:
29840 case DW_AT_bit_size:
29841 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
29842 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
29843 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
29844 case DW_AT_count:
29845 case DW_AT_allocated:
29846 case DW_AT_associated:
29847 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
29848 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29849 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
29850 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die
29851 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29852 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29853 return true;
29854 default:
29855 break;
29857 if (dwarf_strict)
29858 return false;
29860 break;
29861 case DW_OP_const_type:
29862 case DW_OP_regval_type:
29863 case DW_OP_deref_type:
29864 case DW_OP_convert:
29865 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
29866 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
29867 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
29868 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
29869 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
29870 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
29871 while (loc->dw_loc_next
29872 && (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_convert
29873 || loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert))
29875 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
29876 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
29877 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
29878 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
29879 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
29880 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
29881 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
29882 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
29883 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29884 break;
29885 else
29886 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29887 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
29888 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
29889 break;
29890 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
29891 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
29892 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
29893 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
29894 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
29895 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
29896 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
29897 if (size1 == size2
29898 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
29899 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
29900 && loc != keep)
29901 || enc1 == enc2))
29903 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_convert after
29904 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
29905 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_regval_type
29906 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_type
29907 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
29908 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
29909 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
29910 else
29911 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
29912 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
29913 continue;
29915 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_convert after e.g. floating
29916 point typed stack entry. */
29917 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
29918 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
29919 break;
29921 break;
29922 default:
29923 break;
29925 return true;
29928 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
29929 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
29930 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
29931 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
29932 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_implicit_pointer
29933 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
29935 static void
29936 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
29938 if (!VAR_P (decl)
29939 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
29940 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
29941 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
29942 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
29943 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
29944 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
29945 return;
29947 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
29948 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
29949 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
29950 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
29951 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
29952 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
29953 return;
29954 if (dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 5)
29955 return;
29956 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
29957 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
29958 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
29959 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
29960 we can add DW_OP_implicit_pointer. */
29961 STRIP_NOPS (init);
29962 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
29963 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
29965 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
29966 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
29967 STRIP_NOPS (init);
29969 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
29970 return;
29971 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
29972 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
29973 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
29974 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
29975 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
29977 dw_die_ref ref;
29978 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
29980 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
29982 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
29983 if (!rtl)
29984 return;
29985 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
29987 else
29988 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
29989 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
29990 if (ref == NULL
29991 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
29992 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
29993 return;
29994 l = new_loc_descr (dwarf_OP (DW_OP_implicit_pointer), 0, offset);
29995 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
29996 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
29997 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
29998 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
30002 /* Return NULL if l is a DWARF expression, or first op that is not
30003 valid DWARF expression. */
30005 static dw_loc_descr_ref
30006 non_dwarf_expression (dw_loc_descr_ref l)
30008 while (l)
30010 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
30011 return l;
30012 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
30014 case DW_OP_regx:
30015 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30016 case DW_OP_stack_value:
30017 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30018 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30019 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
30020 case DW_OP_piece:
30021 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30022 return l;
30023 default:
30024 break;
30026 l = l->dw_loc_next;
30028 return NULL;
30031 /* Return adjusted copy of EXPR:
30032 If it is empty DWARF expression, return it.
30033 If it is valid non-empty DWARF expression,
30034 return copy of EXPR with DW_OP_deref appended to it.
30035 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_reg{N,x}, return
30036 copy of the DWARF expression with DW_OP_breg{N,x} <0> appended.
30037 If it is DWARF expression followed by DW_OP_stack_value, return
30038 copy of the DWARF expression without anything appended.
30039 Otherwise, return NULL. */
30041 static dw_loc_descr_ref
30042 copy_deref_exprloc (dw_loc_descr_ref expr)
30044 dw_loc_descr_ref tail = NULL;
30046 if (expr == NULL)
30047 return NULL;
30049 dw_loc_descr_ref l = non_dwarf_expression (expr);
30050 if (l && l->dw_loc_next)
30051 return NULL;
30053 if (l)
30055 if (l->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && l->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
30056 tail = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom)
30057 (DW_OP_breg0 + (l->dw_loc_opc - DW_OP_reg0)),
30058 0, 0);
30059 else
30060 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
30062 case DW_OP_regx:
30063 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx,
30064 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned, 0);
30065 break;
30066 case DW_OP_stack_value:
30067 break;
30068 default:
30069 return NULL;
30072 else
30073 tail = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
30075 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, *p = &ret;
30076 while (expr != l)
30078 *p = new_loc_descr (expr->dw_loc_opc, 0, 0);
30079 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd1 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30080 (*p)->dw_loc_oprnd2 = expr->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30081 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
30082 expr = expr->dw_loc_next;
30084 *p = tail;
30085 return ret;
30088 /* For DW_AT_string_length attribute with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30089 reference to a variable or argument, adjust it if needed and return:
30090 -1 if the DW_AT_string_length attribute and DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size
30091 attribute if present should be removed
30092 0 keep the attribute perhaps with minor modifications, no need to rescan
30093 1 if the attribute has been successfully adjusted. */
30095 static int
30096 optimize_string_length (dw_attr_node *a)
30098 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a), lv;
30099 dw_die_ref die;
30100 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
30102 tree decl = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
30103 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
30104 if (die)
30106 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30107 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
30108 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30110 else
30111 return -1;
30113 else
30114 die = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
30116 /* DWARF5 allows reference class, so we can then reference the DIE.
30117 Only do this for DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value. */
30118 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL && dwarf_version >= 5)
30120 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30121 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
30122 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = die;
30123 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30124 return 0;
30127 dw_attr_node *av = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
30128 dw_loc_list_ref d;
30129 bool non_dwarf_expr = false;
30131 if (av == NULL)
30132 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30133 switch (AT_class (av))
30135 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30136 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
30137 if (d->expr && non_dwarf_expression (d->expr))
30138 non_dwarf_expr = true;
30139 break;
30140 case dw_val_class_view_list:
30141 gcc_unreachable ();
30142 case dw_val_class_loc:
30143 lv = AT_loc (av);
30144 if (lv == NULL)
30145 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30146 if (non_dwarf_expression (lv))
30147 non_dwarf_expr = true;
30148 break;
30149 default:
30150 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30153 /* If it is safe to transform DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value
30154 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_GNU_variable_value into
30155 DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, do so. */
30156 if (!non_dwarf_expr
30157 && (l->dw_loc_next != NULL || AT_class (av) == dw_val_class_loc))
30159 l->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_call4;
30160 if (l->dw_loc_next)
30161 l->dw_loc_next = NULL;
30162 else
30163 l->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
30164 return 0;
30167 /* For DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value, we can just
30168 copy over the DW_AT_location attribute from die to a. */
30169 if (l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
30171 a->dw_attr_val = av->dw_attr_val;
30172 return 1;
30175 dw_loc_list_ref list, *p;
30176 switch (AT_class (av))
30178 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30179 p = &list;
30180 list = NULL;
30181 for (d = AT_loc_list (av); d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
30183 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (d->expr);
30184 if (lv)
30186 *p = new_loc_list (lv, d->begin, d->vbegin, d->end, d->vend, d->section);
30187 p = &(*p)->dw_loc_next;
30189 else if (!dwarf_strict && d->expr)
30190 return 0;
30192 if (list == NULL)
30193 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30194 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
30195 gen_llsym (list);
30196 *AT_loc_list_ptr (a) = list;
30197 return 1;
30198 case dw_val_class_loc:
30199 lv = copy_deref_exprloc (AT_loc (av));
30200 if (lv == NULL)
30201 return dwarf_strict ? -1 : 0;
30202 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = lv;
30203 return 1;
30204 default:
30205 gcc_unreachable ();
30209 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
30210 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
30211 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
30212 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
30213 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
30214 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
30216 static void
30217 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
30219 dw_die_ref c;
30220 dw_attr_node *a;
30221 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
30222 unsigned ix;
30223 bool remove_AT_byte_size = false;
30225 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30226 switch (AT_class (a))
30228 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
30229 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
30230 loc = *curr;
30231 gcc_assert (loc);
30232 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
30233 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
30234 if (loc->replaced)
30235 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
30236 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
30238 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
30239 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
30240 References must be identical or completely separate.
30241 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
30242 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
30243 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
30244 while (*curr)
30246 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
30247 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (a, (*curr)->expr))
30249 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
30250 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
30252 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
30254 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
30255 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
30256 next->vl_symbol = (*curr)->vl_symbol;
30258 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30259 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
30260 *curr = next;
30262 else
30264 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
30265 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
30268 if (loc == *start)
30269 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
30270 else
30272 loc->replaced = 1;
30273 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
30276 if (!*start)
30278 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30279 ix--;
30281 break;
30282 case dw_val_class_view_list:
30284 gcc_checking_assert (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
30285 gcc_checking_assert (dwarf2out_locviews_in_attribute ());
30286 dw_val_node *llnode
30287 = view_list_to_loc_list_val_node (&a->dw_attr_val);
30288 /* If we no longer have a loclist, or it no longer needs
30289 views, drop this attribute. */
30290 if (!llnode || !llnode->v.val_loc_list->vl_symbol)
30292 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30293 ix--;
30295 break;
30297 case dw_val_class_loc:
30299 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
30300 /* DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value or
30301 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in DW_AT_string_length can be converted
30302 into DW_OP_call4 or DW_OP_call4 DW_OP_deref, which is standard
30303 DWARF4 unlike DW_OP_GNU_variable_value. Or for DWARF5
30304 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value DW_OP_stack_value can be replaced
30305 with DW_FORM_ref referencing the same DIE as
30306 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value used to reference. */
30307 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length
30308 && l
30309 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
30310 && (l->dw_loc_next == NULL
30311 || (l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next == NULL
30312 && l->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value)))
30314 switch (optimize_string_length (a))
30316 case -1:
30317 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30318 ix--;
30319 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
30320 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
30321 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
30322 continue;
30323 default:
30324 break;
30325 case 1:
30326 /* Even if we keep the optimized DW_AT_string_length,
30327 it might have changed AT_class, so process it again. */
30328 ix--;
30329 continue;
30332 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
30333 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
30334 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
30335 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
30336 but shorter, location description. */
30337 if ((dwarf_version > 2
30338 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
30339 || l == NULL
30340 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
30341 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
30342 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (a, l))
30344 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
30345 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
30346 if (l != NULL
30347 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
30348 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
30349 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
30350 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
30351 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
30353 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
30354 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30355 ix--;
30356 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
30357 break;
30359 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_string_length)
30360 /* If we drop DW_AT_string_length, we need to drop also
30361 DW_AT_{string_length_,}byte_size. */
30362 remove_AT_byte_size = true;
30363 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30364 ix--;
30366 else
30367 mark_base_types (l);
30369 break;
30370 case dw_val_class_addr:
30371 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
30372 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
30374 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
30375 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
30376 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30377 ix--;
30379 if ((die->die_tag == DW_TAG_call_site
30380 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_call_origin)
30381 || (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
30382 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin))
30384 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
30385 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
30386 dw_die_ref cdie;
30387 if (tdie == NULL
30388 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
30389 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
30390 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
30392 dw_die_ref pdie = cdie;
30393 /* Make sure we don't add these DIEs into type units.
30394 We could emit skeleton DIEs for context (namespaces,
30395 outer structs/classes) and a skeleton DIE for the
30396 innermost context with DW_AT_signature pointing to the
30397 type unit. See PR78835. */
30398 while (pdie && pdie->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
30399 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
30400 if (pdie == NULL)
30402 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
30403 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
30404 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
30405 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
30406 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
30407 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
30408 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
30409 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
30410 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl, true);
30411 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
30414 if (tdie)
30416 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
30417 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
30418 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
30420 else
30422 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
30423 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
30424 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
30425 ix--;
30428 break;
30429 default:
30430 break;
30433 if (remove_AT_byte_size)
30434 remove_AT (die, dwarf_version >= 5
30435 ? DW_AT_string_length_byte_size
30436 : DW_AT_byte_size);
30438 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
30441 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
30442 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
30443 section. */
30445 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
30447 static void
30448 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
30450 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30451 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30453 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
30455 case DW_OP_const4u:
30456 case DW_OP_const8u:
30457 if (loc->dtprel)
30458 goto hash_addr;
30459 /* FALLTHRU */
30460 case DW_OP_const1u:
30461 case DW_OP_const1s:
30462 case DW_OP_const2u:
30463 case DW_OP_const2s:
30464 case DW_OP_const4s:
30465 case DW_OP_const8s:
30466 case DW_OP_constu:
30467 case DW_OP_consts:
30468 case DW_OP_pick:
30469 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
30470 case DW_OP_breg0:
30471 case DW_OP_breg1:
30472 case DW_OP_breg2:
30473 case DW_OP_breg3:
30474 case DW_OP_breg4:
30475 case DW_OP_breg5:
30476 case DW_OP_breg6:
30477 case DW_OP_breg7:
30478 case DW_OP_breg8:
30479 case DW_OP_breg9:
30480 case DW_OP_breg10:
30481 case DW_OP_breg11:
30482 case DW_OP_breg12:
30483 case DW_OP_breg13:
30484 case DW_OP_breg14:
30485 case DW_OP_breg15:
30486 case DW_OP_breg16:
30487 case DW_OP_breg17:
30488 case DW_OP_breg18:
30489 case DW_OP_breg19:
30490 case DW_OP_breg20:
30491 case DW_OP_breg21:
30492 case DW_OP_breg22:
30493 case DW_OP_breg23:
30494 case DW_OP_breg24:
30495 case DW_OP_breg25:
30496 case DW_OP_breg26:
30497 case DW_OP_breg27:
30498 case DW_OP_breg28:
30499 case DW_OP_breg29:
30500 case DW_OP_breg30:
30501 case DW_OP_breg31:
30502 case DW_OP_regx:
30503 case DW_OP_fbreg:
30504 case DW_OP_piece:
30505 case DW_OP_deref_size:
30506 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
30507 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30508 break;
30509 case DW_OP_skip:
30510 case DW_OP_bra:
30512 int offset;
30514 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
30515 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
30516 hstate.add_object (offset);
30518 break;
30519 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30520 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
30521 switch (val2->val_class)
30523 case dw_val_class_const:
30524 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30525 break;
30526 case dw_val_class_vec:
30528 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
30529 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
30531 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
30532 hstate.add_int (len);
30533 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
30535 break;
30536 case dw_val_class_const_double:
30537 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
30538 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
30539 break;
30540 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30541 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
30542 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
30543 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
30544 break;
30545 case dw_val_class_addr:
30546 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
30547 break;
30548 default:
30549 gcc_unreachable ();
30551 break;
30552 case DW_OP_bregx:
30553 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30554 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30555 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30556 break;
30557 case DW_OP_addr:
30558 hash_addr:
30559 if (loc->dtprel)
30561 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
30562 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
30564 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
30565 break;
30566 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
30567 case DW_OP_addrx:
30568 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
30569 case DW_OP_constx:
30571 if (loc->dtprel)
30573 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
30574 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
30576 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
30578 break;
30579 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30580 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30581 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
30582 break;
30583 case DW_OP_entry_value:
30584 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
30585 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
30586 break;
30587 case DW_OP_regval_type:
30588 case DW_OP_deref_type:
30589 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
30590 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
30592 unsigned int byte_size
30593 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
30594 unsigned int encoding
30595 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
30596 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
30597 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
30598 hstate.add_object (encoding);
30600 break;
30601 case DW_OP_convert:
30602 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
30603 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
30604 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
30605 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
30607 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
30608 break;
30610 /* FALLTHRU */
30611 case DW_OP_const_type:
30612 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
30614 unsigned int byte_size
30615 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
30616 unsigned int encoding
30617 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
30618 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
30619 hstate.add_object (encoding);
30620 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_const_type
30621 && loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
30622 break;
30623 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
30624 switch (val2->val_class)
30626 case dw_val_class_const:
30627 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
30628 break;
30629 case dw_val_class_vec:
30631 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
30632 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
30634 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
30635 hstate.add_object (len);
30636 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
30638 break;
30639 case dw_val_class_const_double:
30640 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
30641 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
30642 break;
30643 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30644 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
30645 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
30646 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
30647 break;
30648 default:
30649 gcc_unreachable ();
30652 break;
30654 default:
30655 /* Other codes have no operands. */
30656 break;
30660 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
30662 static inline void
30663 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
30665 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
30666 bool sizes_computed = false;
30667 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
30668 size_of_locs (loc);
30670 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
30672 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
30673 hstate.add_object (opc);
30674 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
30676 size_of_locs (loc);
30677 sizes_computed = true;
30679 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
30683 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
30685 static inline void
30686 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
30688 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
30689 inchash::hash hstate;
30691 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
30693 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
30694 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
30695 hstate.add_object (curr->vbegin);
30696 hstate.add_object (curr->vend);
30697 if (curr->section)
30698 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
30699 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
30701 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
30704 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
30706 static inline bool
30707 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
30709 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30710 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30711 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
30712 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
30714 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
30716 case DW_OP_const4u:
30717 case DW_OP_const8u:
30718 if (x->dtprel)
30719 goto hash_addr;
30720 /* FALLTHRU */
30721 case DW_OP_const1u:
30722 case DW_OP_const1s:
30723 case DW_OP_const2u:
30724 case DW_OP_const2s:
30725 case DW_OP_const4s:
30726 case DW_OP_const8s:
30727 case DW_OP_constu:
30728 case DW_OP_consts:
30729 case DW_OP_pick:
30730 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
30731 case DW_OP_breg0:
30732 case DW_OP_breg1:
30733 case DW_OP_breg2:
30734 case DW_OP_breg3:
30735 case DW_OP_breg4:
30736 case DW_OP_breg5:
30737 case DW_OP_breg6:
30738 case DW_OP_breg7:
30739 case DW_OP_breg8:
30740 case DW_OP_breg9:
30741 case DW_OP_breg10:
30742 case DW_OP_breg11:
30743 case DW_OP_breg12:
30744 case DW_OP_breg13:
30745 case DW_OP_breg14:
30746 case DW_OP_breg15:
30747 case DW_OP_breg16:
30748 case DW_OP_breg17:
30749 case DW_OP_breg18:
30750 case DW_OP_breg19:
30751 case DW_OP_breg20:
30752 case DW_OP_breg21:
30753 case DW_OP_breg22:
30754 case DW_OP_breg23:
30755 case DW_OP_breg24:
30756 case DW_OP_breg25:
30757 case DW_OP_breg26:
30758 case DW_OP_breg27:
30759 case DW_OP_breg28:
30760 case DW_OP_breg29:
30761 case DW_OP_breg30:
30762 case DW_OP_breg31:
30763 case DW_OP_regx:
30764 case DW_OP_fbreg:
30765 case DW_OP_piece:
30766 case DW_OP_deref_size:
30767 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
30768 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
30769 case DW_OP_skip:
30770 case DW_OP_bra:
30771 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
30772 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
30773 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
30774 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
30775 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
30776 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
30777 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
30778 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
30779 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
30780 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
30781 return false;
30782 switch (valx2->val_class)
30784 case dw_val_class_const:
30785 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30786 case dw_val_class_vec:
30787 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30788 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
30789 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
30790 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30791 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
30792 case dw_val_class_const_double:
30793 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
30794 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
30795 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30796 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
30797 case dw_val_class_addr:
30798 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
30799 default:
30800 gcc_unreachable ();
30802 case DW_OP_bregx:
30803 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
30804 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
30805 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30806 case DW_OP_addr:
30807 hash_addr:
30808 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
30809 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
30810 case DW_OP_addrx:
30811 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
30812 case DW_OP_constx:
30814 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
30815 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
30816 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
30818 case DW_OP_implicit_pointer:
30819 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
30820 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
30821 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
30822 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
30823 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30824 case DW_OP_entry_value:
30825 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
30826 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
30827 case DW_OP_const_type:
30828 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
30829 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
30830 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
30831 return false;
30832 switch (valx2->val_class)
30834 case dw_val_class_const:
30835 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
30836 case dw_val_class_vec:
30837 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30838 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
30839 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
30840 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
30841 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
30842 case dw_val_class_const_double:
30843 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
30844 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
30845 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
30846 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
30847 default:
30848 gcc_unreachable ();
30850 case DW_OP_regval_type:
30851 case DW_OP_deref_type:
30852 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
30853 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
30854 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
30855 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
30856 case DW_OP_convert:
30857 case DW_OP_reinterpret:
30858 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
30859 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
30860 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
30861 return false;
30862 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
30863 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
30864 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
30865 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
30866 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
30867 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
30868 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
30869 default:
30870 /* Other codes have no operands. */
30871 return true;
30875 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
30877 static inline bool
30878 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
30880 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
30881 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
30882 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
30883 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
30884 break;
30885 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
30888 /* Hashtable helpers. */
30890 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
30892 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
30893 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
30894 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
30897 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
30899 inline hashval_t
30900 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
30902 return x->hash;
30905 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
30907 inline bool
30908 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
30909 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
30911 if (a == b)
30912 return 1;
30913 if (a->hash != b->hash)
30914 return 0;
30915 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
30916 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
30917 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
30918 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
30919 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
30920 || a->vbegin != b->vbegin || a->vend != b->vend
30921 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
30922 break;
30923 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
30926 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
30929 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
30930 children and share them whenever possible. */
30932 static void
30933 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
30935 dw_die_ref c;
30936 dw_attr_node *a;
30937 unsigned ix;
30938 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
30939 bool drop_locviews = false;
30940 bool has_locviews = false;
30942 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30943 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
30945 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
30946 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
30947 it and storing into the hash table. */
30948 hash_loc_list (list);
30949 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
30950 if (*slot == NULL)
30952 *slot = list;
30953 if (loc_list_has_views (list))
30954 gcc_assert (list->vl_symbol);
30955 else if (list->vl_symbol)
30957 drop_locviews = true;
30958 list->vl_symbol = NULL;
30961 else
30963 if (list->vl_symbol && !(*slot)->vl_symbol)
30964 drop_locviews = true;
30965 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
30968 else if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_view_list)
30970 gcc_checking_assert (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
30971 has_locviews = true;
30975 if (drop_locviews && has_locviews)
30976 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_GNU_locviews);
30978 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
30982 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
30983 section. */
30985 static void
30986 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
30988 dw_die_ref c;
30989 dw_attr_node *a;
30990 unsigned ix;
30992 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
30993 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
30995 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
30996 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
30997 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
30999 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
31000 or won't be output. Make sure skip_loc_list_entry doesn't
31001 call size_of_locs, because that might cause circular dependency,
31002 index_location_lists requiring address table indexes to be
31003 computed, but adding new indexes through add_addr_table_entry
31004 and address table index computation requiring no new additions
31005 to the hash table. In the rare case of DWARF[234] >= 64KB
31006 location expression, we'll just waste unused address table entry
31007 for it. */
31008 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
31009 || skip_loc_list_entry (curr))
31010 continue;
31012 curr->begin_entry
31013 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin), ate_kind_label);
31017 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
31020 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
31021 children and share them whenever possible. */
31023 static void
31024 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
31026 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
31027 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
31030 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
31031 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
31032 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
31033 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
31034 instance. */
31036 static void
31037 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
31039 limbo_die_node *node;
31041 /* get_context_die calls force_decl_die, which can put new DIEs on the
31042 limbo list in LTO mode when nested functions are put in a different
31043 partition than that of their parent function. */
31044 while ((node = limbo_die_list))
31046 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
31047 limbo_die_list = node->next;
31049 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
31051 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
31053 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
31054 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
31055 else if (is_cu_die (die))
31057 else if (seen_error ())
31058 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
31059 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
31060 else
31062 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
31063 nested function can be optimized away, which results
31064 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
31065 with the return type of that nested function. Force
31066 this to be a child of the containing function.
31068 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
31069 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
31070 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
31071 the function is likely unreachable too. */
31072 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
31074 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
31075 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
31076 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
31077 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
31078 else
31079 origin = comp_unit_die ();
31081 add_child_die (origin, die);
31087 /* Reset DIEs so we can output them again. */
31089 static void
31090 reset_dies (dw_die_ref die)
31092 dw_die_ref c;
31094 /* Remove stuff we re-generate. */
31095 die->die_mark = 0;
31096 die->die_offset = 0;
31097 die->die_abbrev = 0;
31098 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_sibling);
31100 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, reset_dies (c));
31103 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
31104 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
31106 static void
31107 dwarf2out_finish (const char *)
31109 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
31110 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
31111 unsigned char checksum[16];
31112 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31114 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
31115 flush_limbo_die_list ();
31117 if (inline_entry_data_table)
31118 gcc_assert (inline_entry_data_table->elements () == 0);
31120 if (flag_checking)
31122 verify_die (comp_unit_die ());
31123 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31124 verify_die (node->die);
31127 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
31128 DIEs generated after early finish. */
31129 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
31131 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
31133 if (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload)
31135 gcc_assert (flag_fat_lto_objects || flag_generate_offload);
31137 /* Prune stuff so that dwarf2out_finish runs successfully
31138 for the fat part of the object. */
31139 reset_dies (comp_unit_die ());
31140 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31141 reset_dies (node->die);
31143 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
31144 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31146 comdat_type_node **slot
31147 = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
31149 /* Don't reset types twice. */
31150 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
31151 continue;
31153 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
31154 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
31155 attributes. */
31156 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31157 reset_dies (ctnode->root_die);
31159 *slot = ctnode;
31162 /* Reset die CU symbol so we don't output it twice. */
31163 comp_unit_die ()->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
31165 /* Remove DW_AT_macro and DW_AT_stmt_list from the early output. */
31166 remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list);
31167 if (have_macinfo)
31168 remove_AT (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE);
31170 /* Remove indirect string decisions. */
31171 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, reset_indirect_string> (NULL);
31174 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
31176 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
31177 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
31179 #endif
31180 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
31181 move_marked_base_types ();
31183 /* Initialize sections and labels used for actual assembler output. */
31184 unsigned generation = init_sections_and_labels (false);
31186 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
31187 have children. */
31188 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
31189 limbo_die_node *node;
31190 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31191 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
31192 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31193 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
31195 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
31196 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
31197 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
31198 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31200 limbo_die_node *cu;
31201 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
31202 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31203 main_comp_unit_die->die_tag = DW_TAG_skeleton_unit;
31204 cu = limbo_die_list;
31205 gcc_assert (cu->die == main_comp_unit_die);
31206 limbo_die_list = limbo_die_list->next;
31207 cu->next = cu_die_list;
31208 cu_die_list = cu;
31210 else
31211 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
31213 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
31214 switch_to_section (text_section);
31215 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
31216 if (cold_text_section)
31218 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
31219 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
31222 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
31223 in .text. */
31224 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
31225 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
31227 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
31228 if (text_section_used)
31229 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
31230 text_end_label, true);
31232 else
31234 unsigned fde_idx;
31235 dw_fde_ref fde;
31236 bool range_list_added = false;
31238 if (text_section_used)
31239 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
31240 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
31241 if (cold_text_section_used)
31242 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
31243 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
31245 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
31247 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
31248 continue;
31249 if (!fde->in_std_section)
31250 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
31251 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
31252 true);
31253 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
31254 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
31255 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
31256 true);
31259 if (range_list_added)
31261 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
31262 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
31263 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
31264 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
31265 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
31266 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
31267 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
31268 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
31270 add_ranges (NULL);
31274 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
31275 offset expected by debuggers. */
31276 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
31277 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
31278 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
31280 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31281 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
31282 dl_section_ref);
31284 if (have_macinfo)
31285 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
31286 macinfo_section_label);
31288 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31290 if (have_location_lists)
31292 /* Since we generate the loclists in the split DWARF .dwo
31293 file itself, we don't need to generate a loclists_base
31294 attribute for the split compile unit DIE. That attribute
31295 (and using relocatable sec_offset FORMs) isn't allowed
31296 for a split compile unit. Only if the .debug_loclists
31297 section was in the main file, would we need to generate a
31298 loclists_base attribute here (for the full or skeleton
31299 unit DIE). */
31301 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
31302 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
31303 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
31304 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
31305 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
31306 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31309 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
31311 unsigned int index = 0;
31312 addr_index_table
31313 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
31314 (&index);
31318 loc_list_idx = 0;
31319 if (have_location_lists)
31321 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31322 /* And finally assign indexes to the entries for -gsplit-dwarf. */
31323 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
31324 assign_location_list_indexes (comp_unit_die ());
31327 save_macinfo_strings ();
31329 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31331 unsigned int index = 0;
31333 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
31334 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
31335 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
31336 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
31337 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
31338 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
31339 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
31342 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
31343 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
31344 for (node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31345 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
31347 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
31348 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31350 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
31352 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
31353 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
31354 continue;
31356 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
31357 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
31358 attributes. */
31359 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31360 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
31361 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
31362 ? dl_section_ref
31363 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
31365 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
31366 *slot = ctnode;
31369 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
31371 int mark;
31372 struct md5_ctx ctx;
31374 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && !vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31375 index_rnglists ();
31377 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
31378 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
31379 mark = 0;
31380 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
31381 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
31382 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
31384 if (dwarf_version < 5)
31386 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
31387 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
31388 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
31389 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
31392 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
31393 comp-unit DIE. */
31394 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31396 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31397 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_rnglists_base,
31398 ranges_base_label);
31399 else
31400 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
31401 ranges_section_label);
31404 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
31405 /* GNU DebugFission https://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/DebugFission
31406 which GCC uses to implement -gsplit-dwarf as DWARF GNU extension
31407 before DWARF5, didn't have a header for .debug_addr units.
31408 DWARF5 specifies a small header when address tables are used. */
31409 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31411 unsigned int last_idx = 0;
31412 unsigned long addrs_length;
31414 addr_index_table->traverse_noresize
31415 <unsigned int *, count_index_addrs> (&last_idx);
31416 addrs_length = last_idx * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE + 4;
31418 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
31419 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
31420 "Escape value for 64-bit DWARF extension");
31421 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, addrs_length,
31422 "Length of Address Unit");
31423 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 5, "DWARF addr version");
31424 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
31425 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
31427 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
31428 output_addr_table ();
31431 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
31432 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
31433 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo,
31434 dwarf_split_debug_info ? checksum : NULL);
31436 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
31437 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die, checksum);
31439 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
31440 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
31442 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
31443 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
31444 output_abbrev_section ();
31447 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
31448 if (have_location_lists)
31450 char l1[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31451 char l2[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31452 /* Output the location lists info. */
31453 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
31454 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31456 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 1);
31457 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 2);
31458 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
31459 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
31460 "Initial length escape value indicating "
31461 "64-bit DWARF extension");
31462 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
31463 "Length of Location Lists");
31464 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
31465 output_dwarf_version ();
31466 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Address Size");
31467 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Segment Size");
31468 dw2_asm_output_data (4, dwarf_split_debug_info ? loc_list_idx : 0,
31469 "Offset Entry Count");
31471 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
31472 if (dwarf_version >= 5 && dwarf_split_debug_info)
31474 unsigned int save_loc_list_idx = loc_list_idx;
31475 loc_list_idx = 0;
31476 output_loclists_offsets (comp_unit_die ());
31477 gcc_assert (save_loc_list_idx == loc_list_idx);
31479 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
31480 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31481 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
31484 output_pubtables ();
31486 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
31487 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
31488 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
31489 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
31490 generate a table that would have contained data. */
31491 if (info_section_emitted)
31493 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
31494 output_aranges ();
31497 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
31498 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (ranges_table))
31500 if (dwarf_version >= 5)
31501 output_rnglists (generation);
31502 else
31503 output_ranges ();
31506 /* Have to end the macro section. */
31507 if (have_macinfo)
31509 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
31510 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
31511 output_macinfo (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
31512 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label, false);
31513 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
31516 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
31517 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
31518 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
31519 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
31520 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
31521 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
31522 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
31523 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
31524 if (! output_asm_line_debug_info ())
31525 output_line_info (false);
31527 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
31529 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
31530 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
31531 output_line_info (true);
31534 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
31535 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
31536 output_indirect_strings ();
31537 if (debug_line_str_hash)
31539 switch_to_section (debug_line_str_section);
31540 const enum dwarf_form form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
31541 debug_line_str_hash->traverse<enum dwarf_form,
31542 output_indirect_string> (form);
31545 /* ??? Move lvugid out of dwarf2out_source_line and reset it too? */
31546 symview_upper_bound = 0;
31547 if (zero_view_p)
31548 bitmap_clear (zero_view_p);
31551 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a variable_value_struct). */
31553 inline hashval_t
31554 variable_value_hasher::hash (variable_value_struct *x)
31556 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
31559 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of variable_value_struct X is the same as
31560 UID of decl Y. */
31562 inline bool
31563 variable_value_hasher::equal (variable_value_struct *x, tree y)
31565 return x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y);
31568 /* Helper function for resolve_variable_value, handle
31569 DW_OP_GNU_variable_value in one location expression.
31570 Return true if exprloc has been changed into loclist. */
31572 static bool
31573 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (dw_attr_node *a, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
31575 dw_loc_descr_ref next;
31576 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = next)
31578 next = loc->dw_loc_next;
31579 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
31580 || loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_decl_ref)
31581 continue;
31583 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
31584 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) != current_function_decl)
31585 continue;
31587 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31588 if (ref)
31590 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31591 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31592 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31593 continue;
31595 dw_loc_list_ref l = loc_list_from_tree (decl, 0, NULL);
31596 if (l == NULL)
31597 continue;
31598 if (l->dw_loc_next)
31600 if (AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
31601 continue;
31602 switch (a->dw_attr)
31604 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and loclist
31605 classes, so we can change them into a loclist. */
31606 case DW_AT_location:
31607 case DW_AT_string_length:
31608 case DW_AT_return_addr:
31609 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
31610 case DW_AT_frame_base:
31611 case DW_AT_segment:
31612 case DW_AT_static_link:
31613 case DW_AT_use_location:
31614 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
31615 if (prev)
31617 prev->dw_loc_next = NULL;
31618 prepend_loc_descr_to_each (l, AT_loc (a));
31620 if (next)
31621 add_loc_descr_to_each (l, next);
31622 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
31623 a->dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
31624 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = l;
31625 have_location_lists = true;
31626 return true;
31627 /* Following attributes allow both exprloc and reference,
31628 so if the whole expression is DW_OP_GNU_variable_value alone
31629 we could transform it into reference. */
31630 case DW_AT_byte_size:
31631 case DW_AT_bit_size:
31632 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
31633 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
31634 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
31635 case DW_AT_count:
31636 case DW_AT_allocated:
31637 case DW_AT_associated:
31638 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
31639 if (prev == NULL && next == NULL)
31640 break;
31641 /* FALLTHRU */
31642 default:
31643 if (dwarf_strict)
31644 continue;
31645 break;
31647 /* Create DW_TAG_variable that we can refer to. */
31648 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL,
31649 lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl));
31650 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31651 if (ref)
31653 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31654 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31655 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31657 continue;
31659 if (prev)
31661 prev->dw_loc_next = l->expr;
31662 add_loc_descr (&prev->dw_loc_next, next);
31663 free_loc_descr (loc, NULL);
31664 next = prev->dw_loc_next;
31666 else
31668 memcpy (loc, l->expr, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
31669 add_loc_descr (&loc, next);
31670 next = loc;
31672 loc = prev;
31674 return false;
31677 /* Attempt to resolve DW_OP_GNU_variable_value using loc_list_from_tree. */
31679 static void
31680 resolve_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
31682 dw_attr_node *a;
31683 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
31684 unsigned ix;
31686 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
31687 switch (AT_class (a))
31689 case dw_val_class_loc:
31690 if (!resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, AT_loc (a)))
31691 break;
31692 /* FALLTHRU */
31693 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
31694 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
31695 gcc_assert (loc);
31696 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31697 resolve_variable_value_in_expr (a, loc->expr);
31698 break;
31699 default:
31700 break;
31704 /* Attempt to optimize DW_OP_GNU_variable_value refering to
31705 temporaries in the current function. */
31707 static void
31708 resolve_variable_values (void)
31710 if (!variable_value_hash || !current_function_decl)
31711 return;
31713 struct variable_value_struct *node
31714 = variable_value_hash->find_with_hash (current_function_decl,
31715 DECL_UID (current_function_decl));
31717 if (node == NULL)
31718 return;
31720 unsigned int i;
31721 dw_die_ref die;
31722 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (node->dies, i, die)
31723 resolve_variable_value (die);
31726 /* Helper function for note_variable_value, handle one location
31727 expression. */
31729 static void
31730 note_variable_value_in_expr (dw_die_ref die, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
31732 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31733 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_variable_value
31734 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
31736 tree decl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref;
31737 dw_die_ref ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31738 if (! ref && (flag_generate_lto || flag_generate_offload))
31740 /* ??? This is somewhat a hack because we do not create DIEs
31741 for variables not in BLOCK trees early but when generating
31742 early LTO output we need the dw_val_class_decl_ref to be
31743 fully resolved. For fat LTO objects we'd also like to
31744 undo this after LTO dwarf output. */
31745 gcc_assert (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
31746 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
31747 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL);
31748 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL_TREE, NULL, ctx);
31749 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
31750 gcc_assert (ref != NULL);
31752 if (ref)
31754 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
31755 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
31756 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
31757 continue;
31759 if (VAR_P (decl)
31760 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
31761 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL
31762 && lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)))
31764 if (!variable_value_hash)
31765 variable_value_hash
31766 = hash_table<variable_value_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
31768 tree fndecl = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
31769 struct variable_value_struct *node;
31770 struct variable_value_struct **slot
31771 = variable_value_hash->find_slot_with_hash (fndecl,
31772 DECL_UID (fndecl),
31773 INSERT);
31774 if (*slot == NULL)
31776 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<variable_value_struct> ();
31777 node->decl_id = DECL_UID (fndecl);
31778 *slot = node;
31780 else
31781 node = *slot;
31783 vec_safe_push (node->dies, die);
31788 /* Walk the tree DIE and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
31789 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
31791 static void
31792 note_variable_value (dw_die_ref die)
31794 dw_die_ref c;
31795 dw_attr_node *a;
31796 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
31797 unsigned ix;
31799 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
31800 switch (AT_class (a))
31802 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
31803 loc = AT_loc_list (a);
31804 gcc_assert (loc);
31805 if (!loc->noted_variable_value)
31807 loc->noted_variable_value = 1;
31808 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
31809 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, loc->expr);
31811 break;
31812 case dw_val_class_loc:
31813 note_variable_value_in_expr (die, AT_loc (a));
31814 break;
31815 default:
31816 break;
31819 /* Mark children. */
31820 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, note_variable_value (c));
31823 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
31824 has run. */
31826 static void
31827 dwarf2out_early_finish (const char *filename)
31829 set_early_dwarf s;
31830 char dl_section_ref[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
31832 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
31833 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
31834 and overwrite only here. */
31835 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
31836 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
31837 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
31838 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
31840 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
31841 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
31842 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
31843 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
31845 /* When emitting DWARF5 .debug_line_str, move DW_AT_name and
31846 DW_AT_comp_dir into .debug_line_str section. */
31847 if (!dwarf2out_as_loc_support
31848 && dwarf_version >= 5
31849 && DWARF5_USE_DEBUG_LINE_STR)
31851 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
31853 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (comp_unit_die (),
31854 i ? DW_AT_comp_dir : DW_AT_name);
31855 if (a == NULL
31856 || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_str
31857 || strlen (AT_string (a)) + 1 <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
31858 continue;
31860 if (! debug_line_str_hash)
31861 debug_line_str_hash
31862 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
31864 struct indirect_string_node *node
31865 = find_AT_string_in_table (AT_string (a), debug_line_str_hash);
31866 set_indirect_string (node);
31867 node->form = DW_FORM_line_strp;
31868 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
31869 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
31873 /* With LTO early dwarf was really finished at compile-time, so make
31874 sure to adjust the phase after annotating the LTRANS CU DIE. */
31875 if (in_lto_p)
31877 early_dwarf_finished = true;
31878 return;
31881 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
31882 emit full debugging info for them. */
31883 retry_incomplete_types ();
31885 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
31886 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
31887 flush_limbo_die_list ();
31889 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
31890 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
31892 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
31893 for (limbo_die_node *node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
31895 tree decl = node->created_for;
31896 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
31897 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
31898 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
31899 constant and never written to disk. */
31900 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
31902 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
31903 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
31906 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
31908 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
31909 prune_unused_types ();
31911 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
31912 if (use_debug_types)
31914 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
31916 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
31917 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
31918 limbo die list. */
31919 limbo_die_list = NULL;
31921 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
31922 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
31923 references to the main compile unit). */
31924 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
31925 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31926 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
31927 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
31929 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
31930 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
31931 referenced. Prune them. */
31932 prune_unused_types ();
31935 /* Traverse the DIE's and note DIEs with DW_OP_GNU_variable_value still
31936 with dw_val_class_decl_ref operand. */
31937 note_variable_value (comp_unit_die ());
31938 for (limbo_die_node *node = cu_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31939 note_variable_value (node->die);
31940 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL;
31941 ctnode = ctnode->next)
31942 note_variable_value (ctnode->root_die);
31943 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31944 note_variable_value (node->die);
31946 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
31947 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
31948 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
31949 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
31950 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
31951 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
31953 /* The early debug phase is now finished. */
31954 early_dwarf_finished = true;
31956 /* Do not generate DWARF assembler now when not producing LTO bytecode. */
31957 if ((!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
31958 /* FIXME: Disable debug info generation for PE-COFF targets since the
31959 copy_lto_debug_sections operation of the simple object support in
31960 libiberty is not implemented for them yet. */
31961 || TARGET_PECOFF)
31962 return;
31964 /* Now as we are going to output for LTO initialize sections and labels
31965 to the LTO variants. We don't need a random-seed postfix as other
31966 LTO sections as linking the LTO debug sections into one in a partial
31967 link is fine. */
31968 init_sections_and_labels (true);
31970 /* The output below is modeled after dwarf2out_finish with all
31971 location related output removed and some LTO specific changes.
31972 Some refactoring might make both smaller and easier to match up. */
31974 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
31975 that have children. */
31976 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
31977 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
31978 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
31979 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
31980 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
31981 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
31983 /* AIX Assembler inserts the length, so adjust the reference to match the
31984 offset expected by debuggers. */
31985 strcpy (dl_section_ref, debug_line_section_label);
31986 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
31987 strcat (dl_section_ref, DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE_STR);
31989 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
31990 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list, dl_section_ref);
31992 if (have_macinfo)
31993 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DEBUG_MACRO_ATTRIBUTE,
31994 macinfo_section_label);
31996 save_macinfo_strings ();
31998 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
32000 unsigned int index = 0;
32001 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
32004 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
32005 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
32006 for (limbo_die_node *node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
32007 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0, NULL);
32009 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
32010 for (comdat_type_node *ctnode = comdat_type_list;
32011 ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
32013 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
32015 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
32016 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
32017 continue;
32019 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
32020 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
32021 attributes. */
32022 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
32023 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
32024 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
32025 ? debug_line_section_label
32026 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
32028 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
32029 *slot = ctnode;
32032 /* Stick a unique symbol to the main debuginfo section. */
32033 compute_comp_unit_symbol (comp_unit_die ());
32035 /* Output the main compilation unit. We always need it if only for
32036 the CU symbol. */
32037 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), true, NULL);
32039 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
32040 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev_die_table) != 1)
32042 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
32043 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
32044 output_abbrev_section ();
32047 /* Have to end the macro section. */
32048 if (have_macinfo)
32050 /* We have to save macinfo state if we need to output it again
32051 for the FAT part of the object. */
32052 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *saved_macinfo_table = macinfo_table;
32053 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
32054 macinfo_table = macinfo_table->copy ();
32056 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
32057 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
32058 output_macinfo (debug_line_section_label, true);
32059 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
32061 if (flag_fat_lto_objects)
32063 vec_free (macinfo_table);
32064 macinfo_table = saved_macinfo_table;
32068 /* Emit a skeleton debug_line section. */
32069 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
32070 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
32071 output_line_info (true);
32073 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
32074 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
32075 output_indirect_strings ();
32077 /* Switch back to the text section. */
32078 switch_to_section (text_section);
32081 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
32082 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
32084 void
32085 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
32087 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
32088 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
32089 used_rtx_array = NULL;
32090 incomplete_types = NULL;
32091 decl_scope_table = NULL;
32092 debug_info_section = NULL;
32093 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
32094 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
32095 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
32096 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
32097 debug_addr_section = NULL;
32098 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
32099 debug_line_section = NULL;
32100 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
32101 debug_loc_section = NULL;
32102 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
32103 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
32104 debug_str_section = NULL;
32105 debug_line_str_section = NULL;
32106 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
32107 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
32108 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
32109 debug_frame_section = NULL;
32110 fde_vec = NULL;
32111 debug_str_hash = NULL;
32112 debug_line_str_hash = NULL;
32113 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
32114 dw2_string_counter = 0;
32115 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
32116 text_section_used = false;
32117 cold_text_section_used = false;
32118 cold_text_section = NULL;
32119 current_unit_personality = NULL;
32121 early_dwarf = false;
32122 early_dwarf_finished = false;
32124 next_die_offset = 0;
32125 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
32126 comdat_type_list = NULL;
32127 limbo_die_list = NULL;
32128 file_table = NULL;
32129 decl_die_table = NULL;
32130 common_block_die_table = NULL;
32131 decl_loc_table = NULL;
32132 call_arg_locations = NULL;
32133 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
32134 call_site_count = -1;
32135 tail_call_site_count = -1;
32136 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
32137 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
32138 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
32139 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
32140 line_info_label_num = 0;
32141 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
32142 text_section_line_info = NULL;
32143 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
32144 separate_line_info = NULL;
32145 info_section_emitted = false;
32146 pubname_table = NULL;
32147 pubtype_table = NULL;
32148 macinfo_table = NULL;
32149 ranges_table = NULL;
32150 ranges_by_label = NULL;
32151 rnglist_idx = 0;
32152 have_location_lists = false;
32153 loclabel_num = 0;
32154 poc_label_num = 0;
32155 last_emitted_file = NULL;
32156 label_num = 0;
32157 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
32158 generic_type_instances = NULL;
32159 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
32160 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
32161 base_types.release ();
32162 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
32163 producer_string = NULL;
32166 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"